272 55 22MB
English Pages 292 [303] Year 2015
Dance Production Dance Production: Design and Technology introduces
This book also features:
you to the skills you need to plan, design, and execute the technical aspects of a dance production. While it
●●
photos of dance productions.
may not seem that staging a dance production is that different from a play or musical, in reality a dance
●●
dancers, designers, and stage managers from
all on its own, from scenery that accommodates
companies such as Paul Taylor Dance Company,
choreography, to lighting design that sculpts the
Martha Graham Dance Company, David Dorfman
body, and costumes that complement movement. This
Dance, Bill T. Jones/Arnie Zane Dance Company, and
unique book approaches the process of staging a dance
more.
production from a balanced perspective, making it an
Covering a broad range of topics, author Jeromy Hopgood takes the reader through the process of producing dance from start to finish, including pre-
Interviews with international working professionals in the dance industry, including choreographers,
performance offers up unique intricacies and challenges
essential resource for dancers and designers alike.
Hundreds of full-color illustrations and stunning
●●
Chapter-by-chapter projects and exercises for students.
●●
Companion website with chapter reviews, hand-outs, videos, bonus chapters, and additional projects.
production planning (collaboration, production process,
Jeromy Hopgood is a tenured Associate Professor at
personnel, performance spaces), design disciplines
Eastern Michigan University, where he created the
(lighting, sound, scenery, costumes, projections), stage
Entertainment Design & Technology program—one
management, and more. Bridging the gap between
of the only of its kind in the country. In addition to his
theatrical and dance design, the book includes a quick
teaching, Jeromy has designed more than 100 plays,
reference guide for theatrical and dance terminology,
musicals, dance, and opera productions over the last
useful in giving dancers and designers a common
decade. Jeromy worked at the Williamstown Theatre
working vocabulary that will ensure productive
Festival in its Tony Award-winning season alongside
communication across the different fields.
numerous Broadway designers, and he is an Artistic Associate for the Michigan Shakespeare Festival. Jeromy is also the author of QLab 3 Show Control: Projects for Live Performances and Installations by Focal Press.
Bound to Create Y are a creator. You Whatever your form of expression — photography, y filmmaking, y, animation, games, audio, media communication, web design, or theatre — you simply want to create without limitation. Bound by nothing except your own creativity and determination. Focal Press can help. For over 75 years Focal has published books that support your creative goals. Our founder, r Andor Kraszna-Krausz, established r, Focal in 1938 so you could have access to leading-edge expert knowledge, techniques, and tools that allow you to create without constraint. We strive to create exceptional, engaging, and practical content that helps you master your passion. Focal Press and you. Bound to create.
We’d love to hear how we’ve helped you create. Share your experience: www.focalpress.com/boundtocreate
Dance Production
Design and Technology Jeromy Hopgood
First published 2016 by Focal Press 711 Third Avenue, New York, NY 10017 and by Focal Press 2 Park Square, Milton Park, Abingdon, Oxon OX14 4RN Focal Press is an imprint of the Taylor & Francis Group, an informa business © 2016 Taylor & Francis The right of Jeromy Hopgood to be identified as author of this work has been asserted by him in accordance with sections 77 and 78 of the Copyright, Designs and Patents Act 1988. All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reprinted or reproduced or utilised in any form or by any electronic, mechanical, or other means, now known or hereafter invented, including photocopying and recording, or in any information storage or retrieval system, without permission in writing from the publishers. Trademark notice: Product or corporate names may be trademarks or registered trademarks, and are used only for identification and explanation without intent to infringe. Library of Congress Cataloging in Publication Data Hopgood, Jeromy. Dance production : design and technology / Jeromy Hopgood. pages cm Includes index. 1. Dance–Production and direction. I. Title. GV1782.H66 2016 792.8’4–dc23 2015014133 ISBN: 978-1-138-79589-1 (hbk) ISBN: 978-1-138-79591-4 (pbk) ISBN: 978-1-315-75818-3 (ebk) Typeset in DIN by Servis Filmsetting Ltd, Stockport, Cheshire Additional materials are available on the companion website at www.focalpress.com/cw/hopgood
Contents Acknowledgments ........................................................ viii Introduction...................................................................... 1
Part I: Thinking Ahead 1 Collaboration
Part II: Production Areas 4 Lighting
53
4.1 The Lighting Designer .................................. 54
7
1.1 Team Members and Responsibilities ............. 8
4.2 Functions of Dance Lighting (What Lighting can Accomplish) ............................. 54 4.3 Properties of Dance Lighting
1.2 The Choreographer....................................... 12
(Controllable Qualities of Dance
1.3 The Production Process ............................... 13
Lighting) ........................................................ 57 4.4 Lighting Systems .......................................... 60
1.4 Collaborative Models—How we Work Together? ...................................................... 15
4.5 Lighting Positions and Angles ...................... 62
1.5 Chapter Review ............................................. 18
4.6 Lighting Instruments .................................... 69 4.7 Atmospherics ................................................ 73
Interview The Choreographer’s Perspective: An Interview with Julia Gleich ...................... 19
2 Pre-production Planning
23
2.1 Purpose ......................................................... 24
4.8 Color in Lighting ........................................... 73 4.9 Chapter Review ............................................. 76
5 Creating the Lighting Design
79
2.2 Program Concerns ....................................... 24
5.1 Working with the Choreographer ................. 80
2.3 Performance Space Concerns...................... 27
5.2 Communicating the Design .......................... 81
2.4 Production Calendar ..................................... 27
5.3 Hang and Focus ............................................ 87
2.5 Production Budget ........................................ 31
5.4 Preparing for Technical Rehearsals ............ 88
2.6 Personnel ...................................................... 32
5.5 Technical Rehearsals ................................... 91
2.7 Chapter Review ............................................. 32 Interview The Production Manager’s Perspective: An Interview with Stacey-Jo Marine ............. 32
3 Performance Spaces
5.6 Chapter Review ............................................. 91 Interview The Lighting Designer’s Perspective:
35
An Interview with Seth Reiser ...................... 92
6 Sound
95
3.1 Proscenium Theatres ................................... 36
6.1 Thinking About Sound ................................... 96
3.2 Non-proscenium Theatres ........................... 47
6.2 Sound Design for Dance ............................... 97
3.3 Non-traditional Spaces................................. 49
6.3 Functions of Sound Design ........................... 98
3.4 Chapter Review ............................................. 50
6.4 Properties of Sound Design.......................... 99
v CONTENTS
6.5 Audio Equipment......................................... 100
10.5 Hair and Wigs .............................................. 183
6.6 Sound Systems ........................................... 104
10.6 Make-up Considerations ............................ 184
6.7 Legal Concerns ........................................... 105
10.7 Chapter Review ........................................... 186
6.8 Chapter Review ........................................... 107
7 Creating the Sound Design
11 Creating the Costume Design
189
109
11.1 Working with the Choreographer ............... 190
7.1 Working with the Choreographer ............... 110
11.2 Communicating the Design ........................ 192
7.2 Communicating the Design ........................ 111
11.3 Executing the Design .................................. 196
7.3 Sound Editing and Composition Tools........ 113
11.4 Preparing for Dress Rehearsals ................ 199
7.4 Preparing for Technical Rehearsals .......... 114
11.5 Dress Rehearsals and Beyond ................... 200
7.5 Chapter Review ........................................... 118 An Interview with Sam Crawford ................ 119
8 Scenery and Props
11.6 Chapter Review ........................................... 201 Interview The Costume Designer’s Perspective:
Interview The Sound Designer’s Perspective:
125
An Interview with Liz Prince ....................... 202
12 Projections and Video
207
8.1 Scenic Design.............................................. 126
12.1 The Projection Designer ............................. 208
8.2 Functions of Dance Scenery ....................... 127
12.2 Assessing Projection Needs ....................... 210
8.3 Scenic Elements ......................................... 132
12.3 Functions of Dance Projection Design
8.4 Dance Props................................................ 139 8.5 Chapter Review ........................................... 140
9 Creating the Scenic Design
143
(What Projection Design can Accomplish) ................................................ 214 12.4 Projection Systems ..................................... 218 12.5 Projection Equipment ................................. 219
9.1 Working with the Choreographer ............... 144
12.6 Software Solutions...................................... 222
9.2 Communicating the Design ........................ 145
12.6 A Word About Interactive Dance................. 226
9.3 Design Specifications.................................. 151
12.7 Chapter Review ........................................... 226
9.4 Scenic Construction and Painting .............. 155 9.5 Props Design............................................... 157 9.6 Chapter Review ........................................... 159 Interview The Scenic Designer’s Perspective:
229
13.1 Working with the Choreographer ............... 230 13.2 Communicating the Design ........................ 231
An Interview with Campbell Baird .............. 160
10 Costumes, Hair, and Make-up
13 Creating the Projection Design
165
10.1 The Costume Designer ............................... 166 10.2 Functions of Dance Costumes (What Costumes can Accomplish) .............. 166 10.3 Properties of Dance Costumes (Controllable Qualities of Dance
13.3 Content........................................................ 234 13.4 Preparing for Technical Rehearsals .......... 236 13.5 Technical Rehearsals ................................. 238 13.6 Chapter Review ........................................... 238 Interview The Projection Designer’s Perspective: An Interview with João Beira ...................... 239
14 Stage Management
243
Costumes) ................................................... 170
14.1 The Stage Manager ..................................... 244
10.4 Dance Costume Components ..................... 173
14.2 Pre-production ........................................... 248
vi CONTENTS
14.3 Rehearsals .................................................. 250 14.4 Technical Rehearsals ................................. 253 14.5 During the Run ............................................ 255 14.6 Chapter Review ........................................... 256 Interview The Stage Manager’s Perspective: An Interview with Julie Ballard .................. 257
Part III: Quick Reference 15 Dance Terminology
261
16 Theatre/Stagecraft Terminology
273
Index
283
vii CONTENTS
Acknowledgments The idea for this book as you see it today started in
me to see the work of my students and colleagues
the winter of 2013 while designing lights for a dance
represented in this book alongside the work of some of
concert at Eastern Michigan University, where I teach.
the giants in the dance world.
The roots of this project began many years ago, though. I imagined writing a book like this when working with my first student choreographer over a decade ago, and the idea has resurfaced with every student choreographer or designer I have worked with since. Like every other teacher, I owe my biggest thanks to my students, who always ask the best questions. Keep it up!
I couldn’t have created this book without all of the wonderful photographers who so generously contributed their work. Special thanks to Richard Calmes for the use of his amazing dance photography on the cover of the book, as well as a number of the photos inside. He is an amazing guy and a very talented photographer whose work you should definitely check out (www.pbase.com/rcalmes). Thanks also to Randy
As I began the task of researching, writing, and
Mascharka, the talented university photographer for
compiling illustrations and photos for the text, I had
Eastern Michigan University, who has documented
the distinct pleasure of making some new friends
so much of my work over the years. Zac Whittenberg
and standing on the shoulders of some amazing
and the wonderful folks at Hubbard Street Dance
colleagues. My heartfelt thanks to Campbell Baird of
Chicago truly delivered a treasure trove of production
NYU-Tisch School of the Arts, a true gentleman and a
and behind-the-scenes photos. Thanks, as well, to
scholar (and to Diane D. Fairchild for introducing us).
Lynn Wichern and the Merce Cunningham Trust for
My fondest appreciation also to Julie Ballard, João
assistance in including some of Merce’s amazing work
Biera, Sam Crawford, Julia Gleich, Stacey-Jo Marine,
in photo form.
Liz Prince, and Seth Reiser for being so gracious with their time and providing some insight into the world of professional dance. Thanks to the Appalachian State University Department of Theatre and Dance for giving me my first job that introduced me to a whole other world of design outside of theatre. To John Marty, in particular, thanks for being long-suffering as I delved into rep light plots. Thanks to Eastern Michigan University and the Entertainment Design & Technology program for creating such a wonderful workplace. I can’t say how proud it makes
viii ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
None of this would have been possible without the help of Stacey Walker and Meagan White from Focal Press. Thanks for your support on both this and my first book. It has been a pleasure. Finally, thanks to the people who truly support me every day: my family. Katie and Kira have given up so much time from their weekends, summers, and Christmas break for this project. Thanks for being so supportive of me through everything and always believing in me. To the newest member of the family, Isabella, your timing
was perfect. You arrived a month before the manuscript was due and missed out on all the drama. Here’s to making up all those lost days along the way, ladies.
ix ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
INTRODUCTION Coming together is a beginning; keeping together is progress; working together is success. Henry Ford
The Solitude. Choreography and Direction: Source line Julia to K. goGleich. here Photography by Lucas Chilczuk.
●
You have to love dancing to stick to it. It gives you
“I can’t talk about lights. I just know what I like when I
nothing back, no manuscripts to store away, no
see it.” Likewise, there is the case of the designer who
paintings to show on walls and maybe hang in
simply puts together a design without understanding
museums, no poems to be printed and sold, nothing
the intent of the dance or moments of significance. In
but that single fleeting moment when you feel alive.
both of these cases, the collaborative process has been
Merce Cunningham Some years ago, I began my foray into dance by taking a few theatrical dance courses as a part of my
short-changed because of the inability of one or more of the collaborators to relate to the creative process on the other side of the fence.
undergraduate theatre training. I had always been
As an educator, I have noticed that those of my students
involved in music since my childhood, so I found dance
who study both theatre and dance seem to have a much
to be a somewhat natural extension of that side of my
easier go of things when staging a production than some
brain. As anyone who had the misfortune of watching
of their peers. That is not to say that they are necessarily
my dance attempts can attest, though, my musical
more gifted students, but they have much less difficulty
ability certainly had no direct correlation with an
in navigating the collaborative process when working
ability to successfully move my body with the music.
as a choreographer or as a designer. This realization
After graduation, I went on to get my MFA in Scenic
brought home for me the importance of establishing a
and Lighting Design and spent very little time thinking
common language for communicating across the two
about dance, unless it was related to a musical theatre
disciplines.
production. My first tenure-track professor position was in the Department of Theatre & Dance at Appalachian State University in North Carolina. As a faculty scenic and lighting designer, my workload was divided across both theatre and dance productions. In many of my interactions with choreographers, I was told that my approach to dance design and the way that I spoke with the choreographers made the collaboration an easy one. Apparently, my background in music and dance went a long way towards making me a better collaborator. This experience taught me an important lesson: though theatre and dance share many similarities as art forms, the artists from these fields tend to come from widely different backgrounds and rarely share a common vocabulary. As a result, collaboration on dance productions have a potential for confusion at a basic level if the collaborators can’t find a way to get past these differences. Frequently, I have heard choreographers say to a designer for their production,
2 INTRODUCTION
In educational productions, I frequently work with student choreographers who may not always have a grasp of the technical side of the production process. I always try to have one or two meetings with them early in their process to discuss how their choices affect the design/tech side of things and vice versa. In some cases, I try to give a bit of a primer to areas like lighting, sound, scenery/props, costumes, and projections to explain how we achieve storytelling through their use. I also ask for an explanation of the intent of the dance piece, what it should communicate, and any special technical needs. This open collaborative process is so very important to establishing a relationship of trust between the choreographer, dancers, and design team. Sometimes this process can be a difficult one. The collaborative process is always complex. Collaborating with team members across multiple disciplines can be downright intimidating. It is for this reason that I decided to
write a book that addresses the specific needs of a multidisciplinary production and allows the reader to see different perspectives on the process.
Format of This Book
the world of the professional artist and his/her own unique process. Part III: Quick Reference is the one aspect of the book that generated the most interest across the board in early peer responses. This section
My goal in writing this textbook is to bridge the
offers up a collection of terms, photos, and
gap between theatrical and dance production by
illustrations to communicate commonly used
establishing a common vocabulary that will ensure
terms or ideas from both dance and theatre.
productive communication across the two disciplines.
This goes a long way towards bridging that gap
The text covers a wide range of design and technology
between the theatre and dance practitioners
components necessary to staging a dance production. In
by establishing a common lexicon. The better
researching the text, I spoke to a number of academics
acquainted we become with the terminology
and professionals to identify the specific needs in
used in a different field, the better prepared
teaching the process of dance production. I contacted
we are to understand and communicate our
individuals from both the dance world and the theatre
needs though collaboration.
world, since it is most often these two disciplines that converge to create a dance production. It is my hope that the text will find a home in both dance and theatre bookshelves, studied by both designers and dancers alike.
I hope that this book should serve the needs of educator and student alike. If you are a teacher, I hope that my end of chapter reviews, hand-outs, and supplemental materials on the companion website (www.focalpress. com/cw/hopgood) are useful in structuring your
The book is structured to provide an introduction to a
semester. I wrote the book to follow the syllabus that I
number of production areas as well as provide valuable
have crafted over the years to guide students through
insight from professionals in the field. There are three
an introduction to production design and technology.
different sections to the book.
For the student, I have tried very hard to keep the
Part I:
Thinking Ahead addresses the early stages of the production process, covering basic concepts such as the collaborative process, production planning, and performance spaces.
Part II:
Production Areas is the largest section of the book. This section covers all of the different design/tech areas of dance production. Typically, the first chapter will introduce you to the production area while the subsequent
writing approachable and conversational. I discovered early in my career that this is the best approach to any classroom. For those outside of academia, I believe you will find the text useful as well. With the addition of hands-on projects, interviews with working professionals, and multimedia materials on the companion website, this book can serve as an excellent handbook to learning more about the world of dance design and technology.
chapter delves into the specifics of the creative
Finally, I think it is worth stating that the content of this
process for that area. Scattered throughout
book is based on my personal experiences as a teacher
the book are interviews with professionals
and designer. I have worked with a number of different
from each of these areas, giving insight into
choreographers and artists over the years. This has
3 INTRODUCTION
helped form my approach to dance production. It is the
conflicts, communication breakdowns, and more.
nature of a textbook to take a stand on certain issues
Ultimately, though, in each of these interactions lies
as preferred practice. For all of that, it is important to
the potential for something wondrous—a dynamic and
recognize that the artistic process is one that depends
unique creation that tells a story more powerfully and
on personal trial and error. Just because something is a
evocatively than any individual could alone. It is that
preferred practice doesn’t necessarily mean that it will
potential that makes the risk worthwhile and drives us
work in every given situation. Artists should always be
onwards.
willing to take chances and experiment. If this book has given you enough information to spark your imagination towards trying out new and different approaches to dance production, then I have done my job well.
In Conclusion The process of creating any work of art through collaboration is a risky endeavor. There is always the possibility for misunderstandings, personality
4 INTRODUCTION
I hope that this book will help you in your personal journey as a collaborative artist and lead you to some new discoveries. I have learned so many interesting things in the course of writing this book. Hopefully, you will find its contents informative, insightful, and expiring. All the best, Jeromy
PART I THINKING AHEAD
CHAPTER 1 COLLABORATION In the long history of humankind (and animal kind, too) those who learned to collaborate and improvise most effectively have prevailed. Charles Darwin
Hubbard Street Dance Chicago + Alonzo King LINES Ballet take a curtain call following their performance of AZIMUTH by Alonzo King. Costumes by Robert Rosenwasser, Joan Raymond, and Rebecca M. Shouse. Lighting Design Source by line AxeltoMorgenthaler. go here Photo by Quinn B Wharton.
Dance and theatre are both collaborative art forms.
organization runs smoothly. Listed below are a number
In order to create a dance production, even a solo
of these individuals and a brief description of their jobs.
exhibition, a number of people are typically engaged in the process of staging the event: the choreographer
●●
establishes the overarching artistic vision for the
and dancers; a production manager who schedules,
dance company. The AD is frequently the bridge
budgets, and keeps things running smoothly; the design
between artistic and administrative personnel
team who create the visual and auditory world which
(for this reason, I have listed the AD in both
the dancers inhabit; the technicians and stagehands
administrative and artistic personnel below). The AD
who facilitate the designs and run the show backstage;
hires all artistic staff and is in charge of planning
the theatre personnel who control the day-to-day
the season(s) based on his/her vision for the dance
operations of the space; the marketing personnel who
organization.
get the word out about your performance; box office/ front-of-house personnel who interact with the public
●●
Board of Directors: The Board of Directors is the governing group of the dance company, whose
who come to see the show; there might even be a
primary interest lies in supervising the funding
producer/artistic director/board of directors for your
and business practices of the organization. As the
dance company who create the vision for the entire
board assumes the ultimate legal and financial
organization. In any given scenario, one might work
responsibility for the company, it is frequently
with some or all of these positions in order to produce
composed of professionals from the finance,
a dance concert. It is for this reason that artists in the
legal, and business sector as well as individuals
theatre and dance industries must be keenly aware of
well positioned in the community to generate and
the nature of collaboration and the process of working
maintain a donor base.
with others to create a work of art built on a common artistic vision.
Artistic Director: The Artistic Director, or AD,
●●
General Manager: The General Manager (or Executive Director, in some organizations) is an
1.1 Team Members and Responsibilities
individual with experience in arts management who
Though later chapters focus on many of these
works closely with the AD to realize the vision for
production areas in detail, a quick look at the production
the dance company. The General Manager hires and
team members and their responsibilities is useful in
manages administrative personnel and reports to
understanding the production process. The list below
the Board of Directors regarding the general state of
includes a wide array of production personnel and their
organizational stability and operations.
job descriptions. Though by no means exhaustive, this
●●
Business Manager: The Business Manager is
list includes a number of people who are frequently
in charge of bookkeeping and payroll for the
engaged in the process of producing dance.
organization. The Business Manager meticulously tracks all incoming and outgoing funds. If the
Administration
organization is not-for-profit, this individual is
Though the audience tends to focus on the dancers
instrumental in working with an auditor to ensure
onstage, there are a number of people behind the
the financials are properly reported each year.
scenes who work tirelessly to ensure the dance
●●
Company Manager: The job description for Company Manager varies, based on the organizational
8 THINKING AHEAD
structure and mission of the dance company in
Theatre Staff
question. The Company Manager oversees activities
It is important to recognize that many dance companies
in booking performances, communication with performance venues, the logistics of company touring, and outreach opportunities. ●●
●●
do not own a home theatre of their own used exclusively for presenting their dance works. Although this is a possibility, a much more common model is a dance
Development Director: Development Directors
company that presents their works in rental spaces
oversee fundraising for the dance company—working
or in various different spaces. In this case, there are
to establish a donor base, organizing fundraising
personnel that work with the dance company, but are
events, and spearheading grant writing.
employees of the theatre space. Some of these positions
Marketing Director: The Marketing Director is
are listed below.
responsible for promoting the dance company in the community. Marketing involves a number of areas:
●●
the employees working in the theatre’s box office
print media, broadcast media, Internet mailings,
and tracks ticket sales and box office earnings. Since
the company website, and more. Increasingly, social
the box office is the first face your patrons see, this
media plays an important role in the process of
position is instrumental in setting the tone for a good
branding a dance organization. ●●
Production Manager: The Production Manager oversees all of the production elements of the
audience experience and return patrons. ●●
audience experience and safety. The House Manager
production budget tracking, and hiring technicians
typically trains and supervises ushers and helps in
to run the performance. In short, the Production
seating patrons and facilitating the entry of those on
Manager is the person who keeps the production on
the waiting list. In addition, the House Manager has
schedule and on budget.
the important responsibility of ensuring compliance
Presenter: In dance, the Presenter is an individual
with fire codes and dealing with emergency
who represents a performance venue, festival,
situations that arise before, during, or following a
or presenting group. He/she invites artists or companies to present their work as part of the presenting group’s season or festival. The Presenter might sometimes be referred to as a Producer or Curator as well. ●●
Tour Manager: The Tour Manager’s sole job is the planning and organization of a tour. This individual books travel and lodging, coordinates with the presenter or performance venue, ensures the signing of performance contracts and technical riders, and coordinates a tour itinerary.
House Manager: The House Manager works closely with the performance venue to ensure positive
dance company from the production schedule, to
●●
Box Office Manager: A Box Office Manager manages
performance. ●●
House Tech: Many performance spaces have their own technicians assigned to the space to supervise guests in the space. This position is typically referred to as the House Tech, an individual hired by the space but not necessarily affiliated with the dance company. In a union setting, there are certain jobs that can only be performed by the house technicians.
Dance Artists Within the dance company, there are a number of artists who collaborate to produce a dance performance.
9 COLLABORATION
Though perhaps never seen onstage, these individuals
●●
Resident Choreographer: A Resident Choreographer
work to ensure a product of high artistic quality. Listed
is an individual serving in residence with a specific
below are these artists and their job descriptions.
dance company for a predetermined period of time,
●●
during which he/she will set new dance works to
Artistic Director: As listed in the administrative
be premiered through the dance company. In some
group, the Artistic Director is the bridge between
cases, the Artistic Director may serve as a Resident
the artistic and administrative personnel. He/she
Director.
creates the vision for the dance company, planning for the entire season and, in many cases, for many
●●
responsible for documenting and preserving
years ahead. As such, the AD must be firmly rooted
a Choreographer’s vision and intention. The
in all aspects of production. ●●
Choreologist is trained in special forms of notation to
Choreographer: The Choreographer works with
document the dance for future remounts or archival
dancers to set movement for the stage. This
purposes.
collective set of movements is referred to as choreography. These dances are sometimes based on an idea, story, poem, visual image, or piece of music, though many modern choreographers create dances meant to function independently of external constructs. Choreographers tend to be dancers themselves. ●●
●●
Dancer: The Dancer is anyone who interprets and
Musical Staff Dance and music have been interconnected throughout history. It is common to find one or more musicians associated with the production of a dance performance. These roles are listed below. ●●
Composer: The Composer writes the music for
performs the choreography. The Dancer may also
the dance. Some Composers collaborate with
be involved in the development of choreography in
Choreographers to craft the music specifically
conjunction with the Choreographer.
for a dance piece, whereas some modern
Principal Dancer: Many companies feature a
collaborations feature dance and music creation as separate entities that only come together for
Principal Dancer, one who has reached a high level
the performance. Sometimes a Choreographer
of technical proficiency and artistic interpretation.
may simply select music previously written by a
The Principal Dancer performs starring roles in the
Composer.
dance company’s repertoire and might receive billing (having one’s name listed prominently) in marketing
●●
Choreologist: A Choreologist is the person
●●
Accompanist: The Accompanist is a musician
for the dance.
who plays music for classes or rehearsal. Most
Rehearsal Director: The Rehearsal Director
frequently Accompanists play piano or percussion instruments. This individual should be aware of
schedules and runs rehearsals on behalf of
the specific needs and protocols for the dance
the choreographer, to ensure the dancers
class or rehearsal process. When playing piano,
interpret the choreography once set by the
the Accompanist is sometimes referred to as a
Choreographer. This individual is frequently
Rehearsal Pianist.
someone intimately familiar with either the dance company or the choreographer, though not necessarily both.
10 THINKING AHEAD
●●
Conductor: The Conductor is responsible for directing the orchestra and arranging music as
might interact. Sometimes, the Scenic Designer
necessary for performance. In some cases, the
manages properties, as well.
Conductor also hires musicians to play in the orchestra.
●●
Projection/Media Designer: Projection Design is a catchall phrase for the use of imagery, either
Design Staff
projected or displayed on monitors or display panels.
The designers are the production team members
This field, while relatively young, is one of the fastest
responsible for creating the visual and auditory aspects
growing design areas in dance. The Projection
of a dance performance. Frequently, these individuals
Designer generates content to be displayed and
have training in the theatre or live performance
assembles or specifies the necessary equipment for
industries. The list below includes a wide range of
the design.
personnel and job descriptions. Designers are hired
●●
as needed by the dance company and not part of the
responsible for facilitating the sound needs of the
permanent staff. ●●
production, from audio reinforcement for dancers
closely with the Choreographer to determine the
and musicians, to recording and editing of original
clothing needs of the dancers and the specific
music, and setting up a sound system for audio
requirements of costume as it relates to fabric and
playback and mixing. In some instances, a Sound
movement. The duties of the costume designer may
Designer might function as the Composer and write
include hair and make-up as well, or there might be
original music for a dance. It is more rare, though, to
a specific wigs or make-up designer hired for the
see the Composer serving as Sound Designer.
Scenic Designer: The Scenic Designer (or Set Designer) designs the visual world of the scenery based on the storyline, theme, or setting of the dance. The Scenic Designer must work closely with the Choreographer, as movement paths can be either created or inhibited by the placement of scenic elements.
●●
●●
production. These needs can vary depending on the
Costume Designer: The Costume Designer works
production. ●●
Sound Designer: The Sound Designer is the individual
Lighting Designer: The Lighting Designer (or LD)
Technical Staff Technicians are the group of artists who execute the designs and facilitate the designer’s vision for the production. Some of these roles are staff positions with the dance company, though others are frequently freelance positions that are hired in for a specific production. ●●
Stage Manager: The Stage Manager’s biggest
chooses an inventory of lighting instruments and
responsibility is “calling the show.” This phrase
determines their placement, colors, and intensity
refers to the act of calling cues for the show over
to accentuate the dancers’ movement on stage. As
the intercom system during the performance. The
dance programs frequently feature a number of
Stage Manager controls every aspect of the timing
differing dances, the LD must often create a light
for the show (lighting, sound, scenery movement,
plot that works for more than one type of dance as
projections, and dancer entrances) through calling
well.
the cues or triggering of cue lights. In addition, the
Props Designer: A Props Designer is responsible for
Stage Manager is responsible for the safety of the
creating any type of props with which the dancers
performers and crew while in the theatre. In some
11 COLLABORATION
settings, the Stage Manager works closely with the
●●
choreographer during the rehearsal period, while
controls the lighting board, typically pressing the GO
in others he/she only comes in for the technical rehearsals and production run. ●●
●●
button to proceed through the lighting cues. ●●
Spotlight Operator: The Spotlight Operator
Assistant Stage Manager: The Assistant Stage
(sometimes referred to as the Followspot Operator)
Manager (or ASM) assists the Stage Manager in their
operates a special lighting instrument called the
rehearsal duties and in the running of the show from
follow spot—a light mounted on a swivel turret that
backstage.
can follow a dancer across the stage, assuring that he/she will always be lit.
Technical Director: The Technical Director (or TD) is the individual responsible for overseeing all of
●●
Sound Board Operator: A Sound Board Operator
the technical elements of the production. The TD
controls the sound system—typically comprised of a
typically has experience in a number of different
sound mixer and/or audio control system. The Sound
production areas that enable him/her to supervise
Board Operator may control a number of different
the setup, facilities, equipment, and technical
components from audio playback to headsets and
concerns related to touring. For many dance companies the TD is responsible for the Technical
microphones for the orchestra and dancers. ●●
Rider for the show (a contract that stipulates what facilities and equipment are required for staging
Stagehand: A Stagehand is a technician responsible for moving scenery or properties for a production.
●●
a show at a touring venue). The TD is typically a
Flyman: A Flyman is a specific type of Stagehand who moves scenery attached to the theatre’s
permanent staff member of the dance company. ●●
Light Board Operator: The Light Board Operator
counterweight system. Such items are said to be
Master Electrician: The Master Electrician (or
“flown,” meaning that they can be stored overhead,
ME) coordinates the lighting for the dance space—
out of the audience’s line of sight, until they are
interpreting the Lighting Designer’s light plot;
needed for the show. At this time, the Flyman pulls
wiring, hanging, circuiting, and focusing lighting
on a rope that brings the scenery in.
instruments; and also purchasing, maintaining, and
●●
upgrading the lighting inventory. In some instances,
the maintenance and placing of costumes. A Dresser
the ME might serve as a Lighting Designer for some
is a member of the Wardrobe Crew specifically
dances, as well.
responsible for assisting the dancers to get into and out of costume during the show.
Running Crew The term Running Crew refers to those people working backstage who run the various components of a production during the performance. All of the Running Crew take direction from the Stage Manager during the run of the show. Common Running Crew positions are listed below. Some of these positions might be provided by the performance space, but it is most likely that each person will need to be hired as needed by the dance company for the duration of the performances.
12 THINKING AHEAD
Wardrobe: The Wardrobe Crew is responsible for
●●
Wigs/Make-up: Wigs and Make-up Crew Members are responsible for the application or assisting in the application of make-up, face, and/or body paints, wigs, hairpieces, or prosthetics.
1.2 The Choreographer Since so much of the dance process revolves around the choreographer and his/her vision, it is important to examine the role of the choreographer within the
context of dance production. The roots of the word
and shares some of the responsibility for training
choreographer can be traced back to a combination
dancers.
of two Greek words, khoreia (meaning dance) and graphein (meaning to write). Therefore, the literal meaning of choreographer is “dance writer.” This phrase aptly describes the role of the choreographer. In basic terms, the choreographer composes a dance piece, working with dancers to assemble a series of movements and patterns into a cohesive performance. Beyond this, though, the choreographer must consider the overall artistic vision and message and collaborate with designers and technicians to facilitate the visual world of the dance outside of the choreography alone. In the professional context, there are a number of different ways in which choreographers work. The choreographer could work solely on a given project, hiring dancers and designers to create the dance. Similarly, the choreographer could be brought in as a guest artist by a dance company to compose a piece as a premiere, or dance work seen for the first time. Some choreographers create their own dance company to support their artistic vision. Notable examples are companies like the Alvin Ailey Dance Theater, the Martha Graham Dance Company, or the Bill T. Jones/ Arnie Zane Dance Company. Frequently these are repertory companies, a dance company that has a number of dances in their repertoire that are presented multiple times (rather than a single event). These companies present multiple dances in one season, remounting pieces from their repertoire. In this case, a choreographer may be brought in to remount the original work as the original choreographer conceived it for the premiere. Frequently a choreographer functions as the artistic director for a dance company—the individual who sets the overarching artistic vision of the dance organization. In many ballet companies, the position of artistic director is frequently a retired dancer who choreographs some of the company’s productions
One additional area to consider for the choreographer is educational dance. Dance education can begin at a very young age and is present in many educational environments from preschool to K–12 and higher education. Choreographers might function as dance educators in a private studio scenario or as part of a physical education program through public schools. Likewise, there are a number of university professors who specialize in dance. Since the purpose of educational dance is to train, most often the dance and design/tech roles are filled from a group of students and faculty/staff. Though there are a number of ways in which a choreographer can work, the consistent truth is that all dance centers on the choreographer and his or her vision for storytelling. As such, the creative process of the choreographer affects all of the production team members involved in staging a dance.
1.3 The Production Process The creative process that goes into creating dance tends to be unique to the choreographer and his or her collaborative team. While it is true that each choreographer and production team have a unique approach, there are also some common themes that appear in the process of taking a dance from idea to public presentation. The steps below describe one such approach to the production process. Obviously, there are a number of artists who do not fit so neatly into this box, but it is a good place to start our exploration of the dance production process. The following list is created from the perspective of a choreographer selfproducing a dance, so as to see the full spectrum of considerations. Keep in mind that even though these are presented in a specific order, the arrangement of these individual steps may change based on the needs
13 COLLABORATION
of a particular project. Always remain flexible in your
performance style. Theatrical styles, on the other
creative process!
hand, tend to be associated with literary or artistic
●●
movements such as classicism, realism, naturalism,
Inspiration/theme: Like any work of art, the
absurdism, epic theatre, or more.
effective dance piece will have a central idea at its core that inspired the artist to create the work.
●●
backbone of any successful live performance. There
Since dance is most frequently paired with music,
are many components that must be considered when
it only makes sense that music or sound often
producing a dance: budget; contracts; rehearsal
sparks the creative impulse for a dance. This is far
space; securing a performance space; design/
from the only element that might inspire a dance,
technical aspects; marketing and promotion;
though. Visual elements like sculpture, natural
technical rehearsals and performance dates. Each
landscapes, or other physical objects often serve
of these elements should be combined into one
as artistic stimuli. Likewise, the impulse could be
master schedule that creates deadlines for all
more kinesthetic—a desire to explore a movement
elements of the production. Depending on the role of
style or action. One of the most common forms of
the choreographer in the dance company, he or she
inspiration for a dance, particularly in the context of
may be responsible for some or all of these details.
modern and contemporary dance, is the exploration
Additionally, there might be an Artistic Director,
of thought, emotion, or philosophical concepts.
Production Manager, or Technical Director involved
Ultimately, this inspiration might be unknown to
in this step. Whether the choreographer dictates the
the audience, but it is invaluable information for the
schedule or not, the creative process must fit within
choreographer, dancers, and design team. Any or
the confines of the production schedule.
multiple of these elements will combine to create a thematic approach to the dance—what are we trying to communicate? ●●
Style: The choice of style is an important consideration. Style can be defined as a method or approach to presenting a work of art. Style is typically tied to the historical period in which it was first created and, as such, one sees similarities between styles across the differing art forms. In music, style is frequently substituted with the word genre. Jazz, blues, dubstep, and folk are all examples of musical styles. Dance includes styles like jazz, hip-hop, ballet, and Latin/rhythm. One important consideration to working in a multidisciplinary
Setting a schedule: Planning and deadlines are the
●●
Assembling a team: The process of assembling a team varies wildly depending on the specifics of your dance project. When I say “team,” I am referring to the entire group of performers, designers, and technicians necessary to staging the dance. In an academic environment, chances are good that you will have a pool of student dancers auditioning for your dance piece. It is common in this situation to be one of a number of choreographers combining to mount a dance concert featuring multiple pieces. In these situations, it is not uncommon to have a design team assigned to your project.
art form such as dance is that one style can have
Depending on your specific project, you may find
different connotations across the differing art
yourself needing to secure a number of artists for
forms. In music and dance, style tends to be linked
the job. If hiring production members, the contract or
to the historical period and/or cultural origin of the
Letter of Agreement (LOA) is an essential element.
14 THINKING AHEAD
The LOA should include the specific responsibilities,
which the dances are run at full speed with technical
deadlines, rates of pay, and guidelines specific to
elements. Frequently, cue-to-cue and tech runs are
working for this unique production. This contract
combined into the same tech rehearsal. The dress
ensures that all participants have been made aware of
rehearsal is the last step of technical rehearsals, in
their duties before the project begins and agree to the
which costumes are incorporated.
predetermined conditions. ●●
Performance: Once the technical rehearsals have ended, we reach the final stage of the creative
selected, the rehearsal process begins in full.
process—bringing an audience in to watch the
Depending on the choreographer’s approach, this
performance. This is the step for which everyone has
process can vary greatly. It might involve arriving
been working so hard.
in the studio with the movement ready to teach
●●
Self-examination: In many dance companies, a
the dancers; working from a rough idea; asking
period of self-examination is included. Many theatre
dancers to create their own individual stories and
and dance companies refer to this as a postmortem,
accompanying movement; or working from props
a meeting in which the entire production team comes
to determine the material for the dance piece.
together to discuss the process, what worked, what
One should never assume that this process will be
did not, and what could be learned from the process
similar from choreographer to choreographer. At
to improve for subsequent productions.
some point after the choreography is complete, it is the dance piece. In these instances, I tend to create
1.4 Collaborative Models—How we Work Together?
a video recording for future reference. This simple
As we have seen above, there are dozens of different
step can make the tech process run much more
individuals who collaborate to produce a dance
smoothly.
performance. There are a number of different models
Technical rehearsals: Once the dance pieces are
for how these people work together to accomplish
fully choreographed, it is time to move from the
their goals. These approaches are as unique as the
studio into the performance space. This time period
differing types of organizations presenting the dance.
of rehearsing dance pieces with the technical
Once you get a job, it is important to understand how
aspects is referred to as a technical rehearsal.
the organization typically works in order to anticipate
Depending on the time and budget allowed, technical
what your expectations will be. Listed below are some
rehearsals can last anywhere from a week to a few
common collaborative models that you might find in any
hours before opening. Each dance company follows
dance organization.
beneficial to invite the designers in to see a run of
●●
●●
Studio time: At some point after the dancers are
different rules for the process, but it is common for the dancers to space through the dance piece
The Company Model
at a reduced tempo while the choreographer and
The dance company model is a common approach
designers look at the piece under stage lighting with
to producing dance. The idea is to bring together
props and other technical elements. This rehearsal
a group of like-minded artists to create a dance
is often referred to as a cue-to-cue, since the tech
performance. Companies tend to function as groups
process is to gradually proceed from cue to cue and
of artists, centered on the artistic vision of a specific
watch the progression. A tech run is a rehearsal in
choreographer or artistic director. An important
15 COLLABORATION
concept to understand is that the dance company model
within the company model listed above on a project and
is often distinctly tied to the genre of dance being
not be a member of the dance company.
produced. Ballet companies are wildly different in their management and operation than hip-hop companies. No matter the style, though, some aspects remain the same.
The nature of the freelance business is that the freelancer tends to work for a number of different companies. Since there is no assurance of a next job, the freelance artist must always be looking down
Unlike a single dance concert, the dance company
the road for the next opportunity. As such, it is not
model tends to produce works as part of an over-
uncommon to find freelance artists engaged to multiple
arching season of performances in one or more
productions at the same time. This is particularly true of
different performance venues. The company model
designers, who might be in various stages of the design
can be a more rigidly structured, business-minded
process on different shows simultaneously. This setup
approach to collaboration than some others. Producing
makes for a different sort of collaboration than that of
an entire season of dances requires a great amount of
the dance company model. Since freelance artists might
planning. Planning for individual productions occur in
frequently come in from out of town, they tend to not be
a production meeting. These meetings are where all of
involved in as many of the production meetings or be
the production and administrative staff come together
involved by telephone or video conferencing. This type
to plan for the dance performance. Since the company
of relationship means that there is less time for concept
has the responsibility of producing more than one
development and more of a focus on the tech process
singular concert, the decision-making for one show
for the production.
might be affected by the concerns for a previous or future production within the season. It is not uncommon to find many of the same artists working on multiple shows within the dance company season. In addition, the creative process likely involves the artistic director (and other key administrative personnel) in addition to the choreographer and designers. Given the number of collaborators, the company model requires perhaps a greater amount of collaborative flexibility than some of the other models listed below.
The Freelance Model The freelance model is a common approach to creating a production team for dance. This term freelance refers to a worker who is not attached to any one specific employer and, instead, is brought in by different companies to work on a project for a fixed period of time. It is important to note that a freelancer might work
Choreographers can also be freelancers. Depending on the nature of the contract, the choreographer might be in town for an extended time or only long enough to set the dance. In these shorter engagements, the choreographer will frequently set the dance and have a rehearsal director for subsequent rehearsals with the dancers. Most often, the choreographer is required to return for the tech process of the dance to give final notes and communicate with the designers, though this is not always the case. In this type of situation, it is important for the designers and choreographer to be in communication about the choreographer’s concepts and design preferences for his/her dance piece, since the tech rehearsals will be too late to make any substantive changes to the designs.
The Collective Method Another collaborative method is working in a collective, a group of like-minded artists with common
16 THINKING AHEAD
artistic goals who choose to work together. Like the
Warhol; filmmakers Charles Atlas and Elliot Caplan; and
dance company, a collective tends to be of a less
architect Benedetta Tagliabue (Figure 1.1). One of the
temporary arrangement, and might feature a group
most radical notions introduced in these collaborations
of artists working together again and again to create
concerned the relationship between music and dance.
performances. One of the interesting aspects of how
Cage and Cunningham embraced the notion that music
a collective can work is the tendency of blurring the
and dance may well exist in the same time and space for
lines between the creative roles. The dance tends
the performance, but should always be created separate
to be created in a more communal sense, with
of one another. Because of this, the music and dance
choreographers, dancers, musicians, and designers
in their collaborations stood alone as independent
contributing to the artistic creation. In this sense, there
components of the performance. This unique process
is a greater sense of collective artistic ownership of the dance. Though this model may be hard to achieve in practical terms, many artists find this to be a rewarding creative method in which to work.
The Independent Model Though collaboration is one of the benchmarks of dance production, some modern dance artists have blurred the lines between traditional collaboration and chance artistic creation. The father of this modern dance philosophy was Merce Cunningham, who created the Merce Cunningham Dance Company (MCDC) in 1953. One of his defining qualities as a choreographer was a belief in the use of chance as a choreographic device. He would collaborate with the dancers to develop movement sequences focused on time, space, and weight. Once developing a basic movement vocabulary, the dancers would roll a dice or use instruction manuals to determine which moves would be used, in what order and combination. This method created an element of surprise and lacked traditional compositional principles such as a clear beginning, middle, and end. In addition to chance in his own choreography, though, Cunningham often combined his dance with other works of art to create multidisciplinary collaborations. This multidisciplinary method combined the work of composers like John Cage and David Tudor; visual artists Robert Rauschenberg, Jasper Johns, and Andy
F IG UR E 1. 1
Fabrications (2004). Merce Cunningham Dance Company. Photo © Tony Dougherty. Décor and costumes by Dove Bradshaw. Photo courtesy of The Merce Cunningham Trust.
17 COLLABORATION
occurred in the visual elements of the dance production as well, featuring artists creating different aspects of the production separate from one another, only bringing their work together for the production. Though Cunningham is the most famous practitioner
Review Questions 1. What are the key responsibilities of the Artistic Director? 2. What is the difference (if any) between a Composer and a Sound Designer?
of this method, his process had a profound impact
3. What is the Stage Manager’s main responsibility?
on modern dance and the avant-garde art world in
4. Describe some common sources of inspiration for
general. Many modern dancers and choreographers have embraced this method and collaborate in this fashion.
1.5 Chapter Review There are a number of people who collaborate to produce a dance performance. For most productions, artists from a number of different disciplines unite to bring their unique skills to the project. A true collaborator appreciates the contributions of each member of the production team and has a basic understanding of everyone’s responsibilities. It is common to find administration, dance artists,
creating a dance piece. 5. What type of collaborative model appeals to you the most as an artist, and why? Chapter 1 Project: Communicating an Idea People communicate in so many different ways. Sometimes the best method for communicating an artistic concept is through combining differing methods into one presentation. For this project, you will be asked to put yourself into the choreographer’s shoes and create a multimedia presentation to discuss your vision for a new dance
musical staff, design/tech personnel, and running
piece.
crew collaborating on a dance performance. The
Using your preferred type of presentation software
successful dance piece will center on the vision of
(PowerPoint, Keynote, Prezi, Google Presentation,
the choreographer with all of the team members
etc.) create a presentation that showcases your
contributing to the storytelling through their individual
vision for a new dance piece. It should include:
craft. There are many different approaches to the ways in which all of these people work together—as a dance company, freelance model, dance collective, or independent model—or various approaches that might be an amalgam of multiple methods. Understanding all of the information presented in this chapter gives you the tools necessary to begin an earnest examination of the process of dance production. Subsequent chapters will elaborate on these concepts and break down the production process in greater detail.
1. The title of your dance piece. 2. Visual inspiration for the concept. This could be photography, video, poetry, or anything that moves you. 3. Your concept: a brief (one paragraph) description of what your dance should communicate. 4. Three adjectives that best describe how you want your dance to feel. 5. A brief statement on how/if music will be integrated with your dance. 6. A brief statement on your thoughts related to design and how you envision it integrating with the dance.
18 THINKING AHEAD
This project should be a fun opportunity for you to start thinking about different methods of
I still have those impulses today. But my serious training commenced in NY at the age of 11.
communication. Be bold in your choices and have
How did you transition into choreography?
fun with it, especially if you are a non-dancer doing
In the 1970s my family would go to Lake Placid Club
this project. One of the most useful tools we have as artists is the ability to look at the world through someone else’s eyes, even for a moment. You might find that you learn something about yourself along the way.
The Choreographer’s Perspective: An Interview with Julia Gleich Julia K. Gleich is a choreographer, teacher, scholar, and mathematics aficionado. She is on the faculty at Trinity LABAN Conservatoire of Music and Dance (London, UK) and Head of Choreography at London Studio Centre. In addition, she is founding choreographer and director of Gleich Dances, a company seen throughout the United States and in the UK. In 2004, Ms. Gleich and Jason Andrew founded Norte Maar for Collaborative Projects in the Arts, with a mission to renew and refresh the exchange between the interdisciplinary arts. She is also a founder and director of Aegis Live Arts, creating unique locational dance works that enliven history and architecture in London. Her practicebased research on vectors and dance has been presented at the Laban International Conference in London, at the CORPS de Ballet International Conference, and published through the Dynamic Body in Space.
in NY (which no longer exists). There were ballroom dancing lessons offered and the teacher found out I did ballet. He suggested I make a small dance every week and perform it for the Champagne Dance on Wednesday nights. I remember one of the dances was to the Coppélia mazurka. After that I didn’t really choreograph again for many years. I assisted many choreographers and danced in companies, but it wasn’t until I went to grad school (for Arts Administration) that I finally began to consider myself a choreographer. I made my first work in a performance with artistic explorer Dara Paprock. But I wouldn’t call myself a choreographer until I was produced by the Joyce SoHo in NYC several years later. How do you begin the process of envisioning a dance? Every dance I make is different. But my favorite way to create is in collaboration. Dance ideas are everywhere. I have made pieces about memory, perception, and the brain; I made an interactive piece in London called Speak Easy Secrets. I have developed narrative ballets and abstract contemporary dances. Sometimes I begin by working on movement material or processes that interest me. Like Vectors, which is my own mathematical system for generating movement. Other times I might be working with a theme or developing movement for a site. Sometimes I’ll
When did you first start dancing?
take a classical idea and recontextualize it.
I lived in MN [Minnesota] when I first started taking classes.
Do you normally enter a dance with clear-cut ideas
My sister took class and I peered under the barre to watch.
for the design aspects or does that tend to come out of
I used to copy some of the exercises at home while my
discussion with the production team?
mom played the piano. Initially, I used to make up dances in the living room from the age of about seven to music like Deep Purple, Swan Lake, Emerson Lake and Palmer, Led Zeppelin and Coppélia. Rather an eclectic mix. I think
I love working with other artists. There are so many creative ideas that can go into a work of art and I welcome other views, contributions, and artistic motivations. The visual aspects of the work are developed over time in a similar
19 COLLABORATION
way to making dance. There is a lot of risk and uncertainty
your observations on some of the key differences you
in this process and it requires trust in not only your
notice in academic vs. professional dance work?
collaborators but also your own artistic ability to embrace
Professionals who have the luxury of long periods of
uncertainty. On occasions I have had a brief for designers, like Speak Easy Secrets in 2013. Sometimes the design is the brief and I generate ideas from it. Can you describe your ideal process for working with designers? I don’t have one. I am very free in my approach and don’t like to overly plan all the aspects of a work. I suppose that might be a problem for some designers, but it also might be an opportunity. I can create structure or can work with a designer’s structure. Each project is different. Some of the best were simply opportunistic. That is, we knew each other and each other’s work and we had some related ideas that we had developed and noticed that they came together beautifully. There are different stages of each creation. Some designs are made specifically for a dance; some are
experimentation with designers will be able to create amazing theatrical works of art. But that is a rare privilege. I think government-funded institutions with their own theatre (think Europe) have an advantage. But risk-taking and imagination are paramount; anything is possible anywhere. In student work I find that darkness is overused as a lighting technique to create drama. Perhaps as I get older I just want to be able to see the dancers. But darkness has become a bit cliché for me now. In set design I always remember the Noguchi sculptures that were featured in Martha Graham pieces; many of them small and simple and yet iconic. I think she had a great relationship with visual art, like Diaghilev and the Ballet Russes. Both the professional and the student should embrace visual art a
artistic creations in themselves and when brought to the
bit more.
dance magnify into a new artistic vision.
One interesting aspect of your professional work is
Do you have any training in design and/or technical
your international experience in dance. What are some
theatre? I was an electrician at Dance Theater Workshop in NYC for several years. I studied lighting design for a term. I have been a stage manager many times and this taught me a lot of what I know. Lighting design is incredibly elusive as an art to me. I have ideas that occasionally work but I rely on a lighting designer’s expertise to make them reality. In London, I oversee a design collaboration with my choreography students at London Studio Centre and design students from Central St. Martin’s College of Art and Design. Lighting is always the most difficult component of the design. Experience is probably the best teacher for a choreographer. The set designs and costumes seem to be
of the differences you notice in American dance as compared to your work in other countries? Ah, this is a difficult question. American dance can tend to be more virtuosic and yet America is the home of postmodern dance. There are so many different approaches. Perhaps what I like about American dance is that there is a better sense of risk-taking and a willingness to cross over into different forms. I think Europe/the UK is more isolating. The forms of dance are aligned in defined camps and there is less opportunity to produce your work independently and get an audience. NYC is the home of gigging (project-based work) in dance. There are lots of dancers who have had successful careers in NYC working
less mysterious.
with several different companies. I wish there was more of
I know you have experience in both academic and
and support each other. It’s just a little more fun there.
professional environments. Could you share some of
20 THINKING AHEAD
that in London. Dancers tend to share information in NYC
What training or life experience outside of dance
As a choreographer, is there a particular member of
have you found to have the most impact on your
the production team on whom you depend heavily for
choreography?
assistance?
I have had so many different experiences in dance. I
I think costume is where I need the most support. Recently,
didn’t think I was a choreographer until I choreographed
I had Tamara Gonzales design costumes and she was
my first full evening’s work. My collaborator and friend,
nominated for a Bessie (a NY Dance Award). I worry so
Jason Andrew, has been a strong influence in my work.
much about costume and often feel I leave it until the
He has a great eye, is a big risk-taker, and supports
end. I don’t always see costumes in my choreography, so
collaboration. The work that I think epitomizes my ideas
I can’t present my vision easily. It is such a relief when I
in dance, involving collaboration, lots of research and
have a confident designer. One of the best collaborations
experimentation and also pure dance was The Brodmann
I had was with Bernard Johnson in 1995 at the University
Areas (2012). It reflected all of the facets of my work.
of California—Irvine. His designs worked so well for the
Jason was the producer of this work, which utilized chance
dance, both in terms of the dancers’ movements and the
operations, poetry, projection, and ballet.
vision for the work. His use of color and fabric created contrasting sections of my dance with subtlety and simplicity.
21 COLLABORATION
CHAPTER 2 PRE-PRODUCTION PLANNING A goal without a plan is just a wish. Antoine de Saint-Exupéry
Akua Noni Parker and Anthony Bell of Alvin Ailey American Dance Theatre. Photography by Richard Calmes.
Most artists want their work to be seen by the public.
All of these scenarios listed above could affect the
This is true of dance, as in other art forms. With any
choices you make about the nature of your presentation
public performance comes an added responsibility
and what production elements are necessary for a
to the audience. Unless there is the understanding
successful performance. For better or worse, the
of your performance being a work in progress or an
expectations of an audience will dictate the success of a
informal event, patrons will have an expectation of
production and this should be considered as part of your
professional production elements to accompany their
planning.
dance concert (especially if your audience is paying to see the performance). No matter the size or scope of
What are You Trying to Accomplish?
the concert, you can be assured that the presentation
Not every concert should have the same outcomes
will be the result of many people collaborating to create
in mind. The nature of the performance should be
the performance. Planning is essential to the ultimate
dictated by the goals, though. This means that it is very
success of a live performance. This chapter touches
important to consider the desired outcomes from the
on some of the important questions that must be
beginning of the planning process in order to stay on
addressed in order to successfully produce a dance.
track. There are a number of different types of concerts
2.1 Purpose
that one could produce, each with different goals in mind. The formal concert is a presentation of dance
One of the most important questions that is too often
with accompanying production elements of costumes,
overlooked is, why are you producing a show in the
lighting, scenery, and sound. Audiences are sometimes
first place? Far too many artists get caught up in the
invited to see a work in progress or an invited showcase.
desire to present their work to the public before asking
Perhaps your concert is meant to be part of a larger
the hard question—why should someone come see my
artistic offering, like a dance festival or a summer
show? Like anything else, a dance concert should serve
arts program? Likewise, it could be a special event
a purpose. In determining your purpose, there are some
celebrating a specific occasion or theme. In academic
questions that you should ask of yourself to help clarify
circles, it is not uncommon to see an audience educated
your goals.
through (and even participate in) the presentation of
Who is My Audience?
a lecture-demonstration-style performance. All of these goals are legitimate reasons for producing a
This may seem like a simple question, but the answer
dance concert and each one presents its own unique
to this one question will shape your approach to all of
challenges to address.
the other concerns to follow. What type of people are coming to see your show? Is it primarily the family
2.2 Program Concerns
and friends of your dance company? Perhaps you are
Once the decision has been made to produce a dance
presenting in an educational venue, so the majority of
concert, there are a number of questions to address
your audience are students. Maybe your dance piece will
regarding the nature of the program itself. Many of
be presented at a dance conference and the audience
these questions will be directly related to the purpose of
will be comprised of professional dance colleagues.
the dance concert addressed earlier.
24 THINKING AHEAD
F I G UR E 2. 1
The lecture-demonstration is performance that is part presentation, part workshop, often seen in academic circles. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
What Type of Program?
Length of Concert?
One of the important questions to address is the
While there are no firm rules as to how long
nature of your dance presentation. Is it a single dance
a concert should be, there are some obvious
or multiple dances presented as a collage concert? Is
factors to consider related to the length of the
there a unifying theme behind the works presented?
presentation. The number of individual pieces in the
Once you know this, it will affect all of the following
concert will affect the overall length and structure. If
program concerns listed below.
there are multiple dances, then there must be sufficient
Number of Dance Pieces?
time between each number to allow for things like costume changes, manually changing the color of the
If you go with a collage concert, how many different
gels for side lighting, and adjusting scenery and props.
dances are to be included? Is there a time limit on
One cannot simply add up the length of each dance
the individual dances? Should there be a certain
piece and get an accurate representation of the length
predetermined composition (i.e. half of the pieces by
of concert.
professional choreographers and the other half from student work)?
25 PRE-PRODUCTION PLANNING
Intermission?
With that in mind, consider these basic rules of thumb
Another important consideration is the inclusion of an
for programming:
intermission in your dance concert. Most audiences
1.
Start with a light, enjoyable opener that engages
expect an intermission for anything longer than an
the audience’s attention. This both serves as
hour and fifteen minutes. Though it makes the overall
a “warm up” for the audience and allows for
time of the concert longer, there are a number of
latecomers to be seated within a relatively short
benefits to adding an intermission such as giving your
period of time (should your theatre allow for late seating).
audience a break to talk about what they have seen and allowing for more pieces to be included in the
2.
Whenever possible, try not to place dances back to
offering. One important consideration that should not
back that feature the same dancers. This will make
be overlooked is the revenue potential of concessions.
for a longer transition.
Most theatres make a sizable amount of their earnings
3.
Longer, esoteric dances should be placed early in
from concessions. Particularly if your dance company
the show order, so the audience is not mentally
owns a performance space, offering concessions at
and/or physically tired.
intermission is an excellent way to increase earnings without higher ticket prices.
Arrangement of Concert? One of the most important considerations for
4.
directly before intermission to encourage your audience to come back for your second half. 5.
dance. Dances with water require a cleaning/drying
arrangement of programming for the evening. There are
of the floor before another dance can safely occur.
a number of considerations, both artistic and practical,
In this case, placing it at the end of the concert is
that go into deciding the concert arrangement. Ideally,
wise. Fog and haze tend to fill up the space and
your audience will be in attendance for the entirety of
linger. Make sure that the following dance will
the concert. It is your responsibility to create for them
not be adversely affected by lingering fog effects
an evening that takes them on a satisfying artistic
before finalizing the show order. Dances with
journey. The selection and arrangement of pieces for
elaborate scenic changes might do well directly
the concert requires a familiarity with all of the dances
before or after intermission, or as the final piece of
presented and some thought about where each dance concert is to think of it like a story or an album, creating
the concert. 6.
program the second act of your concert in keeping
On the practical side, one must make sure to check cast The goal should be facilitating a quick and effective
If you have one intermission, your second half should be shorter in length. Likewise, try to
a presentation with a logical beginning, middle, and end. lists and the technical requirements for each dance.
Always consider the technical requirements of a dance piece and how they affect the subsequent
assembling a dance concert is the variety and
would best fit. One common approach to arranging a
Try to include something upbeat and exciting
with the rules discussed above. 7.
Consider that the final dance of the concert is in
transition between each dance, eliminating long waits
a position most likely to hold onto the audience’s
between each dance number and organizing the dances
memory and, as such, you want it to be one of the
in such a way as to best keep the audience’s interest.
most memorable. Fast-paced, high-energy, visually
26 THINKING AHEAD
stimulating dances are a good choice for the final
7. What type of equipment is included and/or available with use of the space?
dance.
2.3 Performance Space Concerns
8. Are house technicians included with the rental fee and, if not, are your company members allowed to
The choice of a performance space affects many aspects of the dance performance. Depending on the type of space, certain varieties of staging might be
use the equipment in the space? 9. Is the theatre a union house (stagehands and/or musicians)? If so, how does this affect your choices:
required or limited. In addition, there are a number of
staffing, schedules, union contracts, live vs. pre-
practical concerns related to your choice of space that will affect other areas (i.e. budget, schedule, personnel, etc.). Included below is a list of questions that should
recorded music, etc. 10. Is there any information the space needs from the dance company regarding the performance?
be addressed in order to make sure you are making an informed decision regarding your performance space. For those working in academic settings, your performance space may be a given. Even if you have a space assigned to you, though, it is important to consider the same types of questions. Unless you are lucky enough to have a dedicated dance theatre, a dance program will often find itself performing in a space primarily used by and for the theatre program. In these instances, misunderstandings frequently arise regarding the appropriate use of a space—sometimes produced by rules about which the visiting dance company is completely unaware. One way to address this is to make sure to ask the right questions regarding space usage before going into the performance space.
Once you have addressed these questions, undoubtedly other information will arise from these conversations. Never be afraid to ask questions. It is always best to go into a project with answers, rather than assume that your expectations are the norm.
2.4 Production Calendar One of the most important considerations for any type of show is the production calendar. The calendar will affect every other aspect of the production from personnel to budget and even casting. In all likelihood, the production calendar and performance space will be determined concurrently as the selection of one affects the other. You should have a good idea of your ideal performance dates in mind when negotiating
1. How do you secure permission to use the space?
with a performance space. Once you have secured the
2. What is the fee for using the space?
actual dates, though, creating a production calendar is
3. What amenities are included with the space (and is
a relatively simple process of counting back from the
this for an additional fee)? 4. What are the front-of-house arrangements (box office, house management, ushers, ticket profits, publicity support, etc.)? 5. Is there a green room and/or dressing rooms in the
date and establishing important deadlines. Listed below are some basic guidelines for a production timetable, though you may find that some components need to be tweaked in order to match your expectations.
Six Months to One Year Prior to Opening
space? ●●
Create production budget and begin securing funds.
●●
Determine the choreographer(s) and number of
6. What type of staging is possible in the performance space?
pieces in your performance.
27 PRE-PRODUCTION PLANNING
●●
Secure the performance space and rehearsal space.
it will appear in the performance. Should designers
●●
Determine needs for publicity, ticket sales, and
not get the opportunity to personally attend a
house staff (this may change for each different
designer run, it is a good idea for choreographers
performance space, based on what resources are
to video the performance for the designer to watch.
available to you).
For that matter, the savvy designer may well want
Hire designers and agree on a timetable of mutually
to video the design run as a personal reference.
●●
This ensures that he/she will have an opportunity to
agreed upon benchmarks (date for designer runs,
observe the dance multiple times before going into
date for design drawings, design presentations, etc.).
Three to Four Months Prior to Opening ●●
Begin production meetings with designers, choreographers, and other production staff. A production meeting is an opportunity for all of the production team to meet and discuss pertinent elements to the production. Ideally everyone should participate in these meetings (artistic director, choreographer, designers, stage manager,
tech.
One Week Prior to Opening The period leading up to opening is frequently referred to as Tech Week, even if it is not necessarily a full week in duration. During this period, a number of events occur in preparation for the opening night of your dance performance. ●●
Load-in: At some point before opening, you will need
production manager), since decisions made in
to move all of your equipment and supplies into the
one area might affect another production area. In
performance space to prepare for the show. Your
professional settings, it is not uncommon to find
schedule will vary from company to company, but it
production members “calling in” via a computer
is fairly common to load-in a week prior to opening.
videoconference application such as Skype, Apple’s
This process typically involves laying the dance
FaceTime, or Google Hangouts. The frequency of
floor, hanging and focusing lights, assembling any
production meetings is determined by the needs of the dance company.
scenery, setting up sound, and bringing in costumes. ●●
Cueing sessions: Designers must have sufficient
●●
Schedule auditions and rehearsals.
time alone in the space to write and test their cues.
●●
Determine the number of technicians needed for
Sound designers need to hear the music in the
technical aspects of the performance and hire, as
space in order to set the appropriate levels for a
necessary.
performance. Lighting designers will also benefit
Determine the tech schedule for the production,
from cueing in the performance space. This is when
●●
including all pertinent information, such as load-in; lighting hang and focus; laying the dance floor; cueing sessions; sound checks; tech runs for each dance piece, etc.
Two Weeks to One Month Prior to Opening ●●
Schedule designer runs. These are rehearsals for designers to attend and watch a run of the dance, as
28 THINKING AHEAD
a video from the designer run comes in handy. By using the video, a lighting designer can write cues that match the specific timing of the dance piece before the tech period. This process may involve only the designers or choreographers might be invited as well. There are benefits and disadvantages to both methods.
F I G UR E 2. 2
Technicians laying a dance floor.
●●
Paper tech: Some dance companies incorporate a time for the designers and stage manager to meet before going into tech and discuss the placement of cues within the context of the individual dances. This process, called a paper tech, is a luxury that many companies cannot afford, but it is useful to help familiarize the stage manager with the process of calling the cues. If a paper tech is not possible it is always advantageous to set some time apart at the beginning of the first technical rehearsal for the designers and stage manager to meet and discuss cues.
F IG UR E 2. 3
A lighting designer writing cues.
29 PRE-PRODUCTION PLANNING
familiarize themselves with the stage at a slower
FYI: To the Dancer in Tech
pace or with less energy than a full-out run. In
For many dancers, tech week will be the only time
theatre, these first rehearsals are referred to as
in which they will be involved with the designers and
a cue-to-cue (sometimes abbreviated at Q2Q).
technicians of the production. While the rehearsal
This type of rehearsal moves from one cue to
and performance process is essential to the ultimate
the next, allowing the director and designers to
success of the show, it is important to recognize the
see and hear how the individual cues work with a
crucial role played by the designers and technicians
moment onstage. Once the cue has been worked
and to respect their process. During tech week, it
out, the stage manager calls “hold” and everyone
is helpful to understand that there will be a lot of
moves forward in the script to the next location of
“hurry up and wait.” Dancers should arrive at least 15 minutes before their call time and be ready to
a cue. ●
go at the start of the time slot, but understand
For dance, this process is difficult to reproduce, since it is harder to hold dancers and have them
that there may be a lot of start and stop during
move forward to a point in the dance with all of the
the initial technical rehearsals. Keep conversation
music and movement aligning seamlessly. Dance
with other dancers onstage to a bare minimum and
frequently employs a spacing rehearsal in which
always be aware of what’s happening onstage while
the dancers “mark” the performance. Marking is a
waiting in the wings. Likewise, this is the first time
dance term that refers to running through the dance
designers and choreographer will see the dance
at the appropriate timing, but with less energy than
in show conditions, so dancers should try to keep
running “full-out.” When marking, it is common to
conversation and questions with the choreographer
avoid complicated lifts or certain movement sections
limited to things that strictly affect the performance.
that may be physically taxing on the dancers. During
This is not a rehearsal slot, but a very small window
the spacing run, the designers and choreographers
of time in which numerous production elements have
get the opportunity to watch how the dancers
to come together.
interact with the design elements and to make
Many young dancers may not understand the
adjustments, as necessary. It is also common in the
importance of this process and inadvertently bog
spacing rehearsal for designers to work closely with
down the tech rehearsal period. Keep in mind to
the stage manager so he/she better understands
always listen to the stage manager, as he/she is in control of the stage and when things should occur. The role of the dancer in tech is to perform the role and choreography as accurately as possible. If everyone respects these rules of thumb, tech rehearsals can be an enjoyable process.
when to call cues. ●●
Technical rehearsal: The subsequent rehearsals following spacing are typically referred to as technical rehearsals. These rehearsals have the dancers running full-out with all of the technical elements incorporated. It is not uncommon during these rehearsals to stop in order to tweak a moment,
●●
Spacing rehearsal/cue-to-cue: Once the dancers
but the goal is to give the stage manager and
arrive in the space, it is a good idea to start off with
dancers ample time to run the show with the dance
a rehearsal that allows them the opportunity to
and technical elements combined.
30 THINKING AHEAD
●●
performance space to guarantee you are leaving the
Dress rehearsal: Dress rehearsals are the rehearsals
space in the expected condition.
in which everything is run under show conditions, with all technical elements in place. In addition, it is
●
previously, assessment is an important aspect of
costume changes, pre-show music, changing over
any production process. Many dance companies and
gels on the lights between dance pieces, etc. Only
academic programs include a meeting following
when considering all of these elements can you truly
the completion of the production referred to as a
know the running time of your show.
postmortem in which the production team members
It is also common to find that dress rehearsals are
and staff discuss the entire process and honestly
used for documenting the dance, either through
comment on what things were successful and how it
photography or video. In the theatre world, it is
could be improved for future productions. While this
common to have a photo call, a separate time
is a luxury for many professional organizations, it is
assigned specifically for getting posed photographs
an important aspect for improvement.
This process is less common for dance, since the
2.5 Production Budget
nature of dance is movement and frozen poses tend
Another important element of pre-production planning
to eliminate the kinetic nature desired in dance
is determining your budget. No matter the complexity
photography. Whether there is a separate photo call
of your performance, there will always be some level
or not, it is important to schedule a time specifically
of expenses incurred. It is essential to plan for these
for documenting the dance. For designers and
up front and create a realistic budget that accounts
choreographers alike, the documentation of the work
for both sources of revenue and expenses. If you are a
is an essential component for portfolios. Likewise,
professional dance company, everyone who contributes
the dance company will often use photos and video
to your production will need some sort of compensation.
for marketing/publicity purposes.
In addition, there are many other areas to consider,
Opening night: Opening night is the first performance
such as accompaniment costs, equipment rental fees,
of your dance. Frequently, there might be a reception
expendables (i.e. gels, lamps for lighting instruments,
to accompany the opening in which the dancers
etc.), space rental, transportation costs, publicity,
mingle with the patrons or sponsors. Events such as
printing costs, and more.
this are particularly useful in establishing a donor base. ●●
Postmortem (assessment): As mentioned
useful to consider the impact of all elements such as
(where the actors freeze in place for the photo).
●●
●●
Before you can contract designers or dancers, you need to have a good idea of the amount of funds available for
Strike: The final performance of the dance is
your performance. Consider anticipated ticket sales,
typically followed by strike, sometimes referred
funding reserves, external grants, funds provided
to as load-out. Though this event is often reserved
by student activity fees (if you are in an academic
for the design/tech production members, it is not
environment), or donations provided by patrons. All of
uncommon to have dancers assisting (especially in
these funds make up your available revenue for the
an academic environment). Strike is when all of the
performance or season. While it should go without
design elements are returned to their original state
saying, there is a danger in estimating funds before they
before load-in. Always make sure to check with the
actually are in hand. Just because you have traditionally
31 PRE-PRODUCTION PLANNING
sold tickets doesn’t mean you won’t have a bad year.
2.7 Chapter Review
Just because you have applied for a grant does not
No matter the scope of a dance performance, it is
mean you will receive it. Many an arts organization has had the nasty realization that they have incurred more debt than available funds. Always try to be realistic in creating your budget. After you have a good idea of your available production funds, you can determine how best to allocate the funds to various expenses. If you have produced dance performances in the past, you are likely to have a good idea of resources and artists in your area and their typical costs. If this is your first time, try to make contact with arts organizations of a similar size and mission to see how they approach
obvious that there is a great deal of planning that must go into any successful endeavor. A successful dance company understands its own mission in the context of its target audience. Once the decision has been made to produce a dance performance, the task of planning deals with both the artistic side and the management aspects. One must consider the performance space in addition to budgeting, schedule, and hiring personnel. Though the prospect of taking on so many details may seem daunting at first, the rewards far outweigh the initial frustrations.
the task.
2.8 The production manager’s perspective: An interview with Stacey-Jo Marine.
2.6 Personnel
Stacey-Jo Marine is a production manager/stage
As mentioned in Chapter 1, there are a number of
manager with experience in some of the top companies
different people involved in the process of bringing a dance to the stage. One of the important preproduction considerations is securing all of the individuals necessary for accomplishing your project. Depending on the scope of your performance, you may find that the list is small or incredibly large. Whether you are a professional dance company, independent contractor, or an educational entity it is important to have all personnel sign an agreement that makes clear the expectations of their position and what will be provided to them as compensation for their hard work. These letters of agreement should always cover the essential information, such as the individual’s name and job title, the dance organization, the duties/ expectations, compensation (if provided), specific
and academic programs in the entertainment industry. She has worked in over 30 countries and all 50 states touring with dance and theatre companies including Paul Taylor Dance Company, STOMP, Dar-A-Luz (Tight, Right, White), Richard Move’s Martha @ series, Lisa Giobbi Movement Theatre and Ballet NY. In NYC she has been the production stage manager for Maureen Fleming, Theodora Skipitares, En Garde Arts (Stonewall 25 and J.P. Morgan Saves the Day), Cortez & Co., American Ballet Theatre Studio Company, Dance by Neil Greenberg and Youth America Grand Prix. Ms. Marine is the production coordinator for the Conservatory of Dance at Purchase College and director of production for Martha Graham Dance Company. She has been at Purchase since August 2, where she also teaches dance
dates of employment, and specific employee policies/
production, stage management and lighting for dance.
workplace procedures, as necessary. It is a good
Do you have any background in dance beyond the
idea to provide the contract to a lawyer for review to ensure you are complying with labor laws in your state and that you are not accidentally making yourself legally liable.
32 THINKING AHEAD
design/tech aspects? No. My interest in dance began when I saw the Martha Graham Dance Company performing for Ms. Graham’s
memorial service in 1991 at City Center Theater in New
supervisor for Martha Graham Center of Contemporary
York City. I was already working as a stage manager Off-
Dance?
Broadway. I had a very little experience (watching dance
I am a commodity—all of my skills are available to my
in musical theatre) but that is all. The Graham memorial service was such an inspiration to me that I immediately wanted to start working in the field. Can you explain to the readers the “typical” job description of a production manager for a dance company? The production manager is usually the liaison between the venue and the company. The PM produces the technical schedule and the hanging schedule. The PM is also the liaison to the other company production staff—these duties include forwarding tech specs to the staff and pointing out anything out of the ordinary. The PM calls production meetings—company administrators and production staff get together for these meetings. Lastly the PM often also
employer. If not first hand (creating a new prop), then as a supervisor (hiring someone to get the work done). One of the fascinating things about your career is the balance between professional and academic roles. What are some of the key differences you notice in academic vs. professional dance work? In academia, it is typical to have an entire crew of dance students. It is very important to prepare the students and teach them the value of this work to make them better DANCERS. In a professional situation, I do not expect to have to coax the crew or coach them. Donuts help break the ice in all situations. I know you have worked internationally on a number
serves as the production stage manager.
of dance productions. Tell us a bit about that and if
I know you served as the production stage manager for
international work?
Paul Taylor Dance Company for a number of years. How does the role of a production manager differ from that of production stage manager? A production stage manager calls the shows. How does the nature of the job change for a touring production vs. a more residential production? I treat all performances like they are touring productions. I always make sure costumes, scenery/props, music, and lighting will be taken care of and ready for the load-in and
there were differences you noticed in American vs. Each country has its own work rituals, customs, and personalities. One commonality usually occurs when a crew is union (American, Greek, German, et al.). Union crews are generally more professional, experienced, and well organized. One interesting thing is that many stages are still raked in Europe. Summer festivals are difficult all over the world (including the States) because the company must fit into a house repertory plot and lighting has to be done after sunset.
then performance. I know you have a lot of experience in stage management, props, and lighting. How does that experience factor into your job as production
33 PRE-PRODUCTION PLANNING
CHAPTER 3 PERFORMANCE SPACES The stage is a concrete physical place which asks to be filled, and to be given its own concrete language to speak. Antonin Artaud
Student dancers from Eastern Michigan University’s production of Hope that Lines Don’t Cross. Choreography by Erik Abbott-Main. Lighting Design by Jeromy Hopgood. Photo courtesy Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
Just as the painter uses a canvas to bring a work of art
designer alike have a working understanding of a wide
to life, so too the performer utilizes an empty space to
variety of performance spaces and their features. The
tell a story. To borrow a bit more from the metaphor of
following chapter introduces a number of different
the painter, different types of paper affect the style of
types of performance spaces and discusses some of the
painting that can be created on them. The same is true
inherent strengths and challenges of each type.
of performance spaces. The performance space and, in particular, the relationship of the audience to the stage
3.1 Proscenium Theatres
drastically affect how the audience can participate in
The most popular type of theatre for dance
the performance. The same dance seen in two different
performances is the proscenium stage. The proscenium
theatres (especially when seen from different vantage
is a theatre in which the audience sits in front of
points) can feel completely different to your audience.
the stage and watches the show through a picture
Likewise, each theatre is different and comes with its
frame opening, referred to as the proscenium arch
own unique variety of equipment and features. Some
(Figure 3.1). Though the proscenium arch is typically
performances might work quite well in a proscenium
rectangular in shape, it can be square as well. One
theatre, but not function at all in the round. For these
reason for the popularity of this type of theatre space
reasons, it is essential that both choreographer and
is that it places the audience in a good position to
F I G UR E 3. 1
The proscenium arch is the “picture frame” through which the audience watches the action.
36 THINKING AHEAD
watch the dancers’ bodies in a silhouette form,
to understanding how dancers must interact with their
highlighted against the theatre’s backdrop. In addition,
space is called stage directions.
the proscenium staging allows the audience to enjoy the performance without having to see the backstage
Stage Directions
trappings, such as the lighting instruments.
When referring to one’s position on the stage, giving movement directions can get confusing. A
The Stage
dancer onstage is facing the opposite direction to
No matter the type of theatre, one element remains
the choreographer in the auditorium, meaning their
constant—there is an area of the theatre separated
directions are all reversed. To address this problem,
from the audience upon which the performance takes
those in the theatre refer to movements in terms of
place. This is referred to as the stage. Though stages
stage directions. In stage directions, all directions are
come in a variety of sizes and shapes, they share a
relative to the person standing on stage. When looking
number of similar attributes. One important concept
at the stage from a bird’s eye view, the stage is split into nine separate areas (Figure 3.2). Everything to the right third of the stage (from the dancer’s perspective) is referred to as stage right. Everything to the left third of the stage is referred to as stage left, and the center third of the stage is called center stage. Adding to basic right and left, the stage is also divided into three areas that describe the dancer’s proximity to the audience. The third of the stage closest to the audience is referred to
-
-
UP.51A6f RlbHI
UP.51A6f Cfr..JifR
UP.51A6f Lff=l
as downstage. The center third is once more called center stage, while the area furthest away from the audience is referred to as upstage. Looking at Figure 3.2, you can see how the combination of these terms create the division
Cfr-.JifR .5-rMf RlbHI
cr:r,rrr:R .5-rA!:£ C£:1\JiE::R
C£:1\JiE::R .51A6.£: L£:~1
of the stage into nine areas commonly referred to as: downstage right, downstage center, downstage left, center stage right, center stage center, center stage left, upstage right, upstage center, upstage left.
POWr-,J.51A6f POWI\I.51A6.f RlbHI Ctl\lltR
POWI\I .51A6.f Lf~l
In addition to these basic directions, there are a few other terms that are handy in communicating movement on the stage. When the dancer moves from the perimeter towards the center of the stage, this is referred to as moving onstage. Likewise, moving from
F IG UR E 3. 2
The breakdown of stage directions, as seen from above. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
37 PERFORMANCE SPACES
an area away from the center of the stage is referred to
an imaginary line that runs from right to left, aligned
as moving offstage.
with the upstage edge of the proscenium arch. This reference line is indicated as a consistent dashed line
Stage Coordinate System
on a ground plan. The point at which the centerline is
When looking at a proscenium stage, we use two
bisected by the proscenium line is the 0,0 coordinate for
imaginary lines known as the centerline (or CL) and the
measuring object placement on the stage.
proscenium line to establish a system of coordinates used for measuring the placement of objects on the
When looking at proscenium stages, the stage might protrude out far past the proscenium line towards the
stage (see Figure 3.3).
audience, or it might end close to the proscenium arch.
The centerline is an imaginary line that runs upstage
If there is an area of the stage that extends downstage
to downstage from the back wall of the stage through
of the proscenium line, this is referred to as the apron.
the back wall of the auditorium, bisecting the space in
Sometimes, the apron is also built on an elevator or
half. In a ground plan (a drafting of the theatre from
has a removable stage deck to reveal an area beneath
a bird’s eye view), this reference line is indicated by a
the stage level. This area of the stage is frequently
specific dashed line: long, short, long. The proscenium
reserved for the orchestra, when a musical ensemble
line (sometimes referred to as the Plaster Line) is
accompanies the dance (Figure 3.4). In this situation,
PRo.5C(I\JIUM ARCH
PRo.5C(I\JIUM PRo.5C(I\JIUM PRo.5C(I\JIUM F I G UR E 3. 3
The proscenium line and centerline are imaginary points used to establish stage coordinates.
AUI/IIORIUM
Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
38 THINKING AHEAD
F I G UR E 3. 4
The former New York State Theater (now the David H. Koch Theater) at Lincoln Center. The orchestra pit is located between the stage and auditorium. Photo courtesy of David Shankbone.
this area of the stage is referred to as the orchestra pit
the majority of the audience and which locations are
or sometimes just “the pit.”
ideal for staging pivotal moments of the performance.
Traps
In order to determine just how much of the stage can be seen from the audience, designers use the audience
One of the many ways in which scenery or even dancers
seats located on the outside aisles and closest to the
can make a “magical” appearance on the stage is
stage. These positions are referred to as the extreme
through the use of trap doors in the stage floor. Many
sightlines, because they are the audience seats that
stages are equipped with panels in the stage floor that
see into the backstage area more than any other and
can be removed to create a trap door for special entry of
are looking at the stage from an extreme side angle.
effects. The area beneath the stage into which the trap
When staging a dance, it is important to walk through
doors open is referred to as the trap room.
the audience and watch the performance from these
Sightlines The term sightline refers to the unobstructed view of the stage from an audience member’s perspective. The sightline for each seat in the audience is slightly different from those around them. It is important for the choreographer and designer alike to have a good understanding of how much of the stage is visible to
locations to ensure your audience is not missing out on an important aspect of the dance. Figure 3.5 shows a ground-plan view of a theatre that indicates the stage and audience placement. In addition, it includes the symbol for extreme sightlines (the circle with a cross bisecting it). In looking at this illustration, the dotted lines extending from the extreme sightlines
39 PERFORMANCE SPACES
indicate the amount of the stage and backstage that
the area to either side of the stage, called the wings,
can be seen from the vantage point of that theatre seat.
is where lighting instruments are placed on tall poles
Since the back wall of the theatre is in the sightlines for
called booms in order to get side lighting for the
all audience members, many theatres utilize a backdrop
dancers’ bodies. While it can create an interesting visual
curtain called a cyclorama. This is described in detail
effect to see into the stage trappings, the audience
later in the chapter (see Figure 3.9).
should not always have to see what is located in these areas. For this reason, it is common to use curtains to
Masking
hide the areas of the stage you do not want the audience
When creating a space for performance, there are
to see. This process (as well as the curtains themselves)
undoubtedly aspects of the location that are best
is referred to as masking. When masking off the stage,
hidden away from the audience’s view. For instance,
there are some specific types of draperies used for the
the backstage area of a theatre is frequently a location
stage.
for scenic storage or lighting instruments. In dance,
The Grand Drape The grand drape, sometimes referred to as the main rag, is the main curtain that masks off the stage from the audience (Figure 3.6). This curtain runs the entire space of the proscenium and far enough into the wings
cYcLoRAMA
so that even the extreme sightlines cannot see around it. There are a number of different types of grand drapes, but they all have some elements in common. cYcLoRAMA cYcLoRAMA
cYcLoRAMA cYcLoRAMA
The grand drape is typically made of a heavyweight plush fabric called velour. In addition, the curtain typically has fullness sewn into it—meaning the fabric has pleats sewn into it, giving the curtain a rippled look which gives it more surface area and visual depth to catch light and create shadows. Since the grand drape fills the entire proscenium opening, it must move in some way for the audience to see the show. There are a number of different methods of rigging a curtain to open, but the two most common methods are for the curtain to move up or to open from the center. A curtain that raises or closes in the vertical plane is called a guillotine, whereas a traveller is a curtain with a split down the center in which the two F IG UR E 3. 5
Extreme sightlines. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
40 THINKING AHEAD
F I G UR E 3. 6
sides slide horizontally away from one another. For
The grand drape is a common drapery element used for dance productions.
dance concerts, it is a common practice to close the grand drape between each separate dance piece in the
Photo courtesy of Dilly Boase.
show.
Legs As you move upstage of the grand drape, there are a series of curtains used to mask off the audience’s view into the wings. These curtains, called legs, are tall and typically made of a black or neutral dark-colored fabric (Figure 3.7).
Borders A border is a fabric curtain hung overhead of the stage to mask off the audience’s view of lighting instruments or scenery that might be flown overhead. Typically, a border and set of two legs will be used in conjunction with the border slightly downstage of the two legs (Figure 3.7).
Blackout Curtain Sometimes, a dance calls for a black backdrop to create a stark contrast to the dancers on stage. In these instances, a blackout curtain is an ideal choice. A blackout curtain is typically a full-stage black masking
PROSCENIUM
PROSCENIUM
CYCLORAMA
AUDITORIUM
F I G UR E 3. 7
A view of the theatre from the side. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
PROSCENIUM
41 PERFORMANCE SPACES
curtain with no fullness made of black velour. Since it is black and a smooth surface, there is nothing to bounce light off and the background is a smooth neutral black.
Scrim Scrim is a type of gauze-like fabric with an open weave (Figure 3.8). Many theatres have a full-stage scrim curtain as part of their inventory. The scrim is used to create interesting visual effects. Because of its screenlike nature, when a light is shone on the front of a scrim, it looks solid. When the lights on the front side of a scrim are lowered, though, and it is lit from behind, the material becomes semi-transparent, giving a hazy, ghost-like appearance to anything seen through it. This means that a scrim could be used in a dance to create a special effect in which dancers behind the scrim could “magically” appear.
Cyclorama/Sky Drop The last element of masking for a stage is a covering of the upstage wall of the theatre. Most theatres use a large, light blue or light grey fabric drop called a sky drop. In older theatres, the back wall of the theatre was a concave, wrap-around wall with a plaster covering called a cyclorama. Over the years, most people began
F IG UR E 3. 9
The blue background for this image is a cyclorama illuminated with blue lighting. Photography by Richard Calmes.
referring to the sky drop as a cyclorama, or “cyc” for short. The cyclorama is used as a neutral backdrop that F I G UR E 3. 8
can be lit by lighting fixtures to create a colored wash of
The open weave of the scrim allows for invariant lighting effects.
a background. These lighting fixtures are typically hung above the cyc and positioned on the floor pointing up as well. This gives the opportunity for the lighting designer to mix multiple colors of light on the cyc (Figure 3.9).
Ground Row The ground row is an additional element of masking used for covering up the lighting fixtures positioned on the floor for lighting the cyc (Figure 3.7). Typically, the ground row is a simple series of small boards (around 1´ in height) attached to the floor, just downstage of the
42 THINKING AHEAD
F IG UR E 3. 10
A plan view of the stage showing in-betweens. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
cYcLoRAMA
lighting instruments. These boards are painted black or another neutral color matching the floor to hide the lighting instruments and cabling at the base of the
-
SR lt\1-1
SL lt\1-l
SL lt\1-1
cyclorama.
Dependable Dependable
Dependable Dependable
-
SR lt\1-l
SL lt\1-?
In-betweens One important concept related to the dance stage is the “in” or “in-between.” An in-between is the location between the theatre’s legs. When looking at the stage in a plan view, in-betweens are labeled as either stage right or stage left and numbered from downstage to upstage (Figure 3.10). Sometimes, in-betweens are referred to simply as “ins” (as in Stage Right In-1, Stage Right In-2). In dance design, the in-betweens are also the location of lighting booms, used for side lighting the dancers.
Counterweight Systems Many theatres are equipped with a method for handling scenery in the air, “flying” it overhead to be hidden out of sight until it needs to be seen. This counterweight system utilizes a steel grid placed over the stage upon which is placed a system of pulleys. Beneath the grid is a collection of overhead pipes hung parallel to the proscenium. These pipes are suspended from wire cables that go up through the pulleys on the grid, allowing for scenic elements (or sometimes even people) to be “flown” overhead of the stage. Every theatre does not have a counterweight system, but it is such a common element that it is important to familiarize yourself with their function. Figure 3.11 illustrates a counterweight system in the theatre. F IG UR E 3. 11
The primary components of a theatrical fly system: A) batten, B) aircraft cables, C) loft blocks, D) head block, E) arbor and stage weights, F) tension block, G) rope lock, H) purchase line. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
43 PERFORMANCE SPACES
The Fly Loft
to balance out the load of scenery added to the batten
Flying scenery requires a large amount of space
(Figure 3.12). The purpose of the arbor is to allow for
above the stage. This area, referred to as the fly loft, should typically be two and a half times taller than the proscenium opening in order to fly the scenery above
“counterweighting” with an identical weight to balance out the load, thereby making the task of lifting hundreds of pounds of scenery a simple matter of pulling on one
the vertical sightlines of the first row of the audience.
rope. The lift line is tied to the top of the arbor, with
Grid
line. The purchase line loops down through a block
A grid is a series of steel pipes suspended in the upper
at the bottom of the system called a tension block
portion of the fly loft, used for securing pulleys for the counterweight system. The grid includes a series of I-beams running parallel to the proscenium. These I-beams are used to support another series of steel
another rope tied to the bottom called the purchase
(sometimes called the foot block) and is redirected back up through the head block to once more attach to the top of the arbor. In this way, the purchase line is one big loop attached to the arbor so that pulling down on the
bars running perpendicular to the proscenium, thus creating the grid. At key locations across the grid, there are a collection of pulleys called the loft blocks, used to guide the cables that help in flying scenery.
Batten The batten is a steel pipe that is hung horizontally and used to lift the load of scenery. Attached to the batten are sections of wire cables called lift lines that travel vertically up through the wells and into a loft block to be redirected to a head block on one side of the stage. As seen in Figure 3.11, the blocks in a counterweight system are used to change the direction of the lift line from vertical to horizontal, and then back to vertical.
Linesets The collection of lift lines attached to a batten is referred to as a lineset. The number of lift lines on a lineset is related to the size of a proscenium opening. Wider stages might have five to six lift lines, whereas smaller ones might only have three to four.
Arbor The component of the counterweight system for which it gets its name is the arbor. An arbor is a specially designed rack upon which stage weights can be added
44 THINKING AHEAD
FIG UR E 3.12
Arbors with stage weights.
rope makes the arbor go up (and the batten go down)
level, the arbor will be positioned at the top of the fly
and vice versa.
loft, just below the head blocks. Because of this, most
Lock Rail
counterweight systems have a balcony level positioned near the top of the fly loft, called the loading gallery
The lock rail is a level of the counterweight system that
(Figure 3.14). This area is used for loading stage weights
features a line lock, a simple lever for locking down
onto the arbors to counterweight the amount added to a
movement of the purchase line and, in conjunction,
batten. As a result, stage weights are also stored at this
the batten (Figure 3.13). These locks might be located
level for easy access.
at the floor level or at a position above floor level. This is the location from which the flymen operate the
Audience Seating
counterweight system, unlocking the line lock, flying the
There are a number of different components that affect
scenery, and then locking it back into place for safety.
the audience’s performance experience, but one of the
Loading Gallery
most significant is seating. This directly relates to how
One final point of interest for the counterweight system is how stage weights are added to the arbor, or more to the point where the weight is added. Since scenery is always added when the batten is at stage
F I G UR E 3. 1 3
F IG UR E 3. 14
A lock rail located at the floor level of the stage.
A loading gallery, with weights stored along the walkway.
45 PERFORMANCE SPACES
much of the stage an audience member can see and
level is often at a steep incline, so as to allow the
from what angle, in addition to their proximity to other
audience members to look down on the stage. While
audience members around them. When discussing a
the audience can get relatively close to the action
theatre space, there are some common terms with
from a balcony, keep in mind this will mean looking
which one should be familiar.
down on a production that was meant to be seen at eye-level.
In basic terms, the area of a theatre where the audience sits is referred to as the auditorium. In a proscenium
●●
Italian mezzano meaning “middle.” In theatrical
theatre, the auditorium is placed directly in front of the
terminology, this refers to the lowest balcony of the
proscenium arch. Some theatres may have only one
theatre (if there are more than one) or sometimes
large seating area of the auditorium, while others may
the front rows of the theatre’s balcony.
have different sections of the auditorium with audience seating. The following list indicates some common
Mezzanine: Mezzanine is a term derived from the
●●
Box seats: In some theatres, particularly those built
divisions of the auditorium, while Figure 3.15 includes
before the twentieth century, balconies may wrap
visual examples:
around the sides of the auditorium and extend all
●●
Orchestra: The part of the auditorium on the main floor and closest to the stage. Sitting roughly halfway back in the middle of the orchestra guarantees an excellent view of the stage and dancers.
●●
the way to the sides of the proscenium. These seats are referred to as box seats (also known as loge). While they may seem glamorous seats to some, the box seats are often the worst vantage point for a dance show, as it gives a direct line of sight into
Balcony: A balcony is an upper floor of seating in a
the backstage and makes for a distorted view of the
theatre that protrudes out above the main floor. This
action.
ORC\-lESTRA
STAGE STAGE
ORC\-lESTRA
STAGE
ORC\-lESTRA F I G UR E 3. 1 5
Divisions of the auditorium.
ORC\-lESTRA ORC\-lESTRA
Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
46 THINKING AHEAD
Typically, it is those seats closest to the stage and on
There are a number of different theatre types that make
the main level that cost the most, whereas those further
for interesting dance spaces, though each one presents
away or in the balcony areas of the auditorium are less
its own unique set of challenges for dance.
expensive. This is why some theatres feature an area of the orchestra referred to as premium seats, the first
Thrust Theatres
few rows of the orchestra closest to the stage, for a
The thrust is another type of stage configuration. A
higher ticket cost. Interestingly enough, though, most
thrust stage (sometimes called ¾ round, or theatre in
avid theatregoers prefer to sit a bit further back, as the
the round) is primarily defined by its relationship to the
front seats mean looking up at the stage and possibly
audience. In a thrust space, the stage is thrust forth into
missing some of the action as dancers move upstage.
the audience, with seating positioned on three sides
3.2 Non-proscenium Theatres
of the stage (Figure 3.16). While the thrust stage can have many different shapes, one of the most common
While the proscenium theatre is one of the most popular
resembles an octagon cut in half. Since the audience is
types of theatre space for dance, it is by no means the
incredibly close to the stage, this type of theatre makes
only type of theatre in which a dance can be staged.
for an intimate dance environment.
F I G UR E 3. 1 6
A thrust stage, with seating on three sides of the stage. Photo courtesy of Wharton Center for Performing Arts.
47 PERFORMANCE SPACES
One of the other identifying features of a thrust space is
Another important consideration when staging a dance
that the audience seating is frequently raked, meaning
in a thrust space is the lighting. When lighting dance
that each row of seating is raised higher than the row
productions, it is a common practice to use side lighting
in front of it, thereby guaranteeing a better view of the
on booms positioned in the wings. While these booms
stage. In most thrust spaces, the rake is extremely high,
remain hidden away from the audience’s line of sight
meaning that more than half of the audience will be
in a proscenium space, this is not always the case for
looking down on dancers onstage. As a choreographer,
lighting dance in a thrust space. Booms, if used, might
this is a challenge to keep in mind while setting the
have to be placed in the audience. If so, this process
dance. Thrust spaces typically have tunnels that lead
must carefully be executed in order to avoid blinding
beneath the raked seating called vomitories, or “voms”
some of your audience. The normal rules of dance
for short (Figure 3.17). These voms make for interesting
lighting do not necessarily apply when lighting for the
points of entrance for dancers, adding a unique staging
thrust. Talk early with the lighting designer and make
opportunity over the proscenium space.
sure to let them know it will be staged for a thrust space.
F I G UR E 3. 1 7
A view from the thrust stage, looking out towards the audience. Note the raked audience seating and vomitories (indicated by the arrows). Photo courtesy of Wharton Center for Performing Arts.
48 THINKING AHEAD
Arena Theatres
booms for side lighting would be visible and shining into
Like the thrust, the arena stage (sometimes called
some of the audience’s eyes.
theatre in the round) features seating at a raked angle looking down onto the stage, but instead of seating on three sides, the audience is located on all sides of the stage (Figure 3.18). The main challenge of staging dance in the round is sightlines. Since the entirety of the stage is exposed to the audience, there is no opportunity to hide dancers, props, etc. Likewise, traditional dance lighting is problematic for an arena stage, since any
Black Box/Studio Theatre Spaces The term black box or studio theatre refers to a small theatre space with flexible seating that can be configured in multiple arrangements. This type of space is ideal for student performances, showcases, and master classes, as the audience is in close proximity to the action. The black box space does not lend itself to complex production elements, but there is an inherent value to working in a space that can be adjusted to meet the needs of the particular performance.
3.3 Non-traditional Spaces These days, it is not uncommon to see dance pieces performed in spaces outside of the traditional theatre (Figure 3.19). From warehouses to churches, gymnasiums, swimming pools, or even rock quarries, there are a number of locations that can make for an interesting dance performance space. One of the key benefits of using a non-
Available
traditional space is that your imagination is the limit for the production. There are no predetermined ways in which the space is best suited for a dance performance. Though there are a number of technical challenges to be met, such as power supply, dance flooring, seating, and public amenities, the performance experience in a non-traditional space can be particularly rewarding.
F IG UR E 3. 18
The arena stage, viewed from above, with seating surrounding the stage. Often, there will be vomitories in the four corners of the stage for entrances. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
49 PERFORMANCE SPACES
F IG UR E 3. 19
This photo, taken in a sky bridge over downtown Atlanta, represents the unique opportunity of a dancer performing in a non-traditional space. Photography by Richard Calmes.
proximity to the stage can impact a great number of the artistic decisions that go into producing a dance. The dancer or choreographer who enters into the process of creating a dance with a working understanding of theatre spaces and terminology is at a decided advantage when collaborating with designers and technicians.
Review Questions 1. What is the name of the “picture frame” through which the audience watches the performance? 2. What is the area of the stage that extends downstage of the proscenium line? 3. In regards to stage directions, what is the area called furthest away from the audience? 4. What is the name of the imaginary line that extends from one edge of the proscenium arch to another? 5. What is the name of audience seats located in the outside aisles and closest to the stage? 6. What are the vertical masking curtains called that are placed to mask the wings? 7. This type of system is used to fly scenery overhead
3.4 Chapter Review The type of performance space can greatly affect the type of dance performance that can be staged in its halls. All too frequently, choreographers and designers do not consider the ways in which the theatre space affects the dance until far too late in the process. In particular, the placement of the audience and their
50 THINKING AHEAD
in the theatre. 8. What is the steel pipe called that is used to lift the load of scenery? 9. This type of stage features audience sitting on three sides of the stage. 10. This type of stage is sometimes referred to as theatre in the round.
PART II PRODUCTION AREAS
CHAPTER 4 LIGHTING Lighting affects everything light falls upon. How you see what you see, how you feel about it, and how you hear what you are hearing. Jean Rosenthal
Hubbard Street Dancers Alice Klock, above, and Kevin J. Shannon in AZIMUTH by Alonzo King. Costumes by Robert Rosenwasser, Joan Raymond and Rebecca M. Shouse. Lighting Design by Axel Source Morgenthaler. line to goPhoto here by Quinn B Wharton.
Lighting is one of the most essential production
developing the ability to assess a visual moment and
elements to any live performance. Since most shows
understand all of the component parts that made up
are performed indoors or outdoors at night, some level
the feeling of that moment—the angle of the light, its
of lighting is required for both seeing the performers
brightness, quality, colors, shadows, and texture. When
and to provide for their safety. More than just these
collaborating with a lighting designer, it is useful to
basic concerns, though, lighting is a design element that
have a common language for discussing light. To those
contributes to the storytelling of the performance and
ends, the following sections cover some basic lighting
enhances the audience’s experience. The successful
concepts, discussing why we use light and how it can be
lighting design considers elements such as visibility,
manipulated for the stage.
color, lighting direction and angle, brightness, and be seen while hiding away those elements that distract
4.2 Functions of Dance Lighting (What Lighting can Accomplish)
from the storytelling. Though the tools and process for
In any work of art, all of the elements should be chosen
a dance lighting design are similar to that of theatrical
carefully to fulfill a specific purpose within the overall
lighting, the technique employed for creating dance
composition. Lighting is one of the most important
lighting varies considerably from theatre. Likewise, you
elements within a dance production, and it performs
may find that some of the terminology differs slightly
some very specific functions. Listed below are ways
between the two genres. This chapter details many of
of looking at the functions of dance lighting, or the
the considerations for dance lighting and examines the
purposes of lighting design within the context of a dance
role of the lighting designer in dance.
production.
4.1 The Lighting Designer
Visibility
The lighting designer must have a command of both
The first and most fundamental function of dance
design aesthetics and technological know-how—an
lighting is visibility. The audience cannot see
impeccable artistic eye with the understanding of
something that is in the dark. This basic concept is one
the equipment necessary to execute the desired
of the greatest tools of the dance lighting designer.
look onstage. In addition, lighting designers must
Sometimes what is not seen is much more useful
be excellent collaborators, since their work affects
to the storytelling of the dance than what is seen.
every other visual aspect of the production. Perhaps
Consider the possibility of dancers emerging from the
most importantly, the lighting designer should be
darkness onto lit areas of the stage only to disappear
skilled at describing the use of lighting and how it will
once more into the darkness. For dance, visibility is
emotionally, psychologically, and artistically affect the
more of a relative term than in theatre. For theatrical
production and given moments of the show. While this
performances, the old adage “you can’t hear what
may seem like a simple task, consider for a moment
you can’t see” is a time-tested mantra for explaining
the ephemeral nature of light and the way in which light
how audiences have a difficult time understanding
interacts with the world around us on a daily basis.
actor dialogue if they cannot see the actor’s face. In
Try to describe a sunset or the glow of light after a
dance, the spoken word is secondary to the dancer’s
thunderstorm. Most people take the lighting around
movement. Likewise, dance tends to be less of a
them for granted. Lighting designers have spent years
realistic art form than theatre, at times. For these
movement. Lighting is a tool for displaying what needs to
54 PRODUCTION AREAS
reasons, dance lighting is sometimes dimmer than
by the dancers (Figure 4.1). Sculpting is directly tied to
stage lighting, with a higher contrast between lights
the placement of lighting instruments and the direction
and darks.
and angle of light illuminating the stage.
Sculpting
Composition
When discussing dance lighting, the term sculpting
Composition is a descriptive term used in a number
refers to the combination of light and shadow on a
of different art forms. For the purposes of most visual
person or object to reveal or obscure its true form.
art forms, it refers to the combination of multiple
Also sometimes referred to as modeling, this function
elements and their placement or arrangement to create
is important to the overall purpose of dance—to
a cohesive work of art. Lighting, more so than any of
communicate a story or feeling through the movement
the other design areas, influences what the audience’s
of a dancer. This is why side lighting is so common for
eye falls on and what elements are seen or hidden.
dance lighting. The intense lighting coming from the
Since lighting has the ability to change in a matter of
sides emphasizes the human form and allows for the
seconds, lighting can also change the composition of
audience to see even the subtlest of motions performed
a piece numerous times throughout the performance.
F I G UR E 4. 1
The use of side lighting in this photo accentuates the dancer’s physical features and is an excellent example of sculpting with light. Lighting design by Jared Sayeg.
55 LIGHTING
F I G UR E 4. 2
Lighting can be used to affect the overall stage composition. Lighting design by Jeromy Hopgood. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
The primary use of composition in dance is to create
Mood
a sense of relationship between the dancers and their
Mood is often one of the easiest functions for
background. Figure 4.2 illustrates how the composition of a moment can be changed drastically through changes in lighting. In the first image, the entire stage is darkened, save the small pool of light isolating the dancer. The second image shows more of a full-stage illumination, with a much more open stage composition.
Rhythm While rhythm is an obvious component of any dance, many do not consider the way in which lighting
choreographers to identify about a dance. Mood (sometimes referred to as atmosphere) is the feeling associated with a certain visual moment, often invoked through the use of color, texture, and direction. It is important to discuss what type of feeling the choreographer wants the dance piece to evoke before determining the mood of the lighting design. Figure 4.3 illustrates how lighting can affect mood within a dance.
contributes to the overall rhythm of a dance piece.
Reinforcement/Punctuation
Many people use the term rhythm in dance to discuss
The final function of dance lighting is related to how
how a person or a piece of music moves. The same is true in lighting terms, with rhythm used to describe both how lighting moves within a given moment and in the overarching structure of the entire dance. Obviously, music is an important aspect of many dances (though certainly not all). Like the dancer, lighting can work in harmony with or in contrast to the music, or combinations of both within one dance piece. As the lighting “looks” change throughout the dance, it creates a definite sense of rhythm that either works in conjunction with or against the choreography and music.
56 PRODUCTION AREAS
lighting reinforces or comments on what is being done onstage by the dancers. Lighting should reinforce the storytelling of the choreography and support other design elements such as scenery, projections, and costumes. Likewise, lighting frequently functions as punctuation of a dance or moment within a dance. This can be something as basic as the length of time it takes for the lights to fade to black, or a drastic shift in the color scheme or lighting texture at a key moment within the choreography or musical accompaniment.
F I G UR E 4. 3
The lighting for this dance utilizes warm tones on the dancers with a cooler wash of colors in the perimeter, portraying a calm and serene mood. Lighting design by Jeromy Hopgood. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
4.3 Properties of Dance Lighting (Controllable Qualities of Dance Lighting) The properties of dance lighting refer to the definable attributes of lighting, or the aspects of lighting that can be changed. Each of these properties affects one or more of the functions of dance lighting listed above.
Brightness Brightness is the property of lighting that refers to the amount of light present (sometimes referred to as intensity). This aspect of lighting can be both relative and absolute. Typically, brightness is a relative term referring to the overall stage picture. Perhaps the whole
stage is dimly lit with one dancer standing in a pool of light (Figure 4.4). Even if this pool of light was only moderately bright, it would appear much more intense compared to the dim areas of lighting surrounding it.
Color Of all of the properties of light, color is arguably the most powerful tool used to communicate with your audience. Long after seeing a show, the strongest visual memories tend to be of the color used in a dramatic moment (Figure 4.5). In stage lighting, color was traditionally created through the use of color filters (often called gels). A gel is a thin sheet of plastic
57 LIGHTING
F I G UR E 4. 4
Brightness is most often relative when compared to the entire stage picture. Lighting design by Jeromy Hopgood. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
impregnated with pigment. Due to the nature of the particular gel, only certain wavelengths of light are allowed to pass through, leaving the resulting light colored. In recent years, though, the use of LED (Light Emitting Diode) lighting instruments enables lighting designers to create and mix color through the lighting instrument itself without using gels.
Direction Direction in lighting refers to the placement of the light source in relation to the object being lit. The main directions of lighting are front, back, and side. Each of these directions has a distinctly different feel to them and evokes different responses. Looking at Figure 4.6, the dancer is lit from multiple directions. Front lighting illuminates the form well, but “flattens” out the dancer a bit. Side lighting accentuates the three-dimensional form of the dancer, but tends to decrease some of the specificity of the facial features. Back lighting
F I G UR E 4. 5
eliminates the frontal details altogether, while adding
Dramatic lighting created through strong contrasting colors. Lighting design by Jared Sayeg.
a halo glow around the figure, making her stand out from the background. When considering the placement
58 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 4. 6
The three common directions of light. Photography by Jeromy Hopgood.
FRONT LIGHT
HIGH ANGLE
SIDE LIGHT
HIGH ANGLE
DOWN
BACK LIGHT
of a lighting instrument, the lighting designer should always examine the available lighting positions in
/
relation to the desired stage locations and understand how this choice affects the appearance of lighting.
Angle Like direction, angle is a property of light that relates to the placement of the light source. In fact, direction is rarely discussed without a discussion of the light’s angle. The key difference lies in the fact that direction is related to the object in the horizontal plane, whereas angle is concerned with the vertical placement of the light. In general, lighting angles are referred to as up, low, or high angle, with a few specific terms like up-light or down lighting. The names are related to the placement of the instrument and mostly self-descriptive
LOW ANGLE
LOW ANGLE
LUP
(i.e. shins, mids, head-highs, etc.). Similar to our
F IG UR E 4. 7
Some common angles of lighting. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
59 LIGHTING
discussion of direction, angle of light greatly affects the
the gobo, it is blocked by the steel and passes through
mood and is a powerful tool for the lighting designer.
the openings thereby creating a pattern in the light.
Figure 4.7 shows examples of some common lighting
Some gobos are made of glass and can contain complex
angles.
colored images, so the gobo creates both texture and
Visual Quality The visual quality of light is a term that describes how an area of lighting looks. Two terms used frequently to discuss visual quality are focus and texture. These two terms are interconnected in that focus will always affect texture. When referring to a given light, focus indicates the relative sharpness or softness of the pool of light. In most lighting instruments, the light source allows for adjusting the focus of the beam of light from soft to sharp. Texture in lighting is the visual appearance of the pool of light. Certain lighting fixtures may have an inherent texture to their output. Likewise, texture can be created in stage lighting through the use of a special template called a gobo. A gobo is a thin sheet of steel with patterns cut into it (Figure 4.8). When light strikes
color. Changing the focus of the lighting instrument will affect how crisp or diffuse the resulting texture appears onstage.
Movement The final property of dance lighting is movement. Movement can refer to the physical movement of a beam of light as seen in a follow spot or moving light, or it can refer to the perceived sense of movement created by turning lights on or off within the overall design. For instance, a lighting designer might create special areas of focus on the stage for one particular moment of the dance and then move the pool of light to another area of the stage as the dancers change their positions. Since movement is such a key component of dance, it stands to reason that this is also an important property of dance lighting. When considering movement, tempo (the speed or pace of a given movement) is an important consideration, since the same movement can have different interpretations when performed at different tempos.
4.4 Lighting Systems A lighting system refers to the collection of equipment necessary to generate and control the lighting for a production. When working in a theatre setting, most of these elements will be included as part of the physical plant. In the most basic terms, a lighting system must include power, control, and lighting instruments. The following section details common components of a lighting system. Refer to Figure 4.9 for specific details. F IG UR E 4. 8
Steel and glass gobos with a gobo holder.
60 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 4. 9
An illustrated view of a simple lighting system. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
DIMMER RACK
INSTRUMENT
POWER PLANT (HIGH VOLTAGE) TRANSFORMER (STEP DOWN VOLTAGE)
!IJJNt+l g lmtft+l g
0 0 1I --==========~__J CONTROL SIGNAL 00
LIGHTING INSTRUMENT
LIGHTING CONSOLE
Power For a theatre with a dedicated power system, high voltage electrical service will be sent into the building and through a transformer to step the power down to 120-volt power service. This is then connected to a dimmer rack. Dimmers are electrical devices used to regulate the flow of electricity to a specific outlet. The outlet that receives this power is referred to as a circuit. Stage lighting equipment is typically connected to a circuit by means of a heavyweight electrical cable with a
F IG UR E 4. 10
The stage pin connector, featuring both the male and female connector ends.
stage pin connector, a specialized connector plug that is rectangular in shape with three cylindrical prongs on the male end and three openings on the female receptacle (Figure 4.10).
61 LIGHTING
F IG UR E 4. 11
A lighting console in use. Hubbard Street production table and, foreground, magic sheet in the Museum of Contemporary Art Chicago’s Edlis Neeson Theater. Photo courtesy of Hubbard Street Dance Chicago.
texture, beam quality, and special effects (such as strobe, bouncing effects, prisms, and more). For conventional lighting equipment, it need only be connected to a dimmer to be controlled. For intelligent lighting, the instrument must be connected to a dimmer for power and have a specific control cable that provides a control signal from the lighting console directly to the lighting fixture.
Lighting System Summary In summary, a lighting system contains a collection of equipment necessary to illuminate the stage. A lighting
Control
console is used to send control signals to the dimmer rack and additional lighting equipment in the lighting
For every lighting system, there must be a controller
system. The dimmers receive the control signal, telling
used to manipulate the dimmers and lighting
them how much power (voltage) to provide to circuits.
equipment. This controller is called a lighting console,
Lighting instruments are connected to these circuits
or sometimes simply referred to as the lighting board
to receive their power supply from the dimmers.
(Figure 4.11). A lighting console is an electronic device
Increasing the voltage increases the brightness of the
used to send control signals to the dimmer rack that tell
lighting instrument.
it which dimmer should turn on and to what intensity. This control signal is referred to as a channel. In
4.5 Lighting Positions and Angles
addition, the console can send signals to other lighting
As seen in the earlier discussion of direction and
equipment such as intelligent lighting, color scrollers,
angle, the placement of a light greatly affects the
gobo rotators, and environmental effects like fogger/
resulting lighting look. For this reason, it is useful
hazers.
for choreographer and designer alike to understand
Lighting Instruments
the possibilities for lighting placement within the performance space and how each unique position
Lighting instruments are the final component of the
can be utilized. The following section details common
lighting system. Conventional lighting instruments are
lighting angles, their qualities, and how best to achieve
lights that remain in a fixed position and whose intensity
them in a performance space.
can be changed by the amount of electrical power supplied to them. Intelligent lighting instruments are
Side Lighting
a variety of lights that have a number of controllable
Side lighting is the principal lighting angle used in dance
properties such as focus position, intensity, color,
lighting design. From an artistic perspective, it focuses
62 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 4. 1 2
Side lighting can come from booms or lighting towers
Side lighting reveals the physical form of the dancer, while creating interesting shadows.
placed in the wings, from the offstage ends of the electrics, or even from the box boom positions. Since the boom/tower is the most common position used in
Lighting design and photography by Jeromy Hopgood.
creating side lighting for dance, it is important to have a good understanding of its attributes.
Booms The primary position for side lighting is the boom, a vertical lighting pipe with heavy weighted base, placed in the wings (Figure 4.13). Booms are frequently bolted to the floor or weighed down with sand/shot bags to counterbalance the weight of the lighting instruments hung on them. In addition, since many booms are
Loyal
Responsible
on the physical form of the dancer, giving high contrast
Available
and allowing the audience to truly pay attention to the subtleties of the dancer’s physicality. From a practical standpoint, side lighting is relatively quick and easy to
Responsible Responsible
set up. It also allows for a variety of looks with the least amount of lighting instruments. All of this makes it an ideal choice for touring repertory in dance. By itself, side lighting can create a somewhat mysterious look that focuses on the edges of the dancer, while creating a heavily sculpted look (Figure 4.12).
F IG UR E 4. 13
A boom, featuring four side lighting positions. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
63 LIGHTING
F I G UR E 4. 1 4
focused off of the stage floor. This angle of light
The four primary side lighting positions from a boom.
creates an interesting effect of having the dancer suspended in space, magically hovering above the
Photography by Jeromy Hopgood.
floor (Figure 4.14A). 2.
Mid-highs: Mid side lighting is hung approximately waist-high on the boom and pointing directly out towards the centerline of the theatre (Figure 4.14B). Some of the light will spill onto the stage floor. This lighting illuminates the dancer’s body and does an excellent job of revealing the threedimensional form. When dealing with dancers in
C. HEAD-HIGHS (2 SIDES)
a row, though, this might not be the best choice
D. HIGH SIDES (2 SIDES)
of instrument, as the dancer closest to the wings is brightly illuminated and casts shadows on the subsequent dancers. 3.
Head-highs: Head-high side lighting is placed 6´ to 8´ off of the stage floor (Figure 4.14C). Heads are not focused off the stage floor, so there is an amount of light spilling onto the floor, but not so much as to distract from the dancer. This position, together with the shins, makes up the two essential lighting angles for side lighting in dance.
4. C. HEAD-HIGHS (2 SIDES)
D. HIGH SIDES (2 SIDES)
10´ to 16´ in height, some have a safety line attached to the top of the boom that extends to the theatre’s grid. It is common to hang anywhere from three to six lighting instruments from each boom, typically ellipsoidal
Highs: High side lighting uses a lighting instrument hung 10´ to 14´ off of the stage floor pointed diagonally down onto the stage (Figure 4.14D). This angle creates interesting shadows from the dancer onto the stage floor and creates a great sense of space.
reflector spotlights with the ability to be tightly focused.
Front Lighting
Listed below are the descriptions of dance boom
Front lighting is any lighting source that points directly
lighting placement. Figure 4.14 illustrates the differing
towards the stage. It can be positioned overhead in the
looks of the four common instrument positions on a
auditorium or on stage. For theatrical lighting, front
boom.
lighting is the primary source of illumination. In dance
1.
Shin busters: Low side lighting is a fundamental lighting angle for dance. These lights are hung approximately shin high (12˝ to 18˝ from the stage deck) and pointed up to head height, with the light
64 PRODUCTION AREAS
lighting, however, the most important lighting direction will always be side lighting. As such, front lighting for dance is mostly used as a “fill light” to wash across the stage and help the audience see the dancers’ faces.
Dance lighting tends to avoid an overuse of front light,
Foot Lighting
since lighting from the front tends to flatten out an
Footlights are a row of lights placed at floor level,
object, eliminate the sculptural look desired for dance, and cast odd shadows from the costumes onto the dancers’ bodies. The notable exception to this rule is in ballet, where the traditional approach is to use front lighting to eliminate the shadow in the center of the dancer’s body that results from side light alone.
typically at the front edge or back edge of the stage. Older theatres may even still have a “trough” at the front edge of the stage, sunken beneath the floor surface so that they are out of the audience’s line of sight. Footlights point upstage at the dancers, casting long shadows onto the upstage area and backdrop.
Front lighting is categorized by the different angles.
It is a rather unnatural look, since low front lighting
Figure 4.15 includes examples of various angles of front
rarely appears in nature. The effect makes the dancer
lighting.
seem quite tall, but has a somewhat limited use, since the projected shadow of the dancer on the backdrop can prove to be distracting from the actual dancer (Figure 4.15A).
Low-angle Front Lighting Low-angle front lighting in most theatres comes from the balcony level or from catwalk positions on the back wall of the auditorium. These positions are ideal to get light onto the dancers’ faces, but would “flatten out” the dancers and cast shadows on the backdrop if used on their own (see Figure 4.15B). As a result, they are often used at lower intensities for fill light.
High-angle Front Lighting In most theatres, the majority of front lighting comes COVESCOVES
COVES COVES COVES
at a high angle from either lighting positions in the auditorium (called ceiling slots) or from an overhead electric onstage (see Figure 4.15C). A ceiling slot, sometimes called a port, is a lighting position over the audience’s head, hidden out of sight by the architecture of the theatre. An electric is a batten from which lighting instruments are intended to hang. If it is a dedicated electric, the batten will have permanent circuits attached to it and be clearly labeled. Electrics can be used for a number of different lighting angles from front to side, back, or down lighting. For naming
F I G UR E 4. 1 5
Four common front lighting positions. Photography by Jeromy Hopgood.
purposes, electrics are labeled numerically from C. CEILING SLOT
D. COVES
65 LIGHTING
downstage to upstage (i.e. first electric, second
Back Lighting
electric, etc.).
Back lighting also plays an important role in dance
Front Low-angle Side Lighting Coves are lighting positions in the side walls of the auditorium. Like the ceiling slots, they are often disguised by the building’s architecture so the audience cannot see them. Not every theatre has coves, but some come equipped with multiple cove positions in the house. These positions make for good low-angle front side lighting across the downstage areas from the auditorium sides. Figure 4.15D includes an example of a dancer lit from a cove position.
lighting. The main benefit of back lighting on the dancer is to separate the dancer from the background and make the figure truly stand out. From the audience’s perspective, back lighting reads most strongly on the stage floor (Figure 4.16). Since so much of the other lighting angles are focused off of the stage floor, back lighting offers a unique opportunity to add color and textures to the stage floor. If back lighting is in a complementary color to the front lighting, a halo effect will be seen surrounding the dancer, particularly around the head and shoulders. Back lighting is most often achieved by hanging instruments on the overhead electrics, pointed downstage.
F I G UR E 4. 1 6
This image combines high-angle blue back lighting with a dim wash of front lighting. The back lighting creates a blue wash on the stage floor. Lighting design and photography by Jeromy Hopgood.
66 PRODUCTION AREAS
Low-angle Back Lighting
An electric is the obvious choice for down light
In addition to high-angle back lighting, low-angle back
instruments, as it is placed directly above the stage.
lighting can create an interesting effect. Low-angle back lighting is achieved from lighting instruments placed at the floor level and pointing downstage towards the audience. These are typically in the form of footlights, or floor mounts, a lighting instrument attached to a base on the floor. This lighting angle creates a strong silhouette, but eliminates all sense of form for the dancer. The body will be perceived as a dark silhouette surrounded by a bright background (Figure 4.17). One thing to be wary of with this lighting is the danger of blinding your audience. Though this can create an interesting effect, using this angle too frequently can lead to fatiguing your audience’s eyes.
Down lighting is very common in dance lighting, particularly when used as a special. A special is a light that is hung for a specific purpose, like a particular moment within the dance where you want to highlight a dancer or movement. Down light specials are commonly hung in each of the nine main areas of the stage, pointed down with a crisp focus. In this way, the designer can isolate a location on the stage and draw focus to that area. Keep in mind that the angle of down light makes for odd shadows on the dancer, though, so it is wise to use it sparingly. Figure 4.18 illustrates the creative use of down lighting in a dance production.
Lighting the Background
Down Lighting
One final element to consider is the lighting of
Down lighting is the use of a lighting instrument
background elements. For most dances staged in a
hung overhead to point straight down onto the stage.
theatre the background is a cyclorama, a painted drop, a scrim, or a combination of more than one.
Cyclorama A cyclorama, called a cyc for short, is a large fabric backdrop hung upstage (see Figure 3.9). Originally, the term cyclorama referred specifically to a curved backdrop, and flat drops were called a sky drop. Today, most people simply refer to all sky drops as a cyclorama. The cyc is typically gray or light blue in color and used for lighting effects to create a large colored backdrop. It is lit by special lighting instruments referred to as cyc lights or strip lights. These lights are specially designed to evenly spread their light across a wide surface area. In addition, cyc lights tend to have three to four lights in a cluster, each one having an individual color, such as red, green, blue, and amber. F I G UR E 4. 1 7
A dancer lit from behind, using a floormounted instrument.
Through the use of these colors, the lighting designer can mix colors and create a wide variety of colors for the backdrop.
Photography by Jeromy Hopgood.
67 LIGHTING
F I G UR E 4. 1 8
Strong down lights create an interesting high-contrast visual. Lighting design by Jared Sayeg.
Cyc lights are typically hung overhead on a batten
Drops are typically painted on muslin fabric. Lighting a
close to the cyclorama and sometimes placed on the
drop requires the use of high front light from a batten
floor pointing up at the cyc. These lights on the floor
downstage of the drop, similar to lighting a cyclorama.
are referred to as a lighting ground row. This type of lighting from both above and below the cyclorama
Scrim
makes for the ability to create a split lighting effect with
A scrim is a type of fabric with an open weave, similar
color control for both top and bottom. When lighting the
to gauze, used for creating a full-stage backdrop
cyclorama from below, it is important to use a scenic
(see Figure 3.8). Scrim can either be a solid color
ground row, a short vertical row of flat scenery on the
or have scenic elements painted on it. This fabric is
stage floor used for masking the lighting ground row.
advantageous for theatrical applications because of the
Painted Backdrops
nature of scrim to appear either opaque or translucent, depending on the type of lighting cast upon it. When
A painted backdrop, sometimes simply called a drop, is
lit from the front, the color or painting on the scrim is
a large fabric backdrop upon which scenery is painted.
visible. When the front lighting is taken away and the
68 PRODUCTION AREAS
lighting behind the scrim left up, the scrim becomes
Instrument Types: Spotlight (Specific Lighting)
translucent, creating a magical “hazy” look to objects
When discussing lighting instruments, the instrument
behind it. Scrim is frequently used in dance as a backdrop near the cyclorama (Figure 4.19). When a black scrim is used downstage of the cyclorama, the lighting effects on the cyc can still be viewed, or the black of the scrim can create a neutral black backdrop when cyc light is removed. This makes for a versatile dance background. In Figure 4.19, a black scrim was used as a backdrop, with the back wall of the theatre space exposed upstage of the scrim. This made for an interesting contrast when lighting the wall.
4.6 Lighting Instruments The selection of a lighting instrument is one of the most important duties of the lighting designer. The lighting designer must understand the technical specifications of many different types of lighting instruments and how best to utilize them to achieve the desired artistic outcome. Though lighting equipment rapidly changes with advances in design and engineering, there are some common types of instruments that consistently appear in dance lighting. It is useful for choreographers and designers alike to familiarize themselves with some of these basic types of instruments and their attributes.
types are commonly grouped together based on their lighting output attributes. The spotlight fixture is a type of lighting instrument that can create a tight pool of lighting, has the ability for beam shaping, and can affect changes to the beam’s focus from crisp to soft. There are many different types of spotlight fixtures, though the most common type used in dance applications is the Ellipsoidal Reflector Spotlight, or ERS for short. An ERS is a type of lighting instrument that uses an ellipsoidal-shaped reflector in conjunction with its lamp to create a high-intensity beam of light. Introduced in the 1930s, the first ERS was called a Leko, named for its two developers, Joseph Levy and Edward Kook. Some people today may still use this term to refer to any ERS instrument. Though differing manufacturers offer a slightly different approach to the ERS, there are some common features (Figure 4.20): ●●
C-clamp and yoke: The lighting instrument is attached to a batten by means of a c-clamp. The c-clamp is bolted to a u-shaped steel piece called the yoke. It is tightened down to the batten to secure the light. In addition, there is a set screw attached to the c-clamp that can be loosened to allow the
F I G UR E 4. 1 9
In these images, a black scrim is used as a backdrop. When unlit (left), the background appears to be flat black. When the back walls of the theatre are lit (right), they magically appear behind the scrim, creating an ethereal look to the backdrop. Choreography by Erik Abbott-Main. Lighting design by Jeromy Hopgood. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
69 LIGHTING
F IG UR E 4. 20
The ERS lighting fixture. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
GOBO SLOT COLOR SLOT
GOBO GOBO
BARREL
●●
GOBO
~
Barrel: The barrel is the component of the lighting instrument that contains the lenses for adjusting the focus of the beam of light. By adjusting the distance of the barrel from the light source, the resulting pool of light will be either crisp or fuzzy in focus. Modern lighting instruments feature removable barrels that are interchangeable. This allows for one lighting fixture to be used in different situations. Barrels are named for the beam spread of lighting they produce.
BARREL ADJUSTMENT KNOB
Common beam spreads are 5-, 10-, 19-, 26-, 36-, and
SHUTTERS
50-degree. The smaller the beam spread, the further away the light is intended to be hung from the focus
instrument to pan from side to side for focusing purposes. ●●
●●
point and vice versa. ●●
Color slot (gel frame holder): At the end of the barrel
Shutters: One of the identifying features of the ERS is
is a slot for a gel frame holder. Gels are placed in
the ability to shape its beam of light through the use
a metal frame called a gel frame. The gel frame,
of shutters. A shutter is a moveable metal plate that
complete with gel, is then inserted in the gel frame
blocks the beam of light in order to shape the output.
holder at the end of the barrel. Most barrels also
There are four shutters than can be slid into different
have a locking clip so as to secure the gel frame and
configurations. Due to the shutter placement and the
keep it from falling out. In addition to the standard
nature of reflected light inside the ERS, the physical
gel, a color scroller can be used in the color slot. A
action of shuttering the light will be reversed in the
color scroller is a box-shaped lighting accessory with
resulting pool of light. This means that pushing in
a string of gels fused together on a loop. This string
the top shutter will affect the bottom portion of the
of gels is attached to a motor that can move the loop
pool of light, and the right shutter will affect the left
along until the chosen color appears in the gate.
side of the light.
Color scrollers have an external power supply and
Gobo slot: The ERS comes equipped with a gobo slot,
are controlled by a control signal from the lighting
a slot in the top of the lighting body made for the use
console.
of a gobo. This slot can accept either steel or glass gobos. Similar to the shutter, gobo patterns will be
The Follow Spot
reversed on the lighting surface. It is important to
A follow spot is a particular type of spotlight lighting
remember this fact when working with templates
fixture controlled by a human operator and designed to
that feature writing or recognizable symbols. In
create an intensely bright pool of light with a long throw
order to be correctly projected, the gobo must be
distance. It is typically located in the theatre’s control
placed upside down and reversed into the gobo slot.
booth or in special positions in the balcony so as to be
70 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 4. 2 1
that can create a large wash of evening lighting across a
A small follow spot unit.
wide area. Wash fixtures are best used for this purpose.
Photography by Jeromy Hopgood.
There are two conventional lighting instruments used for wash lighting: the Fresnel and the PAR-type fixture. The following section discusses these two instruments and some of their attributes.
The Fresnel The Fresnel is named for Augustin-Jean Fresnel, the French scientist who invented its interesting lens. Fresnel took the basic plano convex lens and cut away sections of the glass in concentric rings, thereby making a lens with the same refractive properties as the plano convex but with much less material. The Fresnel is an excellent choice for back lighting since it can create an even wash of the stage for large color fills. Unlike the ERS, a Fresnel has fewer internal tools for adjusting the overall appearance of light output. Inside the Fresnel are a spherical reflector and lamp mounted on a moveable carriage (sometimes called a sled), and a Fresnel lens (Figure 4.22). The quality of the light can
hidden away from the audience. Follow spots are often used in ballet productions. A typical follow spot (Figure 4.21) has a douser to “dim” the beam of light and an iris to change the size of the circular pool of light, a horizontal shutter control, and a “color boomerang” at the end of the barrel to change the color of light. The light is mounted on a moveable base that can be locked down into place. The follow spot’s yoke is attached to a central pedestal that enables panning and tilting the instrument with minimal effort.
Instrument Types: Wash Lighting (General Lighting) Whereas the spotlight is used for specific lighting, sometimes the lighting designer needs an instrument
F IG UR E 4. 22
A Fresnel lighting instrument. Photography by Jeromy Hopgood.
71 LIGHTING
be changed from spot (sharper) to flood (diffused) by
Instrument Types: Cyc Lights
moving the sled closer to or further away from the lens.
As mentioned earlier in the chapter, there are a variety
Sliding further away achieves a spot focus, whereas moving closer creates a flood focus. There are no shutters in the Fresnel for beam shaping, though there is a device called a barn door that can be attached to the end of the Fresnel to shape the light output. Though you can never achieve a crisp shutter cut like the ERS, the barn door is an effective tool for basic beam shaping.
of lighting instruments used for lighting the cyclorama or stage drops. These lights are intended to hang near the cyclorama from a batten above or placed as a ground row on the floor. Cyc lights tend to fall into three main categories: strip lights, quartz “far-throw” cyc fixtures, or LED cyc fixtures. Strip lights are a variety of cyc lights that feature a long
The PAR-type Fixture
rectangular lighting fixture with multiple paired cells
For years, the PAR fixture was the go-to lighting
of lights in sequence. They tend to feature three or four
instrument for dance and concert lighting because of its lightweight, cost-effective design and ability to create wide colorful washes of light. The PAR is named for its unique lamp (the Parabolic Aluminized Reflector) that combines together light source, reflector, and lens into one component (Figure 4.23). The PAR lighting fixture is simply a metal housing to hold the PAR lamp with a gel slot on the end of the barrel. The simple design of this lighting instrument led to the term “PAR-can” since it is essentially a PAR in a can. Like the Fresnel, the PAR must use barn doors for beam shaping (though you can change out the lamps for very narrow, narrow, medium, or wide flood).
different cells for maximum color mixing capabilities. The far-throw cyc fixture is a type of cyc light made up of one to four large rectangular quartz lamps per section and can be hung further away from the cyc or drop than a typical strip light. They cover a large area with a smooth, even wash of lighting but require around a 4´ distance from the cyclorama for effective coverage. LED cyc fixtures feature LED cells instead of conventional lamps. This allows for exceptionally bright light with color mixing capabilities without using a gel.
Instrument Types: Intelligent Lighting Intelligent lighting is a blanket term referring to a wide array of lighting instruments that have controllable attributes to make them more versatile than conventional fixtures. One of the most appealing attributes of an intelligent light is the ability to remotely adjust the light’s focus. This is why some people simply refer to them as “moving lights.” Many intelligent lighting fixtures have a wide array of controllable features, such as color change, gobos, gobo rotation, prism effects, strobe effects, and built-in effects engines, to simply create interesting visual effects. Intelligent lighting has become a mainstay of concert
F I G UR E 4. 2 3
lighting and audiences have come to expect this
A PAR64 lighting instrument.
dynamic look in concert settings.
Photo courtesy of Jonge Koning.
72 PRODUCTION AREAS
Like conventional lighting fixtures, intelligent lighting
Hazers
tends to be split into different varieties of wash and spot
Another type of atmospheric effect is called haze.
fixtures. Though intelligent lighting has a high initial cost, a small number of intelligent lights in a dance light plot can help the designer limit the number of instruments necessary to create a versatile design. One important consideration in using intelligent lighting is cabling. Unlike a conventional lighting instrument that is controlled by the power supply only, intelligent lighting needs both a power supply and a control signal. This means the use of DMX cable that runs from the lighting console to the intelligent lighting fixture for the control signal. Rather than run a separate cable for each instrument, though, it is common to “daisy chain”
Haze is a long-lasting mist that hangs in the air for an extended period of time without dissipating. Haze is popular for concert lighting and outdoor events as it can easily fill a large area even in locations with inconsistent air circulation. It is the haze effect that creates the iconic rock and roll lighting appearance of visible shafts of colored light in the air. Hazers use either waterbased hazer fluid or liquid nitrogen to create haze. Many models of smoke machines, foggers, and hazers are DMX-controllable and can be connected to a lighting console for remote control.
the instruments together and have cabling run from
4.8 Color in Lighting
instrument to instrument.
Color is one of the most powerful tools of the lighting
4.7 Atmospherics In addition to selecting the appropriate lighting instrument, there are a number of decisions to be made that affect how lighting is perceived onstage. One of the most important factors to how lighting is perceived is atmospherics, typically in the form of haze and fog. Since lighting is intangible, it can only be seen when it
designer. It can communicate mood and atmosphere more effectively than most any other attribute of lighting. There are entire books dedicated to color theory and how lighting affects color. For the purposes of this text, we will examine a few of the key characteristics of color in lighting and how to implement color in a lighting design.
touches an object. When a beam of light passes through
Talking About Color
a darkened space, the beam itself is unperceivable
It can be difficult to discuss something so technical as
unless the air contains particles (i.e. water, dust, fog, etc.) For this reason, there are a number of devices that can be used to create atmospheric effects.
Fog Machines The use of fog is a time-tested effect for theatre and dance. There are different types of machines that can produce both low-lying fog that clings to the stage surface or a more smoke-like airborne variety. Most types of fog machines use a water-based liquid called fog juice. Low-lying fog machines work through either the use of dry ice, a chiller unit to cool smoke, or by
lighting and color without having a basic understanding of vocabulary. It is important to have a common vocabulary between designers and collaborators, though, to ensure that everyone is on the same page. When discussing the name of the color, we commonly use the word hue. In basic terms, this can be interpreted as the color’s name or its placement in the visible color spectrum. When discussing the purity of the color, we tend to use the term saturation, which refers to the amount of a hue present in the colored lighting.
creating fog directly from liquid CO2.
73 LIGHTING
Another word used in relation to a color’s saturation
the resulting hue is closer towards white light. This
is value. In discussing pigment, value relates to the
phenomenon is referred to as additive color mixing.
relative amount of black or white in a color. This value scale can be illustrated as a chart with black on one
Primary and Secondary Colors
end, white on the other, and the pure hue located in
A primary color is a pure color that cannot be created
the center. Since there is no black lighting, a color’s
by mixing together other colors. These primary colors,
value in lighting is relative to the amount of white light
though, can be mixed to create interesting colors known
present. Therefore, the value scale for a hue in lighting
as secondary colors. In pigment, we know that all
is illustrated with the saturated hue on one end of the
colors are made up of three primary colors: red, yellow,
scale and pure white on the other end (Figure 4.24). We
and blue. Many people are surprised to discover that
will discuss these terms a bit more as we address the
the primary colors in lighting are different than those
use of color media later.
in pigment. For lighting, the three primary colors are
Color Mixing
red, green, and blue. By mixing pure versions of these three colors together, one can create any color in the
Another fundamental aspect of lighting is color mixing.
visible lighting spectrum. Figure 4.25 illustrates the
Color in lighting behaves in a unique fashion, quite
colors of light and how color mixing works in lighting.
differently than colored pigment in paint or inks. In
The three primary colors (red, green, and blue) are on
examining what we call “white light,” all of the visible
the outside circles. Where these areas overlap, the
colors of the spectrum are present. The reason for
result is secondary colors. The illustration shows that
this difference lies in the fact that, unlike paint, when
red and green combine to create yellow, green, and
different hues of colored lighting are added together,
Loyal Caring Caring
Caring
Caring
F I G UR E 4. 2 4
F IGU RE 4. 25
This value scale shows the gradation of a red hue from pure saturation to white.
Color mixing in lighting. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
74 PRODUCTION AREAS
Loyal
Loyal
blue combine to create cyan; and blue and red combine
Four main manufacturers (Rosco, Lee, GAM, and
together to create magenta.
Apollo) make theatrical gels. In recent years, Rosco
Another important concept in colored lighting is how colors interact with one another. Looking at Figure 4.25, you will notice the arrows connecting certain hues. These hues, opposite to one another on the chart, are referred to as complementary colors. In lighting, complementary colors are those that produce white light when combined together. When looking at these colors side by side, the effect is making both colors appear more bright and vibrant than seeing any one by itself. This can create an interesting effect, but can lead to visual overstimulation if used for too long on the stage. Colors closer together on the chart, called analogous colors, are more similar to one another and have less visual contrast (i.e. cyan and blue).
Producing Color in Light There are a number of different ways to create colored lighting for the stage. For most dance applications, though, there are three main devices used to produce color in lighting: color filters (gels), glass color filters,
purchased GAM, but left the GAM line of gels available for purchase as a division of Rosco. Each manufacturer makes swatch books with a small sample of their gels. When working with gels from different manufacturers, it is important to remember that some colors will have similar names, but produce a differing hue. For example, most manufacturers create a color called “bastard amber” but each one is slightly different in color. For this reason, manufacturers have a numbering system to differentiate the different colors between brands. Designers use the letters of the manufacturer to distinguish between makers. For instance, the color bastard amber could be listed as R02 (Rosco), L162 (Lee), G325 (GAM), AP7050 (Apollo)—even though it has a slightly different name for each manufacturer. It is important that a lighting designer be familiar with colors from all four manufacturers and maintains current swatch books. To obtain a swatch book, contact your local theatrical supplier or the manufacturers directly.
and LED lighting instruments. It is important to
There is some important information included in all
understand these different tools, how each of them
swatch books related to gel selection. The first item to
is used, and the difference in the quality of colors
look at is the gel’s transmission. Transmission refers
produced onstage.
to the amount of light transmitted through the gel. A
Color Filters
low percentage of transmission means that a small percentage of the visible spectrum passes through
There are a number of ways to produce color in light.
the gel, thus producing high color saturation. A high
One method is the use of a color filter, often referred
transmission means the opposite. Since a greater
to as a gel. As mentioned earlier in this chapter, a gel
amount of white light passes through the gel, the
is a thin polycarbonate or polyester sheet infused with
resulting color will be unsaturated—closer to white
pigment and placed in the path of a beam of light to
light.
produce a colored beam of light. In early days, they were made of gelatin, leading to the use of the term gel, which has continued in use over the years. Gels work by absorbing unwanted wavelengths of lights and only allowing the desired wavelength to pass though, thereby producing the resulting color.
In practical terms, it is important to remember that those gels with the least transmission have a shorter lifespan than high transmission gels. Since saturated colors convert a greater amount of light into heat energy, they often develop a hole burnt into the center
75 LIGHTING
of the gel over time. Some manufacturers make long-
it is wise to use LED lighting in conjunction with
life gels to counteract this effect, but for longer show
conventional fixtures.
runs gels will have to be regularly replaced. All plastic color media used in a conventional lighting fixture will eventually burn out.
Glass Color Filters Another possibility for producing colored lighting is a glass color filter. Strip lights can use special convex glass filters called roundels. In ERS fixtures and moving lights, glass color filters are used to create a vivid colored beam of light. In addition to a plain glass filter, there are also glass gobos with textures and color built in and variegated glass filters that create interesting color-blended textural effects, such as fire or water. All of these glass color filters can be used in addition to a conventional steel gobo for creating varied effects. Glass filters will never lose their color or burn out. The only danger in a glass filter is the possibility of dropping and breaking the filter. Though glass is much more expensive, the extended life may make it appealing for longer productions.
LED Lighting The final of the most common methods for producing colored lighting is LED lighting. As mentioned earlier, one of the greatest benefits of LED lighting is its ability to create vivid, brightly saturated colored lighting without the heat present in conventional lighting fixtures. LED lighting is still in many ways in its infancy. Initially, it was mostly in wash fixtures and strip lighting that LED fixtures appeared on the stage. Within the last few years, we have seen a number of the larger theatrical lighting companies make huge advances in their offerings, featuring LED moving lights, wash fixtures, and even ERS fixtures. At this point, most theatres and designers have not made a move to LEDonly lighting installations. For a number of reasons,
One thing to keep in mind with LED fixtures is that the instruments themselves, not separate dimmers, control the dimming of lights. As the LED lights dim, there are rapid pulses of the LED that happen too quickly for the human eye to take in under normal circumstances. This pulsing can often be seen under the camera, especially if the shutter rate of the camera is set in sync with the refresh rate of the LED lighting instruments. Make sure to research the settings available on your LED lighting if you intend to capture the dance on video. Likewise, in some instances a dance that is presented in low lighting with only LED lighting can create an effect similar to strobe lighting. Again, adjusting the refresh rate on the instruments can be useful in solving this problem. Finally, the quality of LED color can sometimes be described as electric, vivid, or extreme. While this is appropriate for some dances, it may seem off-putting in other situations. As we move forward with LED lighting, it will be more important than ever to keep in mind the old adage “you get what you pay for.” Often, low-cost lighting instruments, though able to create interesting lighting effects onstage, will not have the ability to make the necessary adjustments for the challenges mentioned above. High-quality fixtures (typically higher in cost) will have a number of features built into their control structure to address these issues.
4.9 Chapter Review Lighting design is a multifaceted component of dance production that requires both artistic and technical proficiency in a designer. In seeking to understand the basics of lighting, this chapter explored the functions and properties of lighting—both what we can accomplish through lighting and the controllable aspects of the light itself. In addition, we examined the physical theatre space and how where lighting instruments are placed affects distribution. Finally, a
76 PRODUCTION AREAS
focus on lighting systems, equipment, and color gives insight into how the technical side of lighting design truly affects the types of artistic decisions that the designer makes. From the choreographer’s perspective, it is advantageous to have a passing understanding of the
3. Describe the components of a lighting system and their individual functions. 4. What is the most common hanging position for achieving side lighting? 5. What is the name of a batten from which lighting instruments are hung?
basics of lighting design. Those who can enter the
6. What is a scrim?
collaborative process with this knowledge will find it
7. What does ERS stand for?
easier to communicate with the lighting designer and
8. What is uncommon about how shutters operate?
find the end product more closely matches their vision for the production.
Review Questions 1. What are the functions of dance lighting?
9. What device is used to fill the air with a long-lasting mist? 10. The combination of complementary colors produces which color of light?
2. What are two terms commonly used to discuss the quality of lighting?
77 LIGHTING
CHAPTER 5 CREATING THE LIGHTING DESIGN The secret lies in our perception of light in the theatre as something alive. Does this mean that we are to carry images of poetry and vision and high passion in our minds while we are shouting out orders to electricians on ladders? Yes, that is what it means. Robert Edmond Jones
The graceful lines of a dancer’s silhouette, captured through lighting. Photography by Richard Calmes.
The job of the lighting designer is a delicate balancing
Collaborative Models
act of artistry and technical details. The difficult part of
The history of dance in the last century is a study of how
the lighting designer’s role in a production is that much of his/her work depends on the ability to successfully communicate the ephemeral. The lighting designer must communicate with the choreographer and other members of the production team how a moment will look before ever having hung or focused the lights, cued the show, or sometimes even having stepped into the performance space. In order to make certain that these original concepts are successfully carried over to the actual performance, the lighting designer must create a vast amount of design drawings and paperwork, and work closely with the technicians who set up the lighting equipment. This chapter details the process of creating the lighting design from concept discussions to opening night. This information is useful not only to the designer, but also to the choreographer in the collaborative process.
5.1 Working with the Choreographer The process of working with a choreographer is, to a great degree, a question of interpersonal communication and individual personalities. Unlike most theatrical productions, dance allows you to work firsthand with the creator of the artistic work and not have a director as a mediator to the creative process. This would be akin to a playwright directing his/her own play. If all parties approach the process with open minds and flexibility, this unique relationship can lead to a rewarding collaborative process. Unfortunately, too many times someone comes to the table with a preconceived notion of “how things must work.” If there is one firm rule for collaboration, it is this: there are no set rules for how we can successfully collaborate.
the choreographer/designer paradigm visibly shifted. Before the early twentieth century, much of the larger context of professional dance was ballet-driven: large productions telling a story with elaborate scenery and costumes. In this model, lighting designers were generally expected to create a wash of light across the stage, with follow spots used to track principal dancers. In short, the role of the lighting designer was to create visibility. George Balanchine, considered by most as the father of American Ballet, co-founded the New York City Ballet and choreographed for both Broadway and Hollywood. His works from the 1940s onward introduced a new modernist take on ballet that was more abstract and stripped down. As works like these became more prevalent in the classical repertoire and choreographers like Martha Graham popularized modern dance with the general public, lighting design moved away from basic illumination and became equal parts alternative scenery and artistic expression. In the latter half of the twentieth century Merce Cunningham, as mentioned in Chapter 1, embraced the notion of “stand-alone” production elements in which the dancing, lighting, scenery, and music were created separately and then combined for the performance. In looking at this brief history, one can see three basic expectations for lighting designers that remain prevalent today. While individual cases vary, most often I see choreographers expecting one or more of these three approaches: Make sure I can see the dance; Support/comment on the dance’s narrative; I trust you to do what you like. As a choreographer and designer alike, it is important to identify the collaborative goals before heading into the production.
We must arrive at them together, if they are to be
Setting Goals
successful.
One challenge inherent in collaboration is that most people don’t go into a project consciously thinking about how they would like to work with their colleagues. For
80 PRODUCTION AREAS
this reason, I always find it useful as a designer to
Practical Concerns
approach each project with a series of questions to help
When working in a collaborative art form, the devil
define expectations. This is an approach I use in both theatrical and dance design. I find it to be useful for both parties, and have had many choreographers tell me that it helps them clarify their thoughts on the dance and consider it in a way they had not before. The following list is tailored for lighting design, but can be used to think about a number of different production areas.
Talking About Your Dance 1.
Describe in two to three sentences what you want your dance to communicate.
2.
3.
is truly in the details. Communication is everyone’s responsibility, to ensure that all production participants are on the same page. When going into collaboration with a choreographer (especially for the first time) I always try to send a message with a list of practical concerns that will be important to the overall process. Listed below is a checklist of information with which the designers, choreographer, and dancers should be familiar. Keep in mind that the answers to these questions will always vary. There is no set formula that will always be followed. It is just useful for everyone to
Is your dance based on or influenced by any
start from a common place. It is also possible that the
particular work of art? (If so, feel free to include
choreographer will not have answers to all of these
images, links/references with this response).
questions. Some of these questions might best be
Is your dance in one piece, or are there distinctly
addressed to the production manager and/or technical
different “movements” or sections within the
director.
dance? (Some choreographers like to create a brief “script” of the dance, describing important events or changes in music within the dance. This can be
●●
Is this a new piece or a remount?
●●
If a remount, are there elements of the premiere that are important to reproduce?
particularly useful to designers who are used to ●●
What is the rehearsal schedule?
the designer and stage manager have a better
●●
What is the tech schedule?
understanding of the choreographer’s intent.)
●●
Will there be regularly scheduled production
working from the written word. It can help both
4. 5.
meetings?
If there are different sections of the dance, how do they differ from one another?
●●
At what point will the dance be fully choreographed?
Give a few adjectives or short descriptive phrases
●●
Will you be at all rehearsals, or will a rehearsal
to describe how your dance (or individual sections) should feel. Try to avoid the temptation to explain
director run rehearsals? ●●
your concept—it tends to be more effective to focus, instead, on what the dance or moments should feel
recorded for cueing purposes? ●●
Can you share the music used in the dance?
●●
Will costumes be available to view before tech?
●●
Will projection be involved as a design element?
like. 6.
What is the color scheme of your costumes?
7.
Are there specific technical needs of your dance related to lighting?
Is there a point at which the dance can be video
5.2 Communicating the Design Creating a lighting design involves a number of steps bringing together the artistic and technical
81 CREATING THE LIGHTING DESIGN
elements into one elegant presentation. Though the
cases, this software even allows the designer to pre-
designer creates the concept for the lighting design,
program the show before ever entering the space. I
it is actually the stagehands that set up all of the
personally prefer to use such software for presentation
lighting equipment for the production. For this reason,
purposes and cueing in the theatre, but there are a
there is a series of design drawings and paperwork
number of different approaches. Some such programs
necessary for communicating the design specifics to
like WYSIWYG and ESP Vision work with a number of
a crew of electricians who implement the designer’s
different configurations. Other programs, like grandMA
specifications. Though the choreographer should not
3D, are designed to work specifically with a certain line
be expected to understand all of the requirements of
of lighting consoles.
creating these design drawings and paperwork, it is important to have a passing familiarity with all of the
Draftings: The Light Plot
elements. Such an understanding invariably leads to an
The light plot is a type of drafting. A drafting is a
increased appreciation for the job of the designer and
specialized drawing produced through mechanical
his/her role within the production.
means for the purpose of communicating details. It
Visual Communication
can be hand-drafted or created by CAD software, such as Vectorworks® or AutoCAD®. Draftings are always
The lighting designer tends to produce considerably
executed in scale, meaning that they include all details
fewer drawings or visual representations of his/her
with accurate sizes, but proportionately shrunk down
finalized design than the scenic, costume, or projections
by a certain amount. For instance, a ½˝ scale drafting
designers. Much of this is due to the fact that lighting
means that every ½˝ measured on the drafting is equal
works atop the palette of and in conjunction with those
to 1 foot in the real world.
other design elements. It is much more common to find the lighting designer communicating ideas through visual research, storyboards, or verbal exchanges than through a traditional rendering medium. This seems to be even more prevalent in dance lighting than in theatrical lighting. For all that, though, there are a number of methods commonly used by lighting designers to communicate the design idea.
The purpose of a light plot is to include all of the necessary technical information of the lighting design needed by the electricians to hang, circuit, and focus the design (Figure 5.1). Light plots are drafted atop a plan view of the theatre space and any included scenery. This drafting is provided to the lighting designer by the theatre staff or scenic designer. A plan view is a drafting done from a bird’s eye view of the theatre, looking down
Pre-visualization
on the performance space.
As the prevalence of 3D rendering and CAD (Computer
Light plots include hanging positions, lighting
Aided Drafting) technology has increased, more
instruments, circuiting and dimmer information, focus
designers depend on pre-visualization programs to
(where the light is pointed), color, and other information,
create a realistic representation of their design on the
such as if the light uses a gobo or accessory. Another
computer. Such programs allow the lighting designer
important aspect of the light plot is the instrument key.
to input a 3D model of the theatre, scenery, and
An instrument key is an information box included on the
human figures into a program with the exact lighting
drafting that shows all of the symbols used for lighting
fixtures included in their hanging positions. In some
instruments and accessories. This key will include the
82 PRODUCTION AREAS
FIGURE 5.1
A repertory light plot used for a dance concert.
83 CREATING THE LIGHTING DESIGN
F I G UR E 5. 2
An instrument key, featuring a number of different lighting instruments.
INSTQUMENT k:EY PRACTICAL
instrument name, beam spread, and symbols for any included gobos or accessories (Figure 5.2). FYI: Drafting Standards Light plots for theatre and dance use a standardized
I I 50UQCE: 4 "J PAQNE:L
system of notation developed by USITT (the United States Institute for Theatre Technology) called “Recommended Practices for Theatrical Lighting
soo
Design Graphics.” There are specific symbols used
50UQCE: 4 SOOE:G
to represent certain types of lighting instruments, accessories, and hanging positions. Following these recommended practices helps stagehands across
36]
the country clearly understand the intent of the
50UQCE: 4 3GOE:G
'c-----"
standards for preparing a light plot and lighting symbols tend to vary. USITT publishes “Recommended Practices for
' I
lighting designer. It is worth noting that international
50UQCE: 4 ~GOE:G
Theatrical Lighting Design Graphics” online at the website www.usitt.org. At the time of publication, it is located on the Lighting Design & Technology Commission page.
50UQCE: ~GOE:G
LEGENO PUQPOSe COLOQ
SeAJS~f2eAO UNIT# ; OIMMef2 CHANNeL
Draftings: The Lighting Section A lighting section is another drafting that depicts the theatre in a side view, removing one half of the theatre at the centerline (Figure 5.3). The purpose of the lighting section is to help the designer visualize the theatre architecture, scenery, and masking in the context of lighting positions and equipment. The lighting section helps the designer consider where best to place lighting instruments in the theatre space to accomplish the desired visual effect. As with the light plot, a section view of the theatre will be provided by the scenic designer or theatre staff.
Lighting Design Paperwork A big part of the lighting designer’s job is the creation of design paperwork to be used in conjunction with the
84 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 5. 3
A lighting section, indicating lighting positions, instruments, and masking.
light plot for executing the design. Most paperwork
today to see it created in a drafting program or through
follows a standard spreadsheet layout, utilizing rows and
specially designed paperwork software, like John
columns with outlined borders to keep the information
McKernon’s LightWright. Included below is a list of
properly grouped. The order of information varies
some of the common types of paperwork.
according to the type of paperwork, but the function remains the same—a list of all information related to
Channel Hookup
any lighting instrument in the light plot. In many cases,
The channel hookup, or hookup for short, is a list
paperwork is more important to the electricians setting
designed to show the channels on a lighting console
up the equipment than the plot itself.
and the information about the lighting instruments
Paperwork was once done by the lighting designer or assistant designer by hand, but it is more common
controlled by a given channel. It includes information such as channel, dimmer, hang position, instrument
85 CREATING THE LIGHTING DESIGN
F I G UR E 5. 4
• R&J
A simple hookup sheet.
10-2-()8
2
•
3 4
•• _D_Un __
5
•
40
Source 4 19deg
575W
X
R12
PORT 2
20
6
• 2
34
Source 4 26deg
575W
IV
R12
PORT 2
19
7
•
4
33
Source 4 26deg
575W
Ill
R12
PO_fll_2
18
8 9 0
• 6 • 17 • 18
10
Source 4 19deg
575W
R60
PORT 2
17
39
Sou·rce 4 1'9 deg
575W
R12
PORT 2
16
38
Source 4 19deg
575W
XI IX VIII
R12
PORT 2
15
9
Source 4 19deg
575W
X
R60
PORT 2
14
37
Source 4 19deg
575W
R12
PORT 2
13
32
Source 4 26deg
575W
R12
PORT 2
12
31
Source 4 26deg
575W
R12
PORT 2
11
8
Source 4 19deg
575W
R60
PORT 2
10
16
4
Source 4 '2•6deg
575W
VII II I IX IV
R60
PORT 2
9
17 18 19 22 24 26 27 28 29
3
Source 4 26deg
575W
Ill
R60
PORT 2
8
36
Source 4 19deg
575W
VI
R12
PORT2
35
Souroe 4 19deg
575W
v
7
R12
PORT 2
6
7
Source 4 19deg
575W
R60
PORT 2
5
6
Source 4 19deg
575W
R60
PORT 2
4
2
Source 4 '2•6deg
575W
R60
PORT 2
3
1
Source 4 26deg
575W
R60
PORT 2
2
5
Source 4 19deg
575W
VIII VII II I VI XVII XVI
R60
PORT2
1
R12
PORT 1
12
R12
P0~ 1
11
___________________
m_e~dC~ ban _n _e ~i.--------------------------olo_r
1
2
•• 111
3
•
4 5 6 7 8 9
• • • • • •
20
•
2 22 23 24
25
• • • • •
26
• 30
10
12 14 15
46
Source 4 '2•6deg
575W
45
Source 4 26deg
575W_
number, type, wattage, and focus. A channel hookup is
top to bottom in the case of vertical positions such as
shown in Figure 5.4.
booms. This information allows technicians to quickly
Instrument Schedule An instrument schedule is similar to the channel
identify lighting instruments when hanging, focusing, or troubleshooting.
hookup, but it sorts the information according to the
Color Cut Lists
hang position of the theatre. This includes fixture
Another type of paperwork useful to electricians is
information for every lighting instrument in a given
the color cut list. Gel comes from the manufacturer in
position, sorted in fixture order. Fixtures are numbered
a large sheet that must be cut down to fit in different
on a light plot from stage left to stage right and from
lighting instruments. The color cut list includes the
86 PRODUCTION AREAS
different types of gels organized by manufacturer,
pictorial example of how the stage is divided into
including the color number, number of cuts, and size
control and, at times, color. Figure 5.5 is a magic sheet
of gel cuts. This paperwork may sometimes include the
created for Hubbard Street Dance Chicago, illustrating
necessary number of gel frames, as well.
what channels are used for controlling different lights. In this example, the magic sheet is divided into
Magic Sheets
individual systems of lighting, such as back lighting,
A magic sheet, or cheat sheet, is a piece of paperwork
side lighting, etc.
designed by the lighting designer to help in the process of cueing the show. It is personalized to how
5.3 Hang and Focus
the lighting designer likes to work. As such, there is
Once the lighting plot has been finalized and all
no right or wrong on how a magic sheet should be set
the lighting equipment moved into the theatre, the
up. The goal of the magic sheet is to have a simple
process of hanging and focusing the lights begins. The lighting designer may not be involved with the process of hanging the lights, though it is not uncommon to see them participate. Lighting equipment will be hung by stagehands called electricians, with the master electrician heading up the work call. Typically the process begins with hanging the lights in their appropriate locations, followed by circuiting the lights into the appropriate dimmers. It is essential at this point to record all information and changes onto the updated light plot. Once the hanging and circuiting has occurred, the lighting designer will run the light focus. This is the process of instructing the electricians on the appropriate focus, shutter cut, and diffusion of the light. A common focus involves moving a lighting instrument to the focus point onstage, adding any necessary gobos, shuttering off of scenery or unwanted positions, and adjusting the diffusion of the instrument to create the desired visual quality of light. In touring productions, it is common for the crew to
F I G UR E 5. 5
Magic sheet for Hubbard Street’s Winter Series, Princess Grace Awards: New Works at the Museum of Contemporary Art Chicago’s Edlis Neeson Theater. Photo courtesy of Hubbard Street Dance Chicago.
use something called a focus chart. The focus chart is a specific type of paperwork that includes focus information for every lighting instrument in the lighting rig. It includes the focus position (in relation to the center and proscenium line), if the instrument is spot or flood focused, shutter cut information, and any
87 CREATING THE LIGHTING DESIGN
necessary information about color and gobos. Though
cues, but if a dark time is not scheduled you can be
this is less common for resident companies, it is a way
assured this will be the case.
of life for commercial dance tours.
Cueing the Show
5.4 Preparing for Technical Rehearsals
Cueing the show is one of the most important steps in
Technical rehearsals are a time-consuming and
creating lighting design. It is also one of the last steps in
laborious process devoted to getting all of the technical
the design process. Like many other steps in the design
details of the production in place before opening. As the
process, cueing is a personal approach arrived at by
lighting designer, there are a number of details to be
years of experience on the part of the lighting designer.
addressed before heading into tech.
The lighting designer should enter into this process
Preparing to Cue As the lighting designer prepares for the process of writing cues, there are a few basic questions that must
being fully familiar with the dance piece and with a plan of attack for creating cues. The following section details some thoughts on the cueing process.
be addressed in order to be prepared. Taking time to
Cue Sheets
prepare for cueing sessions can save a lot of time and
Just like the process of writing a paper, creating a
energy down the road.
lighting design requires an organized plan, taking into
Is Everything Set Up?
account the entire dance piece and the changes that occur to the lighting during the performance. A cue
While this may seem like a basic question, it is one of
sheet is a type of paperwork used to plan out all of the
the most important questions to ask. Before the lighting
lighting cues for a performance. It is typically presented
designer begins the cueing process it is a good idea to
in a spreadsheet format, featuring cues and cue
ask the master electrician if all of the lights have been
information in chronological order (Figure 5.6). A cue
hung, focused, gelled, and tested for proper operation.
sheet often contains the cue number, information about
A dimmer check (using the hookup paperwork to check
when the cue is called, fade times, and a description
each dimmer in the system for proper function) should
of the action of the cue. Like magic sheets, many
be done at the top of each day.
designers customize their own cue sheets to include
Dark Time
information they find the most useful. The cue sheet will be used by the designer to write cues and then
In the period leading up to technical rehearsals a
later given to the stage manager for use in calling cues
number of different departments will be vying for time
during the dance.
in the theatre. Everyone has a lot to accomplish in a short period of time. This is why it is so important for the lighting designer to schedule dark time in the theatre—a period of time in which all of the theatre’s auditorium and work lights will be turned off so the lighting can be seen under show conditions. Nothing is so frustrating to the lighting designer as having to compete with an offstage work light while trying to write
88 PRODUCTION AREAS
FYI: The Paper Tech Some dance companies have a special meeting called the paper tech, before going into the tech process. The paper tech is a meeting at which all of the designers with cues meet with the stage manager and choreographer to discuss the
FIGURE 5.6
A cue sheet, indicating all cues and pertinent information.
Cue List : PHASES OF DARK Cue# 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
Prompt: Preshow Cued with curtain speech Dancers in places Music begins Skye on pointe Trio enters SR Upstage group exits DSR lift Upstage group enters Trio exits Abbie fl ies in on swing Pas de deux All exit
1/5/13
Designer: J . HOPGOOD
nme
placement of cues. This can involve scenery, lighting, sound, projections, and special effects. Paper tech is useful for getting all of the cues in the stage manager’s prompt book and giving an opportunity to talk through the entire dance. If your company does not do paper techs, it is important to confer with the stage manager before heading into tech so he or she can be prepared for calling the show.
4 4 6 9 4 4 4 6 8 4 9 12 3
Description I Notes : Sets up pre-show look Blackout for dancers to take places Lights up on scene - slow fade in Shift to warmer lighting Group freezes Listen for cello Slow fade out
to the next cue. Depending on the nature of the dance, the cues may build atop one another or be completely different looks having little to do with one another. The next consideration is fade time. Fade time means the amount of time it takes for the current cue to disappear while the subsequent cue comes up. Rapid fade times create an abrupt shift, whereas longer fade times create a subtle shift from one cue to the next. It is important for the designer to watch the design in proper order to ensure the timing works for the
The Lighting Console As discussed in Chapter 4, the lighting console is a specialized piece of equipment used for controlling lighting equipment. Today’s consoles are computers with unique control interfaces that vary between different manufacturers. It is important for the designer
dance piece.
The Cueing Process As I mentioned before, the cueing process can vary wildly from designer to designer. There are, however, some considerations that will apply to most cue
to understand the individual console and its use. The
sessions:
console is used to create a look onstage and then save
1.
The tech table. One common convention seen
the parameters into its memory for playback at a later
in most theatres is the use of tech tables for the
time.
cueing and tech process. A tech table is a position
The process of writing cues in the lighting board begins
set up in the auditorium from which the designers
by setting levels of brightness with individual lighting instruments until a suitable look is achieved. Once this look is saved as a cue, the designer can proceed
and choreographer can work. The tech table allows the designers to see their work from the vantage point of the audience, rather than from
89 CREATING THE LIGHTING DESIGN
the control booth, which is typically far away from
consideration. Without this, the lighting levels will
the stage and from an awkward vantage point.
invariably have to be adjusted once the stage is
Typically, there will be multiple tech tables set
filled with bodies. Another necessary consideration
up for different departments. The lighting tech
is the costume color. Whenever possible, include
table should include sufficient space for a lighting
some fabric or clothing that is a similar color to the
console, lighting paperwork, headsets, and
dance costumes. This will give you the opportunity
typically room for the lighting designer’s laptop.
to see how the lighting affects the costume color.
It is common that the stage manager and lighting
2.
4.
music, it can be useful to listen to the music while
tech.
cueing. Especially in instances where fade times
What to bring? When moving into the theatre, it
must sync with music, there is no better way to get it right than working with the music.
is important to consider what things you will want on hand at the tech table. It is always wise to think
5.
Working with a rehearsal video. As mentioned in
ahead so that you don’t find yourself having to leave
previous chapters, a rehearsal video is invaluable
to get something from home. A well-equipped tech
to the cueing process. By referencing the video,
table should include:
you can determine the location of certain moments
●●
pencils and scrap paper;
on the stage and ensure the timing is correct.
●●
all design paperwork and magic sheets;
Likewise, if using a rehearsal video that includes
●●
a flashlight;
music this allows you to include both music and
●●
a stopwatch;
●●
a crescent wrench (keep in mind some union theatres will not allow the designer to touch equipment, but it is always good to be prepared);
●●
a laptop;
●●
a portable hard drive and thumb drives for back up and file transport;
●●
3.
Working with the music. If your dance incorporates
console operator will sit at the tech table once in
surge-protected power strips.
movement in one package. 6.
With or without the choreographer? The lighting designer may create the cues alone or in the presence of the choreographer, depending on the customary practice of the choreographer and dance company. It is best to ask about the usual process if you are working together for the first time. There are benefits and drawbacks to both approaches. If cueing with the choreographer present, you go
Representing the figure. Since dance lighting
into tech knowing that they have seen the cues and
focuses on the dancers, it is important to include
know what to expect. Unfortunately, this can lead
some type of representation of the dancer during
to a longer process than if the designer cues alone.
cueing. If you have volunteers to walk the stage
Depending on the time constraints, it may simply
while cueing, this can be invaluable. Not every
not be feasible. Personally, I like to create my
design has this luxury though. In many cases, I
lighting cues alone in the theatre while watching
have used a costumer’s dress form as a stand-in
the rehearsal video and making any necessary
for a dancer. In a pinch, I have used a rolling chair
tweaks to the programming in the first mark-
or a music stand. Ultimately, having something
through of the dance.
to focus your light on is the most important
90 PRODUCTION AREAS
7.
The Paper Tech. Paper Tech is a meeting that
5.6 Chapter Review
brings the stage manager, designers, and
The job of creating the lighting design is a long and
choreographer together for a discussion of the dance and when cues are called. This happens more often in academic theatre environments, but it can sometimes be useful for dance as well. More often, it is useful to have a combined final cueing session with the choreographer, stage manager, and designer in the darkened theatre to see how the lighting looks. It is important to have some type of stand-in for the dancers: actual people, dress forms with colored fabric similar to the costumes draped over them, or even something simple like a music stand with fabric hung over it. The purpose for this is that, since dance lighting is mostly from the side, you cannot see the details of the design
multifaceted process that combines both artistic and technical expertise. The lighting designer must be a master communicator, utilizing visual imagery, verbal and written communication to convey a design idea. In creating a lighting design, the lighting designer must use draftings, drawings/renderings, and paperwork to communicate his/her ideas. Planning and paperwork are central skills of the lighting designer, used to ensure continuity from his/her initial concept through the final performance. Through a study of the lighting design process, we gain an increased appreciation for the job of the designer and his/her role within the production.
without a figure on stage to be illuminated. This
Review Questions
rehearsal is a good time for the stage manager to
1. What is pre-visualization?
get cues recorded into his/her notes.
5.5 Technical Rehearsals Technical rehearsals are the rehearsals dedicated to working through the dances with all technical elements included. The idea of technical rehearsals varies wildly from dance company to dance company.
2. What is the type of drafting executed in a plan view that is used to communicate the technical information of the lighting design? 3. What is an instrument key? 4. What information should be included in an instrument key?
Some companies have a “tech week” that incorporates
5. Describe a lighting section.
many days of tech, followed by dress rehearsals, then
6. What type of paperwork sorts the information
opening. This method is most common in academic environments. When looking at professional dance companies, however, the deciding factor for length and number of technical rehearsals is the theatre space. If the dance company owns its own space, it is common to see longer periods of tech. If the company is renting the space, the tech process might be limited to one day or even a few hours before going into the performance. Refer to Chapter 2 to see a breakdown of spacing rehearsals/cue-to-cue, technical rehearsals, and dress
according to lighting hang positions? 7. What is a focus chart? 8. What type of paperwork is used to plan out all of the lighting cues for a performance? 9. What type of paperwork does the lighting designer use as a visual example of how the stage is divided into control and, at times, color? 10. What term describes the time it takes to move from one lighting cue to another?
rehearsals.
91 CREATING THE LIGHTING DESIGN
Chapter 5 Project: Thinking Like a Lighting Designer
shaping our understanding of it in the un/natural world. Seth is interested in framing and telling stories. His work is characterized by an elemental approach to light
As you have seen in this chapter, lighting can be
through simplicity, constrained color palettes, and the
difficult to discuss. One tool that lighting designers
use of space and scenery to create textures and focal
use to aid in the process of communicating their
interest.
ideas is visual research. The old adage “a picture is worth a thousand words” is particularly true when describing light. This project will focus on the use of visual research to communicate an idea through lighting.
Recent designs include: Matthew Passion, directed by Peter Sellars; Come, and Back Again, with David Dorfman Dance; King Lear, directed by Kevin Moriarty; The Agony and the Ecstasy of Steve Jobs, by Mike Daisey, directed by Jean Michele Gregory; Radio Play, directed by Kip Fagan;
Frequently, lighting designers are called on to
The Whale, directed by Hal Brooks; Black Snow, directed
communicate an emotion or mood through lighting.
by Mikhael Garver; The Lily’s Revenge, by Taylor Mac; and
The properties of dance lighting (brightness, color,
Middlemen, directed by Josie Whittlesey.
direction/angle, visual quality, and movement) can
Seth holds an MFA in design from NYU’s Tisch School of
be used to successfully create a feeling through lighting. For this project, you will be given a list of words for which you must find an image that communicates this idea through the use of lighting. For each of the five examples below, choose a photo that illustrates how one of the properties of dance lighting could be used to communicate the
Design for Stage and Film, and a BA from Ohio Wesleyan University, where he studied theatre, philosophy, and the fine arts. He is the recipient of the NY International Fringe Festival Award for Outstanding Lighting, and has twice been nominated for the American Theatre Wing Hewes Design Award, Production Design.
idea. Include a brief description of why you feel the
What was your training in lighting design?
lighting communicates the word.
I started designing lighting as a teenager for my high
1 Fear 2. Claustrophobia 3. Excitement 4. Anger 5. Physical attraction
school and at a local rock club in Houston. I have a bachelor’s in theatre from Ohio Wesleyan University and an MFA from NYU’s School of Design for Stage and Film. Do you have a dance background/any formalized training in dance?
The Lighting Designer’s Perspective: An Interview with Seth Reiser
I took a few dance classes in college, but I wouldn’t say I had any training.
Seth Reiser is a New York-based lighting designer
How did you first start working in dance design?
working in theatre, dance, and music. His interest
In high school we had a pretty great dance department
in light comes from the extraordinary effect that the
and we got to light their performances twice a year.
environment surrounding an event or story has in
Lighting dance at all levels of my education has played a major role.
92 PRODUCTION AREAS
I know that you recently collaborated with David
can be a much louder voice, whereas in theatre the lighting
Dorfman Dance on Come, and Back Again. Could you tell
needs to play a subtler role, generally speaking. Practically
us a bit about the collaborative process for that piece?
speaking, plays require more visibility when it comes to
C&BA was one of the dreamiest processes I’ve ever been
the actors, while dance is all about form and the air that
a part of. The piece took a long time to get together. David had spent more than a year on the piece before I even turned a single light on, and I had just over a year after that
surrounds the piece. Dance lighting is fun because you get to invest more emotionally speaking, the same way you would with music. It’s more abstract, so the lighting can be
to create the lighting for the piece. At first there was no
more abstract too.
set and we were working in the studio at UCONN. I made
Can you describe your ideal process for working with
a crude set out of paper and cobbled together some lights in addition to the lights in the space and we made what I think of as the first version of the piece. We had three other stages of the piece before we premiered it at BAM in October of 2013. Over the year we worked on the piece, it changed dramatically but the ideas I came up with in that studio came through in every subsequent version. A big part of that is David’s “yes, and” approach to the work; new ideas are always stacked on top of and combined with the old ideas so nothing is ever discarded until the end of the process when we all start trimming and honing in on the final product. This collecting of ideas became a major
choreographers? I think it’s really hard to nail down an ideal process. Some projects need lots of time, others need 30 minutes; some need tons of space, another just a chair; some need strict limits, others need to be free of all limits. I think the most ideal process is a process you choose and becomes part of the piece. This happened during C&BA without knowing it. The process suited the piece and helped create the story. We had time and made mistakes that stuck. It’s like life that way; life happens and it becomes part of you, you can’t put it down. What advice would you give a young artist interested in
theme in the piece. It’s all about what we carry with us; it’s
lighting for dance?
about everything we don’t leave behind. That stuff piles up
See everything you can. Talk to everyone about their work.
and is a part of who we are.
Find the people you love to work with and work with them
How do you find lighting differs for a dance and a theatrical project? I find lighting for both very satisfying, but in different ways.
as much as possible. Email people you don’t know when you see their beautiful work and get a coffee with them. Be part of a community and contribute.
Light for dance becomes another voice in the piece and it
93 CREATING THE LIGHTING DESIGN
CHAPTER 6 SOUND Music begins where the possibilities of language end. Jean Sibelius
Hubbard Street Dancer Emilie Leriche in Counterpoint by Kyle Abraham. Costume by Reid Bartelme and Harriet Jung. Lighting Design by Dan Scully. Photo Source by Todd line toRosenberg. go here
Sound is a fundamental concern in dance. All dances
Pre-recorded Music
are performed with some type of sound, even if it’s only
The easiest method for many choreographers is to
the sound of the dancers moving their bodies across the stage, breathing and interacting with their environment. This is why I prefer the use of the word sound as opposed to accompaniment, as I believe it covers a wider array of possibilities for music, sound, or effects that accompany the dance performance. Whether the dance is performed to music, with an accompanying “soundscape” of sound effects, or performed in silence, sound creates a dramatic impact on how the audience perceives the dance piece. The following chapter examines the use of sound in dance performances and begins the conversation about how sound is created, reinforced, and reproduced for each performance.
6.1 Thinking About Sound For most dancers, rhythm and music are a dayto-day part of their lives. That said, many dancers and choreographers might not be as familiar with the technique and craft that goes into creating and reproducing sound and music for a live performance. There are a number of considerations that go into thinking about sound for the stage.
Music, Sound, or Silence? The process for how a choreographer chooses sound is as unique as each choreographer. Sometimes a choreographer picks a piece of music to which a
select a piece of pre-recorded music as accompaniment for a dance. The only requirement of pre-recorded sound is a sound system and a sound operator to run the audio. This is one of the most common choices for dance companies as it eliminates the need for live performers and will always be a precise reproduction of the music. In addition, in touring companies very little setup is required. While this is an excellent choice in terms of time and money, it can lead to the question of copyright laws. Section 6.7 at the end of this chapter addresses the various legal concerns for using music in a dance performance.
The Composer If a dance requires original music, a composer must be secured to work on the project. This process is unique to the individual choreographer/composer relationship, but normally the composer would need to see the dance several times in order to understand concepts like the choreographer’s intent, internal timing, and the dramatic arc of the dance piece. The composer may write the music for live performance, create a recording of musicians performing the piece, or provide an electronic recording of the performance. The method of delivering the music affects the number of additional personnel required for the performance.
dance will be set. Other times the dance is completely
The Musicians
choreographed before he or she can consider an
Unless the composer alone will record the music,
appropriate piece of music or sound. In other situations, the choreographer might work in conjunction with a composer to create a new piece of music specifically for a dance. Ultimately, the question that must be asked of each piece is, should there be music, sound, or silence accompanying the dance (or a combination thereof)? The answer to this question tells you what kind of support your production will require.
96 PRODUCTION AREAS
musicians will be required for some portion of the process. It could be that the music will be recorded live for playback during the dance. In this case, studio musicians would be hired to work with the composer and to perform for the recording, along with a sound engineer. If this is not the case, then musicians will have to be secured for live accompaniment of the
dance. In this case, there are a number of concerns,
technician would not have insight into the dances
such as placement of the musicians onstage, the
themselves beyond the limited time of having seen them
use of microphones to reinforce their sound, what
in the performance space.
the musicians will wear, securing music stands and providing light suitable for reading, and, of course,
Reality Check: What Resources are Available?
paying the musicians. While the process of planning for
I have seen many dance performances suffer over
more performers can seem daunting, it is a rewarding
the years due to a choreographer or designer taking
experience to perform in a live environment with
it for granted that resources were available when, in
dancers and musicians working in sync.
truth, they were not and simply did not fit within the
The Sound Designer
production budget. This is most often a case of making assumptions and not asking the right questions. Always
As mentioned in Chapter 1, the sound designer is
approach a project by finding out what resources are
responsible for facilitating all of the sound needs for
available to you: equipment, personnel, budget, and
the production. A sound designer might function as a
space. These four resources will affect what choices
composer and create original music for a production,
can be made and should allow you to proceed into
but he/she is also involved in the selection of audio
the project with realistic expectations of what can be
equipment, recording and editing of sound, and creating
accomplished. The practical person will keep these
the cues for sound playback—something a composer
factors in mind while solving the artistic challenges of
would rarely, if ever, be involved with. It is a lucky dance
the production.
company that has a resident sound designer who can facilitate all of these needs.
The Technicians
6.2 Sound Design for Dance Sound design, much like lighting, combines artistry with technical craft. Sound designers must be familiar with
In most instances, the sound designer will not actually
composition, music history, sound recording/editing
run the sound for performances. This duty falls to the
techniques, and remain up to date in the constantly
sound technician. The role of the sound technician is
changing world of sound equipment. In addition to
to set up speakers, microphones, and communication
creating sound and music, dance sound design requires
headsets in addition to running the sound system
an understanding of dance practice and techniques and
during a performance. Depending on the size of the
how varying performance styles are connected to sound.
performance space and its staff, there may be one or
Considering all of these tasks, a competent sound
more sound technicians.
designer is invaluable to the dance company. Since so
In some cases, the dance company may not employ a sound designer but depend on the work of the performance space’s sound technician. It is important to recognize that, while the position of a sound technician is essential to the overall production, a technician would normally be involved in only running sound—not
many aspects of dance are interconnected with sound, the choreographer and sound designer will often work together closely on a dance piece. For this reason, it is helpful for the choreographer to have a common understanding of some basic sound and music concepts when collaborating.
the creation of design elements. Likewise, a sound
97 SOUND
6.3 Functions of Sound Design
Mood/Atmosphere
Like lighting design, I find it useful to discuss the
In most art forms, mood is one of the easiest things to
purpose of sound within the overall dance production.
identify, yet one of the hardest to put into words. Mood is
This can be addressed through the functions of sound
an emotional response to something experienced. In the
design, or what sound design can accomplish for a
case of sound, mood is evoked through what is heard,
dance production. Listed below are six functions of
and often depends on the listener’s past experiences.
sound design for dance.
Since sound is only one element of the production, it is
Audibility Audibility, or the ability to hear a sound, is the primary function of sound design. Pre-recorded music, sound effects, voiceovers, and live accompaniment must all be set to an audible level so that the audience can appreciate the sound without struggling to hear. The challenge of having multiple sounds is that they can compete with one another, so this may lead to the need to use microphones to reinforce sound of certain
important to consult with the choreographer and other members of the production team to make sure everyone is aiming for the common response. Atmosphere is a term commonly associated with sound. In sound, the atmosphere is a collection of the types of sounds that make up a certain environment or moment. In this context, the term soundscape is commonly used to indicate the combination of various sounds and effects to create an immersive acoustical environment.
aspects to be heard over others.
Rhythm
Performance
Rhythm is one of those terms that naturally applies to
Sometimes sound functions as a performance element within a dance. In tap dance, hip-hop, or modern music/ dance performance pieces, the dancer doubles as musical performer. As such, the sound designer must work closely with dancers to reinforce the sound of their movements. In a modern context, it is common to see dancers interact with props or musical instruments to create sound. In such a performance, the lines between musical and dance performance are blurred.
Accompaniment Accompaniment is the function of sound design that
both music and dance. In dance, it can be used to refer to a measured movement, typically with some sense of repetition. In music, rhythm refers to the combination of strong and weak pulses in the music to create a beat. This sense of pattern is what leads to a waltz being in three, since the strong beat comes on the one, followed by two more weak beats (one two three, two two three ...). Since sound and music are frequently used as accompaniment, the rhythm directly reflects on the choreography. Movement can work in sync or against the rhythm of the sound design, creating a sense of harmony or conflict.
refers to the use of music or sound to complement the
When considering rhythm, it is important to look at
dance performance—supporting, or partnering with, the
the entirety of the dance performance. While one
dancer. Though accompaniment is most often thought of
section may have one type of rhythm it is possible
as live musicians playing onstage, it can come in many
that others will have a different type. This can lead to
different forms (live music, pre-recorded music, sound
an overall rhythmic arc within the piece that is worth
effects, etc.).
acknowledging.
98 PRODUCTION AREAS
Reinforcement The final function of sound design on my list is reinforcement. Reinforcement simply means to strengthen or increase something. Sound can reinforce a number of different aspects of the production. It can be a certain sound effect that works in conjunction with a dancer’s movement. Likewise, it could refer to how a piece of music reinforces the dramatic action or overall theme of the dance. Finally, the term sound reinforcement refers to the act of amplifying sound through the use of microphones and speakers. In dance
F IG UR E 6. 1
A low frequency pitch (top) and a higher frequency pitch (bottom). Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
this could be used for musical instruments, the spoken
the frequency, the higher the pitch, and vice versa
word, or used to amplify the physical sounds produced
(Figure 6.1). Pitch is important in creating harmony or
by the dancers’ bodies.
dissonance in sound. When hearing two or more tones
6.4 Properties of Sound Design
played together, the notes will either work together to create a harmonious or dissonant blend. Adjusting the
The properties of sound design can be described as
pitch of a sound can go a long way towards creating a
the controllable qualities of sound, or things that
soothing or discomforting sound design.
you can change about sound within the context of a dance production. The following list details all of the
Sound Quality
properties. Keep in mind that the properties of sound
Sound quality is a term that has many synonyms. In
design also affect all of the functions listed above.
musical terms, it is often referred to as timbre, or
Volume
tonal quality. Timbre (pronounced tam-bur) is the quality of a musical note or sound that distinguishes
Volume is a term that most of us use on a regular basis.
it from others. In the simplest terms, it is what makes
Like brightness in lighting, volume is a relative term.
one instrument sound different from another, even
For some people, certain volumes can seem very loud
if they are both playing the same note. There are a
whereas they may not affect the person sitting next to
number of different factors that affect sound quality
them. Volume is measured in decibels (dB). If a sound
of a musical instrument, like the materials that make
is amplified through a sound system, you have the
the instrument, the humidity or temperature of the
ability to increase or decrease the amount of output
environment, or any imperfections to the instrument
through the speakers, thus manipulating how much the
itself. When creating music or sound effects, sound
audience can hear.
quality can be affected in a number of different ways.
Pitch
The most common method is the use of soundprocessing equipment like an equalizer or other devices
Another property of sound is pitch, or how high or low
to change the tonal quality of the audio signal. There is
a note sounds. Pitch is directly related to frequency,
no doubt that sound quality can directly affect the mood
the speed at which a sound wave vibrates. The faster
of a given moment in a performance.
99 SOUND
When discussing sound quality on an audio recording,
so easily paired together since movement is such an
one of the biggest concerns is the file format of the
essential component of music itself.
recording. Today, most theatres are equipped with computers for audio playback. This means that the sound files used will be in a digital format. When dealing with digital audio, there are a number of different file types for different uses. Compressed audio files like MP3 were designed to be smaller data packets so they could be downloaded quicker through the Internet. There is always a trade-off between the size of the file and the sound quality of the recording. Smaller files tend to include sounds that were not present in the original recording and have a smaller dynamic range than the original, as well. Whenever possible, always use the uncompressed audio formats such as WAV or AIFF for playback and you will be much happier with the audio quality.
Direction Direction refers to where a sound is perceived to originate. In lighting, direction was related to the placement of the lighting instrument. For sound, direction is directly influenced by the placement of speakers in the sound system. When creating a sound design, it is important to consider the direction from which sound should come in relation to the audience and the stage. The change of direction can assist in creating immersive sound environments if done well or become disorienting if executed too quickly.
Movement In musical terms, movement can have different meanings. A movement within a piece of music refers to different sections within the composition— each frequently written in a different key and with a different mood. In another connotation, movement can refer to the way that music rhythmically varies within a composition, creating a sensation of physical movement. It is easy to see how music and dance are
100 PRODUCTION AREAS
In audio terms, movement can have a more technical meaning. For a modern sound system, any amplified sound has the ability to pan, or to be moved from one speaker to another within the system. Therefore, movement is the ability to mechanically manipulate an audio signal to give it the appearance of a changing direction.
Mix In audio terms, a mix is the combination of different audio signals into one cohesive output. For live productions, this might be a combination of live music, pre-recorded sound effects, and reinforcement of the dancers onstage. The mix is how all of these signals are balanced to create the resulting sound that the audience hears through the speakers. If everything were heard at equal levels, there is a potential for “muddiness” in the mix, as one sound drowns out another. Instead, it is important to identify the sounds that are most essential to the dance and make those prominent.
6.5 Audio Equipment When discussing sound with a designer or technician, the conversation can quickly move towards the realm of a foreign language for many. Though it may seem intimidating, at first, it is important for dancers and choreographers to have a basic understanding of audio equipment and terminology. There are entire books that could be devoted to the discussion of audio equipment. This section includes only the essential pieces of equipment within a sound system and describes their function.
Input Source When discussing sound systems, the term input source refers to any type of device that provides an audio signal
to be distributed through the system. For a recording
a belt-pack wireless transmitter that sends a radio
and/or reinforcement system, this is commonly the
signal to a wireless receiver connected to the sound
microphone. For a playback system, the input source
mixer. This audio signal is then sent through the
can be any of a variety of different devices: compact
reinforcement system. For handheld wireless mics,
disc or mini disc players; a computer; a portable
the microphone itself functions as the wireless transmitter.
music player; even a television. Though these are all possibilities, computers are the input source of choice
Boundary microphones: A boundary microphone is
●●
for most playback systems for their ability to run
a special type of microphone that is designed to have
playback software, which far surpasses the function of
a low profile and be placed on a hard, flat surface
other methods.
(like the floor, walls, or a tabletop). The design of a boundary mic places a microphone in a small metal
Microphones
housing mounted onto a flat plate. Though there are
A microphone (often called mic, for short) is a
multiple types of boundary mics, two of the most
mechanical device that turns sound waves into an
popular models come from Crown audio: the PZM
electrical signal. This electrical signal is not powerful
and the PCC. Without going into too much detail,
enough to activate a speaker on its own, though, so it
the PZM picks up sound in all directions around it.
must be sent through other hardware components to
Since it sits on a plate, this is 180° of sound around
boost the signal. While there are many different types of
the mic (called a hemispherical pickup pattern). The
microphone, the two most common for dance purposes
PCC, on the other hand, has a half-unidirectional
are the wireless mic and the boundary mic.
pickup pattern, picking up sound from the front
●●
Wireless microphones: The obvious benefit of a
while rejecting any sound from the rear. Figure 6.2
wireless microphone is the lack of a cable to get
illustrates the pickup patterns of the two types of
in the way of movement. Wireless microphones
boundary mics. One common reason to use these
are typically either handheld or headset models,
mics in dance is to pick up the sound of dancers’
with a miniature microphone that is attached to
feet on the stage. This is ideal for tap or stomp-style
the performer or attached to a headset. For the
dances.
miniature variety, the microphone is connected to
/
I I
I
F I G UR E 6. 2
The PZM and PCC, viewed from the side. Notice the difference in pickup patterns for the two microphones. Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
I
PLATE
PZM
/
I
PCC
\
PLATE 101 SOUND
Mixer
microphone-level signal from mics to what is called line
The mixer (sometimes called the sound board) receives
level. This allows the signal to be powerful enough to
multiple audio signals, processes their individual signals, and creates a “mix” of the different signals to be outputted in different ways (Figure 6.3). It routes signals, sets volume levels, and affects the qualities of the audio signal. Most mixers receive a variety of different signals in a live performance: audio signals from the playback computer; multiple channels of audio from different instruments in the band; boundary microphones on the stage; and more. The mixer also serves an important function of boosting the
F I G UR E 6. 3
A sound mixer with several different channels of control. Photo courtesy of Junior Libby.
102 PRODUCTION AREAS
travel through the system.
Equalizer An equalizer, or EQ, is a device used to affect the frequencies of a sound (Figure 6.4). This device can either boost or limit the types of sound frequencies in an audio signal. The control in your car that features “bass” and “treble” is a form of equalizer, allowing you to adjust the sound to be either lower or brighter. The EQ in a sound system does the same thing, but breaks
F I G UR E 6. 4
A digital equalizer program, used on a computer to manipulate frequencies of sound.
down the audio signal on a much more complex level,
audio signal is not powerful enough to power a speaker
allowing for adjustment of a wider range of frequencies.
and produce sound.
In today’s sound systems, the EQ might be a physical device or a computer program that digitally emulates
Speaker
the process of a traditional EQ.
A speaker works in the opposite fashion of a
Amplifier
microphone—taking an electrical signal and turning it into sound waves we can hear. Most modern
The amplifi er is a type of equipment used to increase
loudspeakers combine two different types of speakers
the audio signals from the input sources from line level
(one suited for low frequencies and one better suited for
to speaker level, an electrical signal powerful enough
high) into one speaker cabinet so that they can produce
to drive a speaker. It is the last stop before the speaker
a wide range of frequencies. A specialized speaker
and a requirement for any speaker to work. Amplifiers
known as a subwoofer, or sometimes just a sub, is
must be plugged into an external power source in order
dedicated to only producing bass tones. As mentioned
to amplify the audio signal. Without an amplifier, the
earlier, all speakers require some type of amplifier to work. Some speakers, however, called self-powered
103 SOUND
speakers, contain the amplifier and speaker in one
software, and speakers or headphones for listening
cabinet, thereby eliminating the need for a separate
to the recording (Figure 6.5). There are hundreds of
amplifier.
variations on a recording system, but these are the basic requirements to record audio.
6.6 Sound Systems Sound systems are a combination of different pieces of audio equipment into a system used for a specific purpose. When looking at sound systems, there are three distinct categories of use: recording systems, playback systems, and reinforcement systems. One or more of these systems might be present in a performance space. For our purposes, we will focus on computerized systems, as most sound recording, editing, and playback are now done on computers.
A playback system is a collection of audio equipment used to play back pre-recorded sound files during a live performance. In the past, these sound recordings were saved on everything from reel-to-reel, compact discs, or minidiscs. Today, almost all live performance venues use some type of computer running a software system to play back audio files. The audio signal is sent out from the computer and sometimes through additional audio equipment before ultimately outputting through the speakers. A common setup might have the audio
A recording system is set up for the purpose of
going through the house mixer, into an EQ, and then out
recording audio for playback at a later time. The
to the amplifiers and speakers (Figure 6.6). Of course,
main components of the system are a microphone,
each setup has its own specific needs and rarely are any
a computer running some type of sound editing
two systems exactly alike.
5=l-0''
lX~ ~RAMIJ\J6
l) RAIL6
I@
lOP Af\JV BOIIOM
l) 6\ILE:'6 ON £:'ACH 611/E:' ?) I066Le:'6 6PACE:'V l~ APARI ?;~ .. PLYwoov uv
HOMA6o-re:' ~OR 60UJ\JV-1/AMPE:'f\Jif\J6 MA60f\JIIe:' ~lf\JI6H ~OR PAIJ\JIIf\J6
Accepting Accepting
Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting
Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting Accepting
138 PRODUCTION AREAS
the platform and damage it or, worse still, have their
is 1´, but for dance applications it is wise to go with a
foot break through the plywood.
deeper tread of 16˝ to 18˝. This allows plenty of room
Typically, platforms will have a layer of Homasote, a sheet good made from compressed recycled paper bits held together with glue. The Homasote dampens the sound of foot traffic on the platforming and offers an added layer of softness over the wooden lid of the platform. For theatrical purposes, most platforms will be covered in hardboard (sometimes called Masonite) as a paintable surface. Masonite can be a particularly slick surface for dance, though, so platforms will sometimes be covered in a layer of Marley for dance applications, though this is much more expensive. Sometimes a platform will be used to create an angled surface on the stage, like a ramp. In theatrical
for the dancer’s foot when quickly going up or down the stairs.
Traps One common device for theatrical performances is the trap door. As mentioned is Chapter 3, many theatres are equipped with a trapped floor that allows for the inclusion of special trap doors for scenic elements or even dancers to enter from below the stage floor. Trap doors are less common in dance applications than theatre, since there is the added complication of sprung floors and Marley used on the dance stage, but they are still a definite possibility.
terminology, any platform that is not level to the stage
8.4 Dance Props
floor is called a rake or raked platform. While raked
What is a prop and who is responsible for providing
platforms are common for theatrical applications and
it? The answer to this simple question seems
musical theatre, they are much less common for dance
to change from company to company. Larger
due to the increased stress placed on the dancer’s body
companies may have a props department with a
and an increased potential for injury. If using a raked
designer and props artists to build the properties. For
platform, the incline should be no greater than a ¾˝
most smaller dance companies, props seem to be
rise per foot.
the domain of the choreographer or, in some cases,
Stairs
the dancers themselves. This is understandable considering how intimate the relationship between
One common element in many scenic designs is the
dancer and prop must be. Understanding the nature
use of stairs. Stairs are obviously used to get from
of props for the given dance company and who is
one level of the stage to another. One important thing
responsible for their design is an important step to the
to consider with stairs for dance are the rise and run
process.
of the stairs. Rise is the height difference between each step and the stage floor. Stairs for dance should
Props Considerations
always have a consistent rise, since any variation in
Props design is a production element that must live
rise could easily lead to a dancer falling and being
in harmony with the scenery and costumes while
injured. The most common rises are 6˝ and 8˝. One
remaining functional for the dancers. This is why
should never exceed a 10˝ rise for dance as it can be
props design frequently falls into the domain of the
difficult for dancers to maneuver. Run is a term used
scenic designer for dance. Whether your production
to define the size of a stair’s tread (the place where the
has a props designer or not, though, it is important to
foot falls on a stair). A common size for stair treads
consider the need for properties, how they will be used
139 SCENERY AND PROPS
in the dance, and who will be responsible for making or
raked platform)? All of these questions will help in
procuring the props. The following list includes some
the design process to create a safe, weight-bearing prop.
important questions to ask regarding the use of props in a dance piece. ●●
Is it a prop, set piece, or a costume?
●
The line between prop, set piece, and costume is often a blurry one. Consider an item like a hat. It can be worn, certainly, but choreographers like Bob Fosse made a career of utilizing costume pieces as props. During initial production meetings try to determine who will be providing these items. Don’t assume that just because you think it’s a prop someone else will too!
●●
Is there a props budget? The question of a props budget is important to consider. Is there a separate line of funds available for props, or do the props need to come from the scenery budget (or some other general fund)? The answer to this question will affect a number of the design choices for props.
●●
●●
How will it be used?
●●
When do your rehearsals begin? Since it is dancers who use dance props, it is important for the designer to see the rehearsal to understand the prop within the context of the dance and see how the dancers use it. One important consideration is the date at which the choreographer needs props for rehearsal. It could be important to try out some rehearsal props before committing to building the show prop. Likewise, in some devised dances, the choreographer might want to bring in a large collection of props and see how the dancers work with them in rehearsal. This will ultimately inform the nature of the choreography.
8.5 Chapter Review Scenery and props design are important production elements to dance. Though they are not necessarily used in all dance productions, when used properly they can enhance the overall quality of the production and
One of the most important questions for any dance
aid in storytelling. Through the use of various scenic
prop is, how will it be used? Does the prop take
elements, the scenic designer creates an environment
abuse during the dance? A chair can easily become
in which the dance unfolds. In addition to defining the
a stepladder or a ramp in the context of a dance.
performance space, the scenery creates interactive
Chances are it would have to be reinforced for safety
elements, sets the time, place, and mood while
though. Make sure to know exactly how the prop will
contributing to the overall style of the dance production.
be used before purchasing or building.
In addition to scenery, props can be used to assist the
Does it need to be weight bearing?
dancers in their storytelling and amplify the moment
One of the most common requests of a dance
onstage. Certainly scenery and props are an important
prop is to be weight bearing. This is an important consideration that requires lots of research on the props designer’s part. What kind of weight does it
consideration for every aspect of dance production.
Review Questions
bear? If it is a dancer, you need to know how much
1. What is stock scenery?
he/she weighs. Does it only need to hold up a dancer
2. Describe a basket weave sprung floor.
standing on it, or will they be jumping? Where will
3. What is the more common name for PVC vinyl
the prop sit on the stage (a flat level surface, or on a
140 PRODUCTION AREAS
sheeting?
4. What is gaffer’s tape? 5. How do gaffer’s tape and Marley tape differ?
8. What are the main differences between a soft flat and a Hollywood flat?
6. What fabric are most scenic drops made from?
9. What is a rake?
7. Describe a soft flat.
10. What is a good size for stair treads?
141 SCENERY AND PROPS
CHAPTER 9 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN Design is interesting to me as it relates to narrative: the design has to support the narrative. Storytelling is the most important thing. Christine Jones
Student dancers from Eastern Michigan University’s production of Guthrie Redux. Choreography by Holly Hobbs. Lighting Design by Jeromy Hopgood. Photo courtesy Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
Like any design area for dance, the scenic design
of questions related to the dance and the scenery and
process is a series of steps in which the designer
props can spark a conversation that gets to the heart
collaborates with the choreographer and other team
of the choreographer’s vision for the production. Some
members to create a visual image that enhances
of these questions mirror those asked in lighting and
the storytelling of the dance. The scenic designer
sound sections of the book, while others are customized
utilizes a number of different skills during the design
to scenery and props in particular. It should be expected
process from research to drawing and painting, model
that the choreographer may not have answers to these
making, creating technical draftings, or working with
questions in your initial conversations. The important
visualization software to create three-dimensional
part is to offer up the right questions to start a dialogue.
renderings. Though the process for each design is
In this way, you can arrive at the solutions together,
unique to the dance and collaborators involved, there
which is always the goal of a successful collaboration.
are some steps commonly utilized during the design process. This chapter discusses the process of working
Talking About Your Dance
from concept to finalizing the design onstage. For
1.
the purposes of the chapter, scenery and props are addressed separately, though it is common to find one designer executing both scenery and props for the same
your dance to communicate. 2.
Like all of the areas of dance design discussed thus
scenery/props should be used related to the script or your vision? 3.
should feel. Try to avoid the temptation to explain
device to help communicate the choreographer’s vision
your concept—it tends to be more effective to focus,
for the dance. Unlike lighting and sound, however,
instead, on what the dance or moments should feel
scenery and props are tangible, physical items with consideration for how they will be used, these design elements can inhibit the storytelling and, in some situations, create an unsafe environment for the
like. 4.
In what way do you see the dancers using the space for movement?
5.
Are there ways in which the scenery could facilitate this movement style mentioned above?
dancers. For these reasons, it is essential that the designer(s) working on scenery and props have an open
Give a few adjectives or short descriptive phrases to describe how your dance (or individual sections)
far, scenery and props should function as a storytelling
which the dancer must interface. If inserted without
Is your dance based on a specific story or work of art? If so, are there any specifications for how
dance.
9.1 Working with the Choreographer
Describe in two to three sentences what you want
6.
Are there specific technical needs of your dance
and thorough discourse with the choreographer to
related to scenery/props (i.e. flying a dancer,
establish how the design elements will be utilized in the
climbing a wall, etc.)?
dance and their overall purpose to the storytelling.
Practical Concerns
Setting Goals
Like the other design areas on which we have focused,
Going into the process it is important to start discussing
there are some practical concerns related to scenery
goals for the design. As with the other design areas
that can affect the decision making of the scenic
we have discussed thus far, starting off with a series
designer. Make sure to ask these questions early in the
144 PRODUCTION AREAS
collaborative process to identify potential challenges
details some of the methods used by a scenic designer
along the way, before getting too far into your creative
to communicate the design. While they may not all
process and discovering that your choices cannot
be used in every collaborative process, it is useful to
be accomplished within the given parameters of the
understand these techniques as each have their own
production resources.
unique purpose.
●●
Does the work stand alone, or is it part of a repertory concert?
Visual Research One technique common to most designers is the use
●●
Is this a new piece or a remount?
●●
If a remount, are there elements of the premiere that
with the choreographer. This is particularly useful in
are important to reproduce?
instances of creating a design to invoke a particular time
●●
What is the rehearsal schedule?
period. Each designer takes a different personalized
●●
At what point will the dance be fully choreographed?
approach to presenting research. Some prefer to print
●●
What are the specifics/limitations of the
out dozens of images and lay them out on a table to see
performance space? ●●
Will there be a need for raised levels (platforming) on the stage?
●●
Will projection be involved as a design element? If so, is there a projections designer or is the expectation that projections will be covered by another design area?
●●
Are there specific props needed for this production? If so, how will the dancers use the props?
●●
of visual research as a springboard for conversation
what the choreographer gravitates towards. Another method is to cut and paste images together to create a research collage (Figure 9.1). In this way, the designer can begin to communicate basic ideas about shape, line, texture, color, or other design elements without going through the entire process of creating a design. This allows the choreographer to respond to the “feel” of the imagery without getting bogged down on the details. Provided that the choreographer responds favorably, this then becomes the basis for creating the scenic design.
What types of costumes are being used and will they
Depending on the process and time restrictions, this
be available to view before tech?
might be a step that is revisited multiple times in the
9.2 Communicating the Design
process of envisioning the scenic design.
Unlike lighting and sound, scenic design offers up a
Sketches
tangible end product in the scenic elements. Since the
Sketches are often the next step in a scenic designer’s
scenery physically takes up stage space and affects
process. A sketch is any type of drawing used to
movement possibilities, it is essential that the scenic
communicate the design idea. Typically this means a
designer and choreographer have a clear understanding
freehand drawing executed quickly to get across the
of the design and how it will affect the choreography.
design idea. Some designers, however, might use
Since scenery is so much harder to change once in the
computer programs like Trimble’s SketchUp to create a
theatre than the other areas we have discussed to this
quick 3D model that communicates the size and shape
point, it is essential that the scenic designer effectively
of the design without having all of the details included.
communicates the reality of the scenic design to the
Others still might use a graphic tablet to input drawings
choreographer before the build begins. This section
into programs like Adobe Illustrator or Photoshop.
145 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
F I G UR E 9. 1
A research collage with a number of images combined to create a composite. Image by Jeromy Hopgood.
Figure 9.2 includes an example of a hand-drawn design
execute all of their design drawings through the use
sketch.
of one or more computer programs. It is no longer
Renderings A rendering is a type of detailed design drawing done in scale with an accurate representation of color, lighting,
uncommon to see design renderings done digitally or as a hybrid of digitized hand drawing augmented with programs such as Photoshop.
texture, scenic details, and human figures as a scale
Scenic Models
reference (Figure 9.3). A rendering was traditionally
One of the traditional communication tools of the scenic
done in pencil and watercolor paint, though the process
designer is the model. A model is a three-dimensional
has changed over the years to include a number of
representation of the scenery created in scale (meaning
different types of media including markers, colored
that all of the elements are proportionately scaled down
pencils, or acrylic paints. Today, many designers
from the real-world dimensions). The model includes
146 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 9. 2
A rough sketch to indicate design details. Drawing courtesy of Campbell Baird.
147 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
F I G UR E 9. 3
A digital rendering, indicating scenery, props, and characters. Design by Jeromy Hopgood.
a representation of the theatre space called a model
such as card stock or heavy stationary paper. Because of
box with the scenery inside. It is also important that
its small size, it is easy to transport and store. Likewise,
models always include a small figure that represents a
the materials are cost effective. Most often this type
human, for scale purposes. Models are quite useful for
of model does not include color and is executed in a
discussing the design with choreographers, since they
monochromatic color scale based on the color of the
provide a more accurate representation of the spatial
materials used (most often white). The 1/8˝ scale model
relations between the dancers and scenery. Figure 9.4
serves as a three-dimensional sketch, communicating
includes examples of a scenic model.
the basic design ideas and giving the choreographer an
There are many types of models that serve different purposes. A 1/8˝ scale model is the smallest scale used for creating scenic models (meaning that every 1/8˝ measured on the model is equal to 1´ in the real world). This type of model is made of simple thin materials,
148 PRODUCTION AREAS
understanding of the stage space. It does not include complex details, however, so it is understood that the designer would need to create a larger color model or color renderings to communicate the full scope of the design.
F I G UR E 9. 4
Two different scenes represented through the use of a color scenic model. Photo and design by Andy Broomell.
149 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
A second type of model used to communicate more
all of the elements of color and texture. Models made
specific design ideas is the ¼˝ scale model. As the name
for commercial productions may have working scenic
implies, it is twice the size of the 1/8˝ scale model. This
representations, immaculately detailed components, and
increase in scale allows the designer to include many
even miniature working lights included in the model. It is
of the details regarding size, shape, and depth of scenic
important to note, though, that a presentation model is
units, but it still is likely not completely accurate in its
an expensive and time-consuming aspect of the scenic
representation of smaller elements. Models that are
design process and seen with much less frequency in
¼˝ scale can be either painted to represent the color
dance productions than in theatre.
choices in the design or painted in all white. This type of model is referred to as a white model. A white model can be created in any scale and is typically made of heavy white paper, illustration board, and/or foam materials. Frequently, a white model might be made of different materials that are all painted white to create a uniform look. Of course, the white model should always be accompanied with color renderings of the scenery so as to communicate the complete design idea.
Computers and Models Though the term model has historically referred to a three-dimensional object created by the designer, computers have changed the way in which many designers create their models. Many designers now have access to tools unheard of in the last decade, such as CNC cutting and 3D printing. Both of these tools refer to the process of using a CAD file to send information to a tool that can fabricate detailed pieces.
The most detailed and accurate type of scenic model
One type of CNC cutting process uses a laser to burn a
is the presentation model. It is crated in ½˝ scale,
pattern into a material until it cuts out the pattern. 3D
the largest scale typically used for creating scenic
printing works like a traditional inkjet printer, but uses
models. As such, it is much more accurate regarding
an additive process to lay down layers of successive
the specific details of scenic elements. Likewise a
material on top of one another to create a three-
presentation model is painted in detail to communicate
dimensional object from a 3D CAD file (Figure 9.5). Both of these tools have become affordable enough that a number of universities and professional designers have access to them for their designs. In addition to using computerized tools to fabricate scenic models, advances in digital rendering software have opened up a new world of possibilities for the creation of computer-generated scenic models. Most varieties of CAD software now include the ability to craft in both 2D and 3D, meaning the ability to create a scale model, adding textures, color, and lighting without ever making a physical model. Programs such as Trimble’s F IG UR E 9. 5
Two miniature scenic units printed via 3D printer. Photo courtesy of Michael J. Riha.
150 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 9. 6
A 3D model, featuring scenery, lighting, and human figures. Design by Jeromy Hopgood, 3D model created in SketchUp.
SketchUp, Autodesk’s 3DS Max, or Nemetschek’s
scale to communicate the minute details of a design.
Vectorworks (Renderworks) give designers the ability to
A drafting can be created by hand (with tools like a
quickly create 3D representations of scenery without the
mechanical pencil, drafting board, T-square, and
time and cost associated with the creation of a physical
triangle) or by computer (using CAD programs such
model (Figure 9.6).
as AutoCAD or Vectorworks), which is then printed.
9.3 Design Specifications In addition to creating drawings, renderings, and models
For both methods, the end goal is to produce a legible, precise drafting that uses industry-approved drafting standards to communicate the design idea.
to communicate the design idea to the choreographer, the scenic designer must also create a number of detailed documents to communicate the specifics of the design to those who will build the scenery. These design specifications make up the agreement between the designer and those fabricating the scenery.
FYI: Recommended Practices for Draftings The United States Institute for Technical Theatre (USITT) has created a series of recommended practices for generating draftings for the entertainment industry, such as light plots, ground
The most common type of document created is the
plans, and construction drawings. Though these are
drafting, a mechanically produced graphic, created in
not official “standards” per se, they are the accepted
151 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
practices by those working in the industry to best communicate information through graphic practices.
●●
the architecture of the theatre space;
●●
the location of the proscenium line and centerline of the theatre (if a proscenium space);
To see information on the recommended practices, visit the USITT website at www.usitt.org
●●
the location of all scenic elements—onstage, offstage, and flown;
●●
The Ground Plan A ground plan is the principal tool of the scenic
the height of scenery above or below the stage floor; ●●
designer to communicate placement of scenic elements on the stage (Figure 9.7). It is a drafting of the stage drawn from a bird’s eye view—above the stage looking down. The ground plan cuts away all of the architecture above 4´ from the stage floor and removes any details above this point. Anything above this 4´ elevation is represented as a dotted line on the drafting. The theatrical ground plan includes a number of details. At minimum, the ground plan must include:
F I G UR E 9. 7
A design ground plan, featuring the theatre space and scenery. Drafting by Jeromy Hopgood.
152 PRODUCTION AREAS
dimensions of principal scenic elements, including a notation of the theatre’s fly system and all flown scenic elements;
●●
an indication of the theatre’s sightlines.
The ground plan is used by a number of people. The lighting designer uses it as a basis for the light plot. The choreographer uses the ground plan to determine the amount of space available for dance. The stage manager will need a copy of the ground plan in order to facilitate rehearsals. In addition, if the dance tours to multiple
locations, the ground plan will be an important element
the centerline and allows the viewer to see the theatre
used to make sure the load-in is accomplished at each
from a side view, including both the theatre architecture
location. As such, it is essential that the ground plan be
and scenery in the drafting (Figure 9.8). The centerline
precise and understandable to all parties.
section is useful for seeing the stage depth and height
The Centerline Section The centerline section is another type of drafting that
of elements and for determining how much of the stage and theatre loft is visible to the audience. The centerline section includes:
cuts the theatre along a vertical cutting plane—down the centerline of the theatre. The centerline section removes all architectural information from one side of
●●
the architecture of the theatre space;
●●
an indication of the theatre’s sightlines;
F I G UR E 9. 8
A centerline section of the theatre space, illustrating scenic placement, trim height, and hanging positions. Drafting by Jeromy Hopgood.
153 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
●●
●●
the location of all scenic elements—onstage,
where electrics battens can be placed and at what trim
offstage, and flown;
height. Likewise, it allows the projections designer to
dimensions of principal scenic elements, including
determine the ideal placement for projectors in order to
the height above the stage floor (known as trim
project imagery on the set and stage.
height); ●●
a notation of the theatre’s fly system, all battens, and flown scenic elements.
Design Elevations Another important drafting generated by the scenic designer is the design elevation. A design elevation,
The centerline section is principally used by the scenic,
or front elevation, is a drafting that shows an object
lighting, and projection designers. Once created by the
depicted from the front view, including all of the object’s
scenic designer, it should be made available to other
details in scale (Figure 9.9). The scenic designer
designers for use in their design process. The centerline
provides this drafting to communicate how the scenic
section allows the lighting designer to determine
element should look from the audience’s perspective.
F I G UR E 9. 9
A front elevation drafted above a plan view of the same scene, for detail. Photo courtesy of Campbell Baird.
154 PRODUCTION AREAS
This drafting includes a number of notations to include
intent for the stage picture (Figure 9.10). Painter’s
information about construction materials, texture, and
elevations can be created using paint, colored pencils,
more. Though the design elevations are front views only,
photo collage, or computer software. It should be
the page of drafting will likely include other views of
understood that the painter’s elevation is essentially a
the object, as necessary, to communicate the design,
contract between the scenic designer and the scenic
such as section views, plan views, side views, enlarged
artists as to how the final product should look. As such,
details, etc.
attention to detail is an absolute necessity.
Painter’s Elevations
9.4 Scenic Construction and Painting
One additional graphic element created by the scenic
Depending on the nature of the producing organization,
designer is the painter’s elevation. A painter’s elevation
scenic construction may be done by a staff member, a
is an elevation created in scale, but painted or rendered
professional scene shop, or even the scenic designer
in color to the exact specifications of the designer’s
him/herself. Ultimately, the scenic designer should
F I G UR E 9. 1 0
A painter’s elevation for a scenic drop used in The Nutcracker. Photo courtesy of Campbell Baird.
155 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
approach the construction process as though he/she
Technical Drawings
will not be present to answer day-to-day questions
As mentioned above, the technical director is
about the construction process. This means the designer should include all of the details necessary for someone else to build the scenery directly from the design draftings and paperwork. For the purpose of this chapter, we will assume that there will be an additional team building the scenery that is not the scenic designer.
The Scene Shop In scenery terms, the scene shop refers to both the build location and group of technicians responsible for the construction of all of the scenic elements. In academic circles, this is frequently done in-house with either student or staff workers assisting in the process.
responsible for determining the appropriate materials and methods necessary for constructing the scenery so the appearance is in keeping with the scenic designer’s vision. One of the primary tools for communicating the method of construction for scenery is the technical drawing. Technical drawings are the draftings created by the technical staff used for construction of all scenic elements. Where the scenic designer creates a front elevation of the scenery, the technical drawing is commonly created as a rear elevation, a drafting from the rear view of the object showing how the framework of scenery is to be constructed, with what materials, and how it all fits together (Figure 9.11).
The scene shop is normally composed of a number of
The Paint Shop
different technicians with specialized expertise. The
The term paint shop is used to refer to both the physical
technical director is the overall supervisor of most scene shops, supervising the process of interpreting the design draftings and creating technical drawings necessary to build the show. Depending on the nature of the shop, there may be one or more assistant technical directors, master carpenters, carpenters, welders, riggers, and more.
F I G UR E 9. 1 1
A front elevation (left) and the rear elevation (right). Draftings by Jeromy Hopgood.
156 PRODUCTION AREAS
location of the paints and all painting tools necessary to paint scenery and the group of personnel who work to paint the scenery. The paint shop is supervised by a scenic charge artist, the lead painter in charge of stocking the shop, interpreting the painter’s elevations and renderings, and supervising a crew of painters in finishing and painting the scenery. Painters are
typically referred to as either scenic artists or scenic
column on the props list to be checked off when the
painters. The scenic charge artist is also in charge of
prop is completed.
budgeting for the paint shop necessary to create the finished designs. In the world of technical theatre, the
Build, Buy, Borrow, Pull, or Rent?
paint shop is responsible for preparation, texturing, and
The role of props design varies for every organization.
finishing all scenic surfaces to an exacting standard that
Often the person in charge of props has accumulated
precisely reproduces the scenic designer’s drawings,
a set of props over the years of doing the job, whether
renderings, and paintings.
this is actually housed as part of the company stock
9.5 Props Design
or a personal collection of the designer. Ultimately, the question arises of how to procure the prop. Some
Since the scenic designer is responsible for the overall
items can be purchased, however it is important to
stage look, it is common to find props included in his/
consider if there are alternate sources for a prop. Often
her set of responsibilities. Most often in the dance
it is wise to look into borrowing from (or even bartering
world, props are considered the domain of the scenic
with) another local arts organization to get a prop for
designer. In cases where there is a separate props
your production. There will be instances of props that
designer, the conversation about props should always
must be constructed. In these cases, it is important to
include a consideration of the scenery and costumes to
consider the specific needs of the prop to the dance:
be sure that the properties visually fit in the world of the
how it will be used, who uses it, how much it weighs,
design. This section details some considerations of the
and what types of stress it must endure are important
props design process for dance.
considerations when constructing a prop for a dance.
The Props List
Remember, safety should always be the primary concern in creating any element to be used in a dance.
The props list is a form that combines together all
This is especially true for anything with which a dancer
of the necessary props for a production and includes
will interact.
pertinent information about their use. Though there is no standard format for a props list, it should include important information such as:
When renting or borrowing a prop, it is essential to keep precise records of the transactions. Always note who the prop belongs to, the agreed-upon rental fee,
●●
prop description;
when it is due, when the prop is to be returned, and the
●●
where it appears in the dance;
replacement value of the prop should it not be returned.
●●
who uses it;
Too often, people do not consider this aspect of props
●●
how it is used;
●●
how it is procured (build, buy, borrow, pull, rent);
Rehearsing with Set and Props
●●
additional notes.
Rehearsing with the scenery and props is an important
The props list is frequently a collaborative effort between the designer, choreographer, and stage management. Since it serves as a makeshift to-do list for the designer, it is sometimes useful to include a
when making arrangements.
aspect for dance. In most instances, the dancers will never rehearse with the actual scenery, but it is important to ensure that the rehearsal space has a representation of the set. This often entails the stage
157 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
manager taping out the physical boundaries of the set
30´ military-grade parachute under 45 mph winds
on the floor of the rehearsal space. In some instances,
(Figure 9.12). For this performance, the artist had a
it might be important to incorporate a sense of levels
residency in a warehouse to work with the parachute
in the space. This can be accomplished in a number
and a large industrial fan. In an instance such as
of ways—with the use of risers, tumbling mats, etc.
this, it would be impossible to choreograph the piece
The important consideration is making certain the
without working with the parachute in rehearsal. The
dancers get accustomed to the physical constraints of
choreographer had a number of interesting ideas
the set.
as to what to try, but without the process of actually
Likewise, since the dancers will be interacting with the props onstage, it is necessary to start working
interacting with the parachute they could not be explored.
with them as soon as possible. One excellent
During the rehearsal process it is important for the
example is the 2014 performance of Your Heart &
designer to be available for questions. In addition, do
Your Belly & Your Whole Insides Felt Empty & Wanting
not underestimate the importance of talking to the
& Hollow by multimedia director, choreographer, and
dancers in addition to the choreographer. Since it is the
performer Yara Travieso. In this performance, Travieso
dancers who will ultimately be working with the prop
created a “dance for two” between herself and a
onstage, theirs is an important perspective.
F I G UR E 9. 1 2
Your Heart & Your Belly & Your Whole Insides Felt Empty & Wanting & Hollow (2014). Created and performed by Yara Travieso. Sound design by Sam Crawford. Presented by Streb Lab for Action Mechanics (SLAM). Photo by Boofa Hobbs.
158 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 9. 1 3
A small props table prepared for production. Photo by Jeromy Hopgood.
Props Tables
outlines drawn in marker and the prop name labeled
Another important role of the props designer is
(Figure 9.13). This ensures that the prop will always be
facilitating the props table. A props table is a table located backstage with all of the props necessary for a dance piece or concert. There is often more than one props table set up backstage, depending on from which side of the stage the prop enters. Unlike most theatrical productions, it is important to keep the props tables far into the offstage wing space, since dancers so frequently congregate in the wings anticipating their entrance. In addition, it is important to keep any kind of a trip or fall hazard out of the wing space, since dancers
set in the correct location and be returned there as well. Likewise, it is easy to determine which prop is missing in the event of one being misplaced.
9.6 Chapter Review As we have seen over the last two chapters, scenery and props are expansive design areas that require a broad set of skills on the part of the designers and a number of persons for construction and finishing aspects. Scenery serves the dual role of creating a
often exit into the wings with lights blinding them.
visual surrounding for the dance, as well as dictating
It is common practice to cover a props table in brown
Properties enhance the storytelling tools available
craft paper or a similar white paper so it is easy to see in the dark. Props are placed on the tabletop with their
the useable space for the dancers and choreographer. to the dancers and expand on the visual world of the design.
159 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
Review Questions 1. How does a rendering differ from a sketch? 2. What does a scenic designer create as a threedimensional scale representation of the theatre and scenery? 3. What is a white model? 4. Which type of drafting shows a section view of the theatre from above? 5. Which type of drafting shows a section view of the theatre from the side?
3. Write a short statement that explains the choices you have made and describes the rationale behind your artistic composition.
The Scenic Designer’s Perspective: An Interview with Campbell Baird Campbell Baird has been active in the dance and theatre world for over 30 years, designing for some of the biggest names in the business. As a student, he gained a B.F.A. in stage design at the North Carolina School of the Arts and an M.F.A. at NYU-Tisch School
6. What does trim height refer to?
of the Arts. One interesting aspect about his work is
7. What organization publishes the recommended
his frequent double billing as both scenic designer and
practices for draftings? 8. What is the role of the scenic charge artist? 9. What is a rear elevation primarily used for? 10. What is used to track props and their use? Chapter 9 Project: Thinking Like a Scenic Designer
costume designer. He was principal assistant to the legendary Oliver Smith for 11 years on productions for American Ballet Theatre, the Royal Ballet at Covent Garden, La Scala, San Francisco Ballet, and Joffrey Ballet. An eclectic artist, he worked as a scenic artist for the Metropolitan Opera House for 15 seasons, working on such productions as War and Peace, Il Trovatore,
The primary responsibility of the scenic designer
The Gambler, Samson et Dalila, La Traviata, Le Nozze di
is to create a three-dimensional world that visually
Figaro, Carmen, Lucia di Lammermoor, and Tosca; and
communicates the ideas of the dance and reinforces
for the films Malcolm X and Three Sovereigns for Sarah
the emotional and psychological subtext of the
(with Vanessa Redgrave). In addition, Mr. Baird was
choreography. This can be a challenging undertaking
resident designer/scenic supervisor for the Joffrey Ballet
for any designer. This project asks you to embrace
for eight seasons, including such works as Billboards,
the design process in order to better appreciate
Cotillon, Billy the Kid, and Empyrean Dances. In addition
the steps necessary in creating a scenic design for
to his professional work, Mr. Baird teaches graduate
dance. The steps are listed below:
studies in advanced rendering, scenic painting, and
1. Find a piece of instrumental music that you find evocative of an emotion or idea. 2. Create a three-dimensional composition
theatre history (“Connections”) at NYU-Tisch School of the Arts. He is listed in the Bristol Who’s Who as well as with the 2012 Marquis Who’s Who in America.
that visually communicates the ideas of the
At what point did you begin costuming?
music. Use any medium that you feel best
My educational background was in professional design and
communicates your piece—paint, sculpture, collage, etc.
execution for scenery and costumes—from high school on through undergraduate degree (high school diploma and B.F.A.—both from the North Carolina School of the
160 PRODUCTION AREAS
Arts, 1969–74) and then my graduate degree in scenic and
different voice and eye on a project, and that can be a lot
costume design (M.F.A.) at NYU-Tisch School of the Arts,
of fun. Usually my biggest concern is color palette, but so
Design for Stage & Film.
far I have been very fortunate to work with other designers
Before that, I was exposed to a lot of dance at home in
who have a sympathetic approach to color, which is very
NC. My mother was a professional dancer and teacher, and my maternal grandparents taught ballroom dancing back in the 1920s and 1930s. So I grew up seeing and knowing a good bit about dance and theatre. I also danced a lot and choreographed when I was a teenager, doing parts in musicals in summer stock—in addition to designing scenery and costumes for them. (I wasn’t
important to me. I am known as a “colorist,” and I guess that means I relish the use of color onstage. I have done my fair share of monochromatic and tight palettes, but I do find that in dance—particularly story ballet in a large 2—3000seat house—color blocking is extremely important for clarity, to know who is dancing and who they are dancing with. I also care deeply about the lighting design, because
great, but it certainly taught me to respect performers and
that affects every other design element onstage.
choreographers.)
How do you find scenery and costume design differs
How did you first start working in dance design?
between dance and theatre?
My first forays into serious dance design were at NCSA,
Dance and theatre are certainly related. Dance often allows
where I worked a lot in the dance costume shop for the five years I studied there. Christina Giannini was my design mentor and teacher for all things to do with dance, and she took me with her as her assistant on projects she designed
a freer expression of conceptual thinking—an open door to self-expression and getting at the heart of the material. I love design in all forms—dance, theatre, opera, film, musical theatre, and ballet—all of them need different
for companies around the United States—including the
viewpoints, but at heart they are always about storytelling.
Joffrey Ballet, American Ballet Theatre, and Ohio Ballet.
This past year I designed the world premiere of a
I was also fortunate enough to go to the Spoleto Festival
new ballet version of Peter Pan for Nashville Ballet,
in Italy in 1974 to work with her, in both the scenic and
choreographed by their artistic director, Paul Vasterling.
costume shops for the summer, on productions directed
This was our third collaboration and our most ambitious
by Roman Polanski and Robert Wilson. I assisted her on
to date. I had designed two different musicals based on
the Agnes DeMille Heritage Dance Theatre after working
the Peter Pan stories before, but suddenly seeing the
on the world premiere of De Mille’s ballet A Rose for Miss
piece without dialogue or singing made me re-evaluate
Emily, which later went into the repertory of American
all of the storytelling options available to me, and to the
Ballet Theatre. Most of what I know about dance costume
choreographer. Paul is a very sharp dancemaker, and an
is directly due to her patient work with me over my most
extremely knowledgeable choreographer regarding music
formative period—my late teens and early twenties, when I
choices. Once he had started to assemble the score (mostly
really had to make a lot of costumes myself.
early twentieth-century French composers) I was able to
Do you frequently design both scenery and costumes for dance, or work in one area in particular? I actually prefer to design both scenery and costumes for story ballet, but I am also very happy to collaborate with another designer. Sometimes you really benefit from the
grasp the weight of the piece that he envisioned. We had a nice long period to resolve the design ideas, which was of great use to us both. (I once, many years ago, had to design a Nutcracker in about three very short weeks—scenery AND costumes!—and I was a nervous wreck.)
161 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
Scenery in dance is often about open space and simplified
Can you describe your ideal process for working with
imagery, whereas in theatre—plays and musicals and some
choreographers?
operas—there are more specific requirements as to spatial
Ideal process with a choreographer—or director for that
demands and props, furniture, levels, and stairs. AND doors and windows. Wow...doors and windows in dance are usually quite a complicated matter. Costumes in dance are about fit and movement, intelligent use of fabrics and trims and particularly cut, so as to clarify movement and make life for the dancer easier. Also, dance costumes take a beating, so you learn a lot about upkeep and maintenance so that your design will survive for as long as possible. Another issue in dance is that since the costume will probably be worn by four or five—or six!—different dancers, you design the character into the costume, the hair, and the make-up. This differs somewhat from plays and musicals, where you usually deal more one on one with a performer to create a singular costume or group of costumes for their character. Of course you always strive to make the costume suit each performer as well as you can given time and budget constraints. I know you do a lot of work in ballet. How does the process differ in designing for a ballet company vs. modern dance? I did more modern dance much earlier in my career, and would love to do it again. Designers get typecast just like
matter—is for them to come to me with a strong idea or “concept”—scary word in some quarters, but simply put a way of seeing the whole work. Some creative people work best from the music, others respond to research or colors or textures. Personally, I don’t like to have a lot of rules—I want to know what is going on in the director’s or choreographer’s mind, and what they want their work to do to the audience. Tom Skelton, the incredible resident lighting designer when I was with the Joffrey Ballet, was with me in a studio rehearsal once, and he gave the best explanation of a design process—one that I still hang onto with both hands and my mind and heart: “The piece that we see in the studio is often more complete for us as designers than anything we can possibly do onstage with lighting, or scenery, or costumes. Our real task is to have the audience feel the same feelings in the theatre that we were able to imagine in the studio—with work lights and old tights and practice skirts and bentwood chairs. Then we will really do something that will illuminate the material in a true sense. We will make it alive for the audience, as we saw it alive in our mind’s eye.” And that is what I really believe in, heart and soul.
performers, however. Modern dance can also include a
In many ways, costumes are very personally linked
lot of ballet technique—and nowadays the reverse is true
to the individual dancer. Do you consult with dancers
as well—so I always feel you design for the choreography
during your design process?
and the music and the performers. There is often a great
I certainly do consult with a dancer as much as the
deal of pleasure in doing more asymmetrical design work in modern dance, where off center focus is often easier to manage. It’s extremely difficult to make an off center tutu and have the dancer feel at ease in motion. Hats and headpieces have similar issues—of course a great choreographer will ask for something specific because he or she wants to challenge the dancer and the storytelling aspects of the work. And this is really challenging and exciting to solve.
162 PRODUCTION AREAS
choreographer wishes me to while designing for them. The fitting is the time where this is most important—not in the initial design stages where the choreographer is the voice you must hear. But the dancer will have opinions and issues that must be heard and addressed. I find that dancers are often nervous taking on a big classical role the first time, and if they are wearing a costume that already exists and is being refitted to them, they will have a lot to consider and talk about. I much prefer solving problems in
the fitting room and shop, and not in the theatre. In dance
sometimes lie on the surface, and stick with it. I show two
and ballet, there are unbelievable issues about safety that
films to my classes, Powell and Pressburger’s The Red
seem strange for a designer to consider—the length of a
Shoes and Baz Luhrmann’s Strictly Ballroom. These are
skirt, a sleeve, or a cape or train; the slippery quality of
commenting on life in dance and ballet, and how it affects
a fabric; the peculiar nature of certain materials as they
people.
absorb sweat; the shoes, oh gosh...so much about shoes
Go to theatre museums where they have collections of
and boots and slippers. And then add something technically challenging, like flying harnesses in Peter Pan? You really do have an awful lot to consider for these performers. What advice would you have for a young designer setting out to design his/her first dance? Best advice for a young designer interested in dance? See a lot of dance. Go to rehearsals, see performances, buy or rent DVDs—so much wonderful material is out there now that was not readily available when I was a student—
dance design: the Bibliothèque of the Paris Opéra is certainly a major resource, and Lincoln Center Library has a good deal of material. Learn what dancers do; watch them practice. Learn to admire their incredible devotion to an art form that at the best can only give them 15 to 20 years of a performing career. Every day they start over in class, take corrections, and try to improve. And then, when they get onstage, you will appreciate why your work can be so very important to them.
and read about it. Try to see past the snobbism that can
163 CREATING THE SCENIC DESIGN
CHAPTER 10 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP The costume designer is not only essential (but) is vital, for it is they who create the look of the character without which no performance can succeed. Theirs is a monumental job, for they must be not only artists, but technicians, researchers and historians. Audrey Hepburn Hubbard Street Dancer Quinn B Wharton in Casi-Casa by Mats Ek. Costume and Set Design by Peder Freiij. Lighting Design by Erik Berglund. Photo Source by Todd line toRosenberg. go here
Costumes are an essential component of any dance
choreographer and dancers as related to movement,
production. Whereas a dance can technically function
the end product has to live onstage with all of the other
without many of the previously mentioned production
design elements, seamlessly integrating to create a
elements, it is a rare dance that works without
cohesive visual package. Looking at all of these different
costumes, hairstyling, and make-up. Like all other
aspects of the costume designer we begin to understand
design areas, costumes serve the dual purpose of
the multifaceted role of the costume designer and how
creating a visually interesting artistic element as well as
the job is much more than just picking out clothes for a
communicating the concepts and themes central to the
dancer to wear. The following sections detail the function
dance. Costumes affect the ability of the dancer to move
of dance costumes and their controllable properties.
in the space and can influence the choices available to
By examining these details, we can begin to better
the choreographer. For this reason, it is essential for the
understand what goes into making an effective dance
student of dance to have at least a passing familiarity
costume.
with dance costuming and the processes required to the role of costumes, hair, and make-up in the dance
10.2 Functions of Dance Costumes (What Costumes can Accomplish)
production.
Like the other design areas, it is useful to discuss
produce costumes for the stage. This chapter addresses
10.1 The Costume Designer
the purposes of costume design within the dance production. The immediate purpose of costuming is
While some dance companies view costuming as an
obviously to clothe the dancer. Beyond this, though,
extension of the choreographer’s duties, it is important
there are specific outcomes that can be accomplished
to recognize that a costume designer brings a very
through the use of costume design. These are
specific skill set to the collaboration that cannot be
referred to as the functions of dance costume design.
approximated by the choreographer, unless he/she has
Listed below are seven functions that costuming can
some previous training in costuming. The designer holds
accomplish.
a unique role that blends together a number of different skill sets: visual artist; fashion designer; craftsperson;
Movement
tailor/seamstress; historian; and movement consultant.
Costume design for dance is linked closely to
In addition to all of these things, the successful costume
movement. A dance costume should clarify the
designer should be adept at working with individuals.
movement of the dancer and not inhibit movement
It could be argued that the costume designer has to
possibilities (unless it is the choreographer’s vision
collaborate with more individuals during the production
to actually force the dancers into working with the
process than many of the other designers on the
movement restrictions of a costume). There are a
production team. Since a costume is intrinsically linked
number of aspects of the costume that can affect
to the performer who wears it, the costume designer
movement needs, such as the fabric type, the cut of
is often in the position of working closely with a dancer
the costume, the fit of the costume (whether tight or
who is understandably concerned with his/her physical
loose), the size and shape of the costume, and even
appearance and, more so, the ways in which the
less obvious considerations like the way a fabric reacts
costume affects movement. Though the dance costume
to sweat (Figure 10.1). For this reason, it is imperative
designer’s primary concern must be the needs of the
that the costume designer meets early and often
166 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 10. 1
Consider the ways in which the larger costume, here in The Nutcracker, would affect the dancer’s ability to move compared to the other dancers onstage. Photo courtesy of Campbell Baird
with the choreographer to determine the specific
of these associations to assist in the storytelling of the
movement needs of the piece. Equally important to the
dance. Particularly when considering dance forms like
decision-making process is attending the rehearsal
ballet, which might occur in a larger theatre space,
period as often as possible to observe how the dancers
it is important that the costume be able to effectively
will be moving and interacting with one another.
communicate information about the character from a
These discussions and observations will help inform
distance. This is why the costume and make-up often
the decisions of the costume designer as related to
work hand in hand to accentuate the character traits of
movement needs.
a dance role.
Character
Costume as a Prop
Another function of dance costume is the
In some dances, such as Martha Graham’s Lamentations
communication of character information, such
or many of the works of Alwin Nikolai, costume functions
as gender, age, social standing, personality, etc.
as a prop, of sorts. A costume that envelops the dancer,
(Figure 10.2). Since clothing is such an important
made of a stretchy fabric, might be an element to
aspect of everyone’s day-to-day life, the audience will
explore through the choreography. In another dance,
have a number of associations related to the dress of
the physical act of putting on and taking off clothing
a character. The costume designer can take advantage
onstage could be the actual choreography. It is always
167 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
F I G UR E 10. 2
The wedding gown is a prime example of how roles can be communicated through the use of costume. Choreography by Holly Hobbs. Lighting design by Jeromy Hopgood. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
important to recognize the ability for costume to act as a
audience focused on which characters are dancing and
prop within the dance and consider the possibilities for
with whom.
its use.
Time/Place
Character Relations
Unlike a play that features dialogue and detailed
In addition to costume serving as a comment on
scenery to indicate the location and time period,
individual characters, it can also establish a sense of
dance rarely includes any of these elements. Instead,
relationships between characters on the stage. This
costumes are often the first and only indicators that
can be accomplished through similarity in costume
an audience gets regarding the time and/or place of
styles, color palettes, fabric types, or textures. As with
a dance. By using the lines, colors, and textures of
the previous function, it is particularly important in
the fashion associated with a particular time period,
larger theatres with the audience at a distance from
the costumer has the ability to instantly locate the
the stage to establish character relations through the
dance in a specific time or place from the moment
costumes, simply for clarity’s sake. The use of similar
a dancer enters in costume. For this reason, it is
color palettes or unifying themes can help keep the
important that the costume designer be adept in
168 PRODUCTION AREAS
historical research to find images of period dress
onstage. Perhaps she would be costumed in a muted
throughout history.
color palette with a cut that restricts movement, as
In addition to references to historic time periods, costuming can comment on other temporal elements, such as the season or even time of day. These kinds of details are important to the storytelling of a larger piece of work like a ballet, in which the audience follows
compared to the other dancers in bright, colorful flowing dresses. This approach would create a sense of visual isolation and would be particularly effective in communicating the choreographer’s theme, mentioned above.
a sequential storyline. In this setting, the costume can
Mood is the suggestion of a feeling or emotional quality
communicate the passage of time in a small scale (from
at a given time. This is most often summed up with
morning to night) or even in a large scale (from one
adjectives like “somber, joyful, tentative, or jubilant.”
century to the next).
Costuming is one element of the overall production
Theme/Mood
design that contributes to the establishment of mood. The selection of colors, textures, pattern, and cut in the
Theme is a word often used in the discussion of
costumes combine with other design elements onstage
works of art. There are two main definitions of theme
to create the mood of the dance.
related to dance. One meaning of the word refers to the dominant idea or unifying concept of a work of
Style
art. There is a second important meaning to consider
In performance, style can refer to a distinct visual
as well. In musical terminology, a theme refers to the
appearance purposefully chosen to aid the storytelling
principle melodic subject within a musical composition.
process. In art terminology, the term style is often
Frequently, music uses a form called theme and
associated with different artistic movements. Words like
variation, in which the melodic theme is introduced and
realistic or stylized are frequently used to describe the
then repeated subsequent times with minor variations
opposite ends of the style spectrum. Realism mirrors
developed in each repetition. Both of these definitions
the actual dress of a time period and location without
can be used to discuss dance, as a choreographer will
having the appearance of being a stage costume.
often establish a unifying concept for the entire dance
Realism is closely tied to historical accuracy, so
piece and create variations on this theme throughout
research is an important element to realistic design.
the entire dance. In either instance, it is the designer’s
Stylized costumes, on the other hand, exaggerate or
responsibility to help reinforce these ideas in whatever
simplify some aspect of the costume, whether it is the
way seems appropriate.
line, the color, texture, or silhouette. A stylized costume
As with other design elements, costuming can communicate a great deal about the choreographer’s overall theme for the dance or the mood of a given moment. Consider a dance in which the choreographer wants to emphasize the isolation of a particular
might feature a dress with an enormously long train trailing behind it, or a dancer performing on stilts to appear larger than life. Within both realistic and stylized approaches, there are numerous variations and possibilities.
character and her inability to function in her world. In
One factor to consider is the way in which
this instance, the costumer might create a costume for
choreographers often affect the style of all design
this dancer that differs from all of the other dancers
elements within the dance. Certain choreographers
169 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
have become synonymous with certain stylistic
easily as natural fibers. It is important that the costume
approaches in costumes, lighting, and scenery. For
designer has a full understanding of all of these
instance, one cannot think of Bob Fosse without
attributes in order to make the best decision as to which
conjuring images of a black-clad dancer with forward-
fabric to use in constructing a costume.
thrust hips, turned-in feet, and a bowler hat on top. It is important to always communicate with the choreographer and have a full understanding of his/her vision before making costuming decisions that might clash with the overall production style.
10.3 Properties of Dance Costumes (Controllable Qualities of Dance Costumes) While the previous section addressed what can be accomplished through costume design, we have not yet discussed how the costume designer goes about accomplishing those functions. For this discussion, we return to the idea of the properties of costumes—the aspects that can be changed or controlled. Each of these properties affects one or more of the functions of dance costumes listed above.
Fabric
The second important factor related to a fabric is its construction method. There are a number of different techniques for combining fibers together to create a fabric (weaving, knitting, crocheting, felting, netting, etc.). Each one creates a different quality of fabric. Some are rough, while others are smooth in appearance. Some are delicate, whereas others can hold up to the heavy abuse necessary for performance. One of the most important considerations is whether a fabric is stretched or not, and in which directions. Also, how does the fabric move? Is it smooth, stiff, clingy, or crunchy? The costume designer must take all of these factors into consideration when deciding on fabric choices for the costume. When selecting fabrics for dance costumes, it is always important to consider color, print (and the scale of the pattern), how the fabric moves, its durability, and
Fabric is the medium in which a costume designer
texture. All of these factors influence the way that a
creates the costume. As such, it is important for
costume can be used on the stage and may affect other
costume designers to have a deep understanding
design areas.
of fabric types and what factors control the overall qualities of the fabric itself. The first factor that
Line
contributes to the quality of a fabric is the fiber
In costuming, line can refer to the cut of clothing, or the
from which it is made. Fibers are the tiny, hair-like
way in which fabric sections are assembled to create
components combined together to create a fabric.
the costume. This property affects the silhouette of the
They come in two categories: natural or synthetic.
costume, which in turn defines the form of the dancer
Natural fibers are those that come from plant or animal
wearing the costume. Throughout history there have
products, whereas synthetics are created from man-
been a number of popular silhouettes that defined the
made materials. All fibers have different attributes,
style of the time. In this way, the line of a costume can
from their strength, to absorbency, how well they hold
place it within a specific historical context. Likewise,
dyes, or the type of care required in cleaning. Generally
it controls the way in which a dancer can move in a
speaking, silk, rayon, Lycra, and cotton are excellent
costume. Consider the movement restrictions of a
fabric choices for dance. When considering dyeing
long, form-fitting evening gown versus those of a short,
fabrics, keep in mind that synthetics tend to not dye as
flowing summer dress. These types of considerations
170 PRODUCTION AREAS
are always important when assessing how the line of
removes all wavelengths of light except those in the
the costume affects movement possibilities.
desired color of light. If a red color medium were used
Shape/Form
to light a white piece of fabric, the fabric would look red. This is because the white fabric reflects back the
Where line creates the silhouette of a costume, shape
red wavelengths without altering the appearance.
or form is the three-dimensional consideration of the
However, if the same red lighting were cast on a piece
costume. Another way of looking at this is the amount
of fabric dyed green, the resulting color would not be
of space taken up by the costume. Again, this property
red, but gray. This occurs because a pigmented fabric
is often tied to certain historic contexts. When looking at
can only reflect back the colors of light present in the
historic research, it is apparent that the form of clothing
light. In this example, the green pigment absorbs the
changes in conjunction with the lines as well. Consider
red wavelengths of light, emitting a resulting color
the difference between a dancer moving onstage in
of gray.
a form-fitting body suit compared to the movement restrictions of a costume from the Victorian period with a tight corset, hoop skirt, petticoats, long sleeves, and high neckline. Such considerations are not only important for the singular dancer, but also in instances of partnering. Depending on the shape of the costume, certain types of movements would be impossible between two dancers, due to the inability to get in close proximity. Likewise, if a costume were too bulky, moves like lifts would be impossible because the partner could never have access to the legs or core of the body.
Color Color is one of the most important properties of costuming. The color of the costume can easily communicate a sense of mood or even aspects about the dancer’s character. Color in costuming comes from two main factors: the color of the fabric, and the color of the lighting.
For these reasons it is important for the costume designer to always have an open channel of communication with the scenic designer, lighting designer, and projections designer regarding the use of color onstage. Costume designers are expected to provide examples of their color choices before starting the build or purchasing costumes. When considering color choices, the costumer should have a good understanding of the other colors used onstage and how they might affect his/her resulting costume colors. This can be a difficult process, considering stage lighting often uses multiple different types of colored lighting in conjunction with one another during the course of the dance. As a reference, Figure 10.3 includes a chart of colors of fabric and their likely appearance under colored lighting. I use the term likely because there are always a number of factors, such as the pigment of the dye, the sheen of the fabric, the type of lighting instrument, and more. When in doubt, try to provide a
When discussing color in costuming, one cannot
fabric swatch to the lighting designer to see if you can
separate the color of the costume from the lighting.
experiment with its appearance under stage lighting.
Light will always affect the perception of a costume’s
This is especially important when you are using various
color. This section gives an example of how this works.
different fabrics that all look the same color under
Going back to our discussion of color in the lighting
regular indoor lighting. Black fabric, in particular, is
chapters, we know that a color medium is used in a
notorious for turning slightly green, red, brown, or
light to create colored lighting. The medium, or gel,
purple under stage light.
171 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
F I G UR E 10. 3
FABRIC
Fabric colors are listed in the left column, with their appearance under colored light to the right.
LIGHT
Illustration by Jeromy Hopgood.
AMBER LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT
RED LIGHT
VIOLET LIGHT
BLUE LIGHT
CYAN LIGHT GREEN GREEN GREEN
GREEN-GRAY GREEN-GRAY
LIGHT LIGHT ORANGE
GREEN-GRAY GREEN-GRAY ORANGEGREEN GREEN-GRAY
GREEN
GREEN GREEN
LIGHT YELLOW
BRIGHT YELLOW
GREEN
GREEN-GRAY
GREEN GREEN
GREEN YELLOW
LIGHT GREEN
BRIGHT GREEN
GREEN GREEN
GREEN GREEN
GREEN GREEN
LIGHT GREEN-GRAY
LIGHT
LIGHT LIGHT LIGHT
GREEN
GREEN GREEN
GREEN GREEN
LIGHT BLUE-GRAY
LIGHT
LIGHT LIGHT
GREEN GREEN
GREEN GREEN
GREEN GREEN
GREEN GREEN
Texture
step foot onstage to touch the fabric, we understand
Texture is defined as the visual appearance of an
they will interpret the true texture of a fabric based on
object, especially related to its tactile qualities. In short, texture refers to how an object feels to the touch. We often assume texture only refers to the rougher textures of the world; however, smooth objects obviously have a specific textural quality to them as well. When discussing texture in costumes, the first consideration is often the natural texture of the fabric itself. Going back to the discussion of
their lifetime of experience. As with some of the other properties of costuming, texture can be a safety issue for dance costuming. It is always important to consider what actions will be performed in the costume before deciding on the fabric’s texture. Fabrics that are too slick can be dangerous when partnering with another dancer, whereas something too rough can increase friction and make moves like sliding across the floor
what types of fibers and construction methods are
difficult to accomplish.
used to make a fabric, we can understand that there
In costuming, texture can be either true or implied
are various textural properties unique to a specific fabric. For instance, satin tends to be smooth and reflective, whereas burlap has a rough and porous surface quality. Though the audience will likely never
172 PRODUCTION AREAS
texture. True texture comes from the weave of a pattern or the type of material. Implied texture can be accomplished through pattern, a visual texture accomplished by repetition of visual elements to create
a design. Pattern can be created through the varying
of balance, unless the designer is purposefully trying
use of colored fibers, through paint or dye used to
to make a comment through creating imbalance. For
literally “draw” a pattern, or through the variation of
instance, a well-balanced, symmetrical design tends to
differing textures of fabric allowing the surface quality
communicate a sense of stability and formality, whereas
of the fabric to reflect light in differing ways. Small
an imbalanced, asymmetrical costume might appear a
patterns seen from a distance lose detail and create a
bit more wild, youthful, or natural. Striking a balance
textured look to the fabric, whereas larger patterns are
within a design is one of the many challenges of the
perceived as purposeful symbolic statements. In this
costume designer.
way, texture is largely tied to our next property.
10.4 Dance Costume Components
Scale
When considering a costume design, there are a
Scale is the property of dance costumes that compares
number of different approaches towards assembling
the proportion of one object or element to another. In
a costume. The designer can build a costume from
the case of costuming, there are a number of elements
scratch, pull it from a stock of costume components
that could be compared to one another. When discussing
already owned, borrow or rent from another company,
an individual costume, certain elements of the costume
or purchase costume elements. It is important to note
might differ in some way, like having a large pattern
that although there are a great many companies who
of stripes next to a small pattern of dots. Though they
build dancewear, any piece of clothing can be used as
might appear to clash when viewed up close, the small
a costume, given the right circumstances. For both the
scale of the dot pattern is only perceived as a textural
choreographer and the designer, a working knowledge
variation of the fabric. Likewise, scale could be used to
of standard dance costume components is essential to
compare aspects of one costume to another. Different
deciding on the appropriate costume for a dance. Listed
costumes might be designed in a similar approach,
below are a number of different types of dance apparel
but one having a small skirt and the second featuring
and their functions. The vast majority of the costume
a larger variation on the same skirt. Though these
pieces listed below are for female dancers, though there
two costumes share many similarities in design, the
are a few specialty items listed for males.
difference in scale will affect the dancers’ movements and the visual flow of the costumes. Yet another way of
Base Layer
considering scale is by comparing a costume or dancer
Dancewear typically features a number of layers of
to the overall stage environment. All of these different
different types of clothing. After the undergarments,
comparisons each represent a different method of
the base layer of most dance costumes is a form-
assessing scale within a design.
fitting garment that allows for ease in movement
One major consideration in the use of scale is the sense of balance in a costume. Balance is a perception of an equal distribution of visual weight within a design. A balanced design should appear visually stable between the horizontal and vertical planes of an object. Costumes typically feature a strong sense
without obscuring the shape of the dancer’s body. The apparel listed in this section is commonly worn for both rehearsal and performance.
Leotard The leotard is the foundation of almost every dance costume. The French acrobat Jules Léotard popularized
173 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
this unisex form-fitting garment in the 1800s. The
F I G UR E 10. 4
The dancer in this image is wearing a camisole-style leotard.
leotard resembles a woman’s one-piece bathing suit (Figure 10.4). As it is a one-piece garment without snaps
Photography by Richard Calmes.
or zippers, it must be put on by stepping through the neck. Many dance costumes feature the leotard as a core component upon which other elements are added. The leotard comes in many different styles, such as long sleeve, short sleeve, camisole, halter top, tank top, or even turtleneck.
Unitard A unitard is similar to the leotard, but includes long legs and often sleeves (Figure 10.5). It is essentially a one-piece garment that replaces the combination of leotard and tights. Since the unitard is incredibly sleek and snug fitting, it gives the dancer the appearance of
F I G UR E 10. 5
Unitards worn in performance for Merce Cunningham’s EyeSpace (2007). Emma Desjardins, Andrea Weber, Rashaun Mitchell (dancers featured), Merce Cunningham Dance Company at Carnival Center. Décor and costumes by Daniel Arsham. Photo by Ben Thacker.
174 PRODUCTION AREAS
uninterrupted lines and a contoured fit to the dancer’s
bottoms. Like all of the costume elements discussed in
form.
this section, there will be variations in names and styles
Biketard The biketard takes its name from the combination of a
between different manufacturers. Listed below are some of the common generic varieties of bottoms.
leotard with biking shorts. The design of the biketard
Pants
features legs that end at mid-thigh—somewhere
When discussing dance pants, there are a number of
between the length of a leotard and a unitard
varieties to choose from. One of the main concerns
(Figure 10.6). It is made of the same form-fitting
for pants in a classroom/rehearsal setting is that they
materials as the leotard and unitard and comes in a
should be short enough so that the instructor can
wide array of colors and prints.
see your ankles. This is extremely important in ballet,
Bottoms
considering the instructor cannot see your positioning to make corrections if the pant goes down longer than
When choosing the costume components, there are
the ankle. Likewise in a tap situation, a longer pant leg
a number of choices of elements that can be worn as
can interfere with the shoes making a clean tap sound.
F I G UR E 10. 6
The dancers in this piece wear longsleeved biketards with a mock turtleneck. Ritual Series One. Choreography by Jillian Hopper. Lighting by Jeromy Hopgood. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
175 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
F I G UR E 10. 7
This photo showcases a wide range of pants worn in dances. Lighting design by David Koltunchik and Jeromy Hopgood. Photos courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
Pants should be light and form fitting for dance. Jazz pants are typically made of a lightweight, stretchy knit fabric. Capri pants feature a shorter cut of the leg, around calf length. Most varieties of pants have different designs for males and females though, and as in most dance apparel, there are many more choices for women than men. There are a number of different fabrics to choose from, as well, such as polyester, cotton, spandex, Lycra, nylon, or blends. Each fabric responds a bit differently to factors such as breathability, wicking moisture away from the skin, and how slick the fabric is (slippery fabrics can make for dangerous movements in some types of choreography). It is always best to experiment with a certain fabric type before purchasing a large amount of costumes.
Tights and Leggings There can be some confusion when referring to tights and leggings, as a number of manufacturers tend to use the terms almost interchangeably. Technically speaking, tights are thin, semi-transparent clothing worn on the legs that start at the waist and tend to cover the feet (though there are both footless and convertible tights).
176 PRODUCTION AREAS
F IGU RE 10. 8
Tights are a common component of many ballet costumes for men and women. Photo by Richard Calmes.
Since tights are semi-transparent, they are not normally worn without some other covering, like a leotard. Due to the sheer, reflective nature of tights, they do a great job
of accentuating the natural contour of the dancer’s body.
bottom of the ribs) and low-rise (with the waist near the
Leggings are similar to tights, but made of a thicker
top of the hip bones).
material and normally stop at the ankle. Leggings can have a bit looser fit than tights, as well.
Shorts
Skirts/Tutus Skirts are an important component of any dancer’s wardrobe. They add a flourish to the dancer’s
Like pants, shorts come in a multitude of styles and cuts
movement and allow the audience to still see the
(Figure 10.9). Like most dance clothing, dance shorts
movement of the feet. Dance skirts come in a number
all tend to be a bit tighter of fit than street clothes and
of different varieties and lengths. The most common
made of materials that work well to wick moisture away
types are wrap skirts and pull-on skirts. Beyond this
from the body. The defining features of shorts tend to
distinction, the defining features are the skirt length
be the waist and the inseam length. Waist placement
and fullness.
commonly falls into high waist (with the waist near the
F I G UR E 10. 9
Shorts of different lengths. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
177 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
For most people, the mention of dance, and in particular
of soft tulle, assembled to create a bell shape, with
ballet, brings to mind the tutu. It is probably the
a long flowing skirt. The Romantic tutu comes in two
singular most iconic element of a dancer’s wardrobe
variations, one with soft tulle falling from the waist, the
that communicates the visual essence of a dancer to
second with the tulle starting at the high hip, called the
most people. The history of the tutu seems to be a point
Romantic tutu with basque.
of argument between dance historians, some dating it back to the eighteenth century, while others contend it was earlier. The one point that everyone seems to agree on is the reason for the tutu’s creation. Early ballet features dancers wearing long, elegant dresses that fell below the ankle. As the legwork began to grow in complexity, there was a desire to raise the length of the skirt to showcase the legs and feet. Since then, there have been many variations on the design of the tutu. The Romantic tutu was the earliest version, featuring a long and floating skirt that begins at the waist and is cut somewhere around the calf to just above the ankles. This would be considered a ¾-length skirt. The Romantic tutu is composed of three to five layers
A basque is the section of the skirt that sits on the dancer’s hips and is sometimes used to connect the skirt to a bodice. The basque is separated into two separate sections: the upper basque, which is visible and covers the area from the waist to the hips; and the lower basque, which resembles a pair of panties under the skirt. In some types of tutus a decorative set of panties are sewn to the basque. Figure 10.10 shows a tutu with basque. The classical tutu was born from the interest in seeing even more of the dancers’ legs in ballet movements. It features a stiffer variety of netting jutting out horizontally from the dancer’s hips. There are two distinct looks of the classical tutu—the “pancake” style and the “bell” tutu. The pancake style is a tutu long favored by Russian ballet companies, featuring a crinoline, or steel wire, in one of the layers. This creates a rigid structure to keep the pancake flat and hold up the longest layers of netting. It is the crinoline that gives the pancake tutu its distinct flat shape. The bell tutu is slightly longer than the classical pancake style and does not include the hoop. This gives it a length somewhere in between the Romantic and the classical tutu. Both variations on the classical tutu tend to feature intricate ruffled panties combined with the tutu in matching fabric. Another type of tutu is the platter. The platter tutu is similar in style to the pancake tutu, with a flat top that
F IG UR E 10. 10
The tutu, with upper basque visible. Photo courtesy of Campbell Baird.
178 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 10. 1 1
Tutu styles (from left to right): Romantic, classical tutu—pancake style, classical tutu—bell style, platter tutu, Balanchine “Powderpuff” tutu. Photo by Richard Calmes.
sticks straight out from the waistline. It differs from the
One final variation on the tutu is the Balanchine/
pancake tutu in that where the pancake is a bit fuller
Karinska, or “powderpuff” tutu. This tutu is named
at the waistline, the platter is almost completely flat
after the famous Russian choreographer George
across the entire top surface.
Balanchine and his longtime collaborator in costumes, Barbara Karinska. Balanchine loved to put a large ensemble of dancers together onstage. The stiff nature of the classical tutu meant that the dancers’ tutus would frequently collide and create a bobbing effect, due to the metal hoops. Karinska devised a new type of tutu that used shorter, self-supporting layers of netting that gave a looser, fluffy appearance (i.e. powderpuff) without the need for hoops. Each of the tutu types is compared in Figure 10.11.
The Bodice Though not technically part of the tutu, the bodice is a frequent companion to a tutu for classical ballet. A bodice is a form-fitting top sewn from several panels of fabric (Figure 10.12). Some of these sections are cut on the bias, meaning that the fabric is cut along the diagonal plane, which allows the fabric to stretch more. The bodice cinches up tightly in the back and features boning to help shape the dancer’s form. Bodices are attached to the tutu at the waistline or high on the F I G UR E 10. 1 2
hip. There are literally hundreds of different designs
A bodice on a dress form.
for bodices and a quality bodice can cost hundreds to
Photo courtesy of Campbell Baird.
thousands of dollars.
179 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
Tops
Ballet
Dance tops come in a wide array of styles, colors, and
For ballet performances, ballet slippers or ballet pointe
prints. Unlike some of the other varieties of dance
shoes are the norm. The ballet slipper is commonly
garments, tops use the same names as most types
made of leather, canvas, or satin. It has a flexible sole
of street clothes, so they are easier for the novice to
with an excellent grip but no heel. The slipper has either
understand. A camisole is a sleeveless top with thin
a single elastic strap or a double, crisscross band that
“spaghetti” straps holding up the top. A tank top is
goes across the top of the foot.
similar, but with wider straps. A halter top resembles a tank top when viewed from the front, but on examination from the back you can see that there is only one strap holding up the top. This strap runs from the front of the garment behind the dancer’s neck. Other varieties of tops are wraparounds, turtlenecks, crop tops (with a raised bottom, showing the stomach), bra tops, and jackets. For men, there are a wide variety of T-shirt style shirts, as well.
Dresses Like tops, there are a multitude of dress types that can be worn for dance. Dresses should accentuate the movement of the dancer and serve the style of the dance piece. When discussing the common types of dresses made specifically for dance by dancewear manufacturers, defining factors are the length of the dress and the placement of the waistline. The primary question for a dress should be how it serves the movement of the dance.
Footwear
Ballet pointe shoes are a specific type of ballet shoe used for dancers en pointe, or dancing on the tips of the toes. Pointe shoes include a component called the box, a rigid reinforced toe of the shoe that encases and supports the dancer’s toes. The box features a flat toe called the platform that makes it easier for the dancer to balance. The top of the shoe is called the vamp and may sometimes include a drawstring that is used to help adjust the fit of the shoe. The sole of the shoe is made of a thin strip of leather stitched to the bottom of the shoe. Inside of the pointe shoe is a rigid reinforcement insert called the shank. The shank gives support to the dancer’s arch and can come in various different lengths of full, half, or ¾ length. The pointe shoe is kept in place by a combination of an elastic strap that goes across the top of the foot at the ankle and two ribbons that crisscross around the ankle and tie together in a knot. Figure 10.13 includes images of both types of ballet shoes. Ballet slippers are unisex and typically come in three colors: pink (the most common color for women),
Footwear (or lack thereof) is an essential consideration
black, or white (commonly worn by men). Pointe
of any dance costume. The dancer’s foot is the point
shoes are intended for females, but can be worn by
at which the body meets the stage and receives more
men in certain situations, such as a female character
stress than almost any other part of the body. For this
commonly played by a man, like the wicked stepsisters
reason, there is a wide array of footwear choices on the
in Cinderella.
market, specifically geared towards the individual needs of the dance performance.
Jazz Jazz shoes are similar to ballet slippers, but feature a slight heel and raised arch to accentuate the dancer’s
180 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 10. 1 3
Ballet slippers (left) and ballet pointe shoes (right). Photo courtesy of Jim Lamberson.
foot. Jazz shoes come in both the slip-on and lace-up
in a number of variations such as the jazz sandal, jazz
variety and feature a split sole for greater flexibility of
boot, jazz sneaker, etc. Each shoe behaves similarly but
the foot. Shoes are normally made of either leather or
has a different sort of look that is preferable for different
canvas. The soles are made of leather or rubber for
dances and costumes (Figure 10.14).
maximum shock absorption and grip. Another variation might include a reinforced toe for the ability to briefly
Tap Dance
rise en pointe. Common colors are either black or tan.
Tap is a specific dance style for which the shoe is
Jazz shoes can be worn by men or women and come
essential. The tap shoe has evolved quite a bit over the
F I G U R E 1 0 . 14
These slip-on jazz shoes feature a small heel and raised arch. Photo courtesy of Jim Lamberson.
181 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
F IG UR E 10. 15
A pair of tap shoes.
the character shoe. These shoes were originally named character shoes for the fact that they were worn by actors either auditioning for roles or acting onstage. The character shoe is very similar to the jazz shoe, but some make the argument that character shoes are slightly sturdier than traditional “dance” jazz shoes. Like the jazz shoe, character shoes feature a heel. Unlike jazz shoes, though, the heel of character shoes comes in a number of high-heel varieties. One of the defining features of the character shoe is the leather sole, which makes for more comfortable use onstage. Men’s character shoes look like a standard oxford shoe with laces and no decoration. For both men’s and women’s varieties, the character shoe can be equipped with taps to make them function as a tap shoe as well.
Modern Dance years since its introduction. Tap dance can be linked to the dance style of African slaves brought to America. Their dance style involved a dancer pounding out a rhythmic beat with bare feet on wooden planking. As time advanced, the use of a specialized shoe with wooden soles replaced bare feet. It was not until the early 1900s that we saw the addition of metal “taps” on the bottom of tap shoes. Today, there are a number of specialized types of tap shoe featuring specific tap sizes, thickness, and materials for creating a unique sound. Though there are many variations on the design, the common factor remains that tap shoes feature
Unlike ballet or tap, modern dance tends to hold an “anything goes” philosophy as related to footwear. Commonly dancers will go barefoot for modern dance pieces, though it is not uncommon to see dancers wear dance sneakers, slippers, boots, or other varieties of shoe. Even if the choreographer wants a unique look, it is always a good idea to select footwear from a dance manufacturer. There are a number of modern options to footwear created with the dancer in mind. Using street shoes can lead to a dangerous situation for the dancer and damage the dance flooring in the performance space.
metal taps applied to the underside of the heel and
When getting a barefoot look may be desirable for the
toes that are used to produce the signature tap sound
choreographer, there are certain options for the dancer
(Figure 10.15).
to give foot protection while still giving the appearance
Musical Theatre
of being barefoot to the audience. Capezio, one of the oldest dance shoe manufacturers in the United States,
Since dance is such an essential component of most
makes multiple varieties of their foot Undeez™, a
musical theatre productions, it is a good idea to address
nude shoe that covers either the ball of the foot or the
182 PRODUCTION AREAS
ball and heel. There are many different options on the
It is essential to recognize that a wig is a complex tool
market for the foot thong-style shoe, though many
that must be provided to the dancer in enough time to
dancers simply prefer the feel and lack of restriction
rehearse while wearing it. This will give both the dancer
that comes from being barefooted. Always make sure
and designer an opportunity to see the wig in action
to take special care in setting up the dance floor and
and determine what specialty needs there might be to
backstage for sweeping and mopping, since it is a given
secure the wig in place for the production. The style
that there will be dancers walking around in bare feet!
needs to be secure enough to withstand the movement
10.5 Hair and Wigs When considering hairstyles for dance, the two basic choices are natural hair or the use of wigs. Overall, the
of the dance, and the wig must be fastened to the head securely enough not to move around or come off. This point cannot be overstressed!
rules of hairstyles for dance are straightforward: keep
Hats, Masks, and Headpieces
it out of your eyes, don’t let it interfere with movement,
In addition to hairstyling, another common approach
and don’t let it clash with your costume. Some types
to drawing attention to the dancer’s head is the use of
of dance have expectations of how a dancer’s hair will
hats, masks, and headpieces. Each element has its own
be styled. Ballet, for instance, mostly assumes that
unique challenges. All three must be properly secured
a ballerina will have naturally long hair. The hair is
into place, else they move around and possibly even
normally placed up in a bun high on the back of the
fall off.
head. The final step is to use a shellac-style hairspray to affix the hair in place so that it stays up under the most rigorous of conditions. Though it is not necessarily a rule that all female ballet dancers must have long hair, it is something of a convention that many classical dancers follow.
Wigs and Hairpieces Sometimes a dancer may need to use a wig or hairpiece in order to achieve the desired look for a role. This could be because of the length of the dancer’s hair, his/her hair color, or for a specific look desirable for a certain character in the dance. A wig is a head covering with hair that covers the entirety of the head, whereas
Hats, while visually interesting, can create large shadows, making it difficult to see the dancer’s face. Masks present the unique challenge of possibly creating “blind spots” for the dancer, should they move to obscure the line of sight. It is important that a mask always be properly secured, have large openings around the eyes, and not protrude too far in any direction so as to block the dancer’s vision. For all of these reasons, it is important to make sure the dancer can rehearse with the mask as soon as possible. This is important not only for the dancer wearing the mask, but for anyone who might be partnering with the dancer, as it could create a hazard for the dance partner as well.
a hairpiece supplements a wig or natural hair. Both
Headpieces come in a number of varieties from crowns
wigs and hairpieces are normally made of human
to headbands, decorative hair combs, or strings of
or synthetic hair. Those made of human hair can be
jewels. Headpieces must be pinned securely into place
colored, curled, and styled in a similar fashion to the
to avoid jarring loose during performance. Figure 10.16
hair on your head. Those made of synthetic fibers will
shows a few examples of the use of masks and
often melt under heat and cannot be colored as easily.
headpieces for dance.
183 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
F I G UR E 10. 1 6
Four images featuring the creative use of headpieces and masks in dance (Peter Pan and The Nutcracker). Photos by Richard Calmes (top row). Photos courtesy of Campbell Baird (bottom row).
10.6 Make-up Considerations
the facial expressions of the character far into the
Although make-up is not technically a part of the
back rows of the auditorium. Although some of the
costume, many dancers believe that make-up is the final step to preparing for the dance performance and an essential component to taking on the character. Dance make-up is bold, so as to help communicate
184 PRODUCTION AREAS
techniques and tools are similar to street make-up or even theatrical make-up, there are some aspects of dance make-up that are unique to the art form.
The Make-up Kit
As a rule of thumb, start with the lightest color
There are a number of different manufacturers of
just beneath the eyebrow and work your way to the darkest color above the eyelashes. Use a clean brush
stage make-up. The types of make-up used for stage
to blend the colors together smoothly. This creates a
applications tend to be a bit thicker and are used to
sculpted look that really accentuates the eyes.
create a higher contrast on the face than for basic cosmetic applications. The basic dance make-up kit
●●
Accentuate the shape of your eyebrows with an
should include cleanser, moisturizer, foundation,
eyebrow pencil. One of the most important elements
powder, eye shadow and eyeliner, eyebrow pencil,
to making the dancer’s expressions visible from a
mascara, blush, lip liner/lipstick, and a setting spray.
distance is the eyebrow. An eyebrow pencil can be
In addition to these varieties of make-up, it is useful to
used to fill in the eyebrow and elongate the shape.
have items such as sponges, cotton balls, brushes, false
The chosen shape of the eyebrow can go a long way towards portraying your character onstage.
eyelashes (and glue), and baby wipes. Manufacturers such as Mehron and Ben Nye sell specialty stage
●●
make-up kits for a reasonable price.
Apply eyeliner to eyelids. The purpose of the eyeliner is to darken the lines of the eyelashes and draw attention to the eye. Many dancers use liquid
Applying Dance Make-up
liner for the top lashes and an eyeliner pencil for the
When applying make-up, there are some basic steps
bottom. Others still opt for no lining on the bottom
to follow in order to achieve an appropriate look for the
lashes at all. The liquid liner on the top should
stage while protecting your skin. The list below includes
be bold in appearance and as close to the natural
a step-by-step approach to applying dance make-up.
eyelashes as you can manage. Lining on the bottom
●●
lashes should be subtle. Using heavy eyeliner on
Cleanse, tone, and moisturize your face and neck.
both top and bottom can lead to the appearance of
This process is important for the health of your skin,
eyes being less open on stage—the opposite of our
as well as for creating a smooth palette on which
goal.
to apply the make-up. After cleansing your face, immediately apply moisturizer. This step fills in the
●●
applied more heavily to the top lashes and very little
tiny cracks on the surface of your face and makes for
to the bottoms. If using mascara on the bottom, start
a smooth application surface. For those with acne
with the bottom lashes and give a few minutes for
problems, use an oil-free moisturizer. If you have dry
the bottoms to dry before applying mascara on the
skin, choose something a bit thicker. ●●
top. Mascara should always be a darker color, often
Apply a foundation. Directly after moisturizing,
black.
apply your foundation over the face, neck, and upper chest (not forgetting the ears). This makes for an even transition from make-up to bare skin. Many people use a finishing powder at this point to set the foundation and prevent an overly oily appearance. ●●
Add eye shadow. Next apply the eye shadow. Many dancers use multiple colors of eye shadow to create a gradation of color from the eyebrow to the eye.
Apply mascara to the eyelashes. Mascara is also
●●
Affix false eyelashes, if desired. False eyelashes are often used for the stage. When using them, mascara is not required. In fact, using mascara can make it difficult to re-use a false eyelash after application. To apply false eyelashes, hold them in place with tweezers and apply glue to the strip that holds the eyelashes together. Let the glue dry for
185 COSTUMES, HAIR, AND MAKE-UP
a few moments so that it becomes tacky. The false
10.7 Chapter Review
eyelashes are placed as close to the root line of your
As this chapter illustrates, the world of dance
real eyelashes as possible and then pressed into place from the center outward. ●●
●●
area covering a number of different considerations.
Apply blush. Blush is used to accentuate the
In addition to the individual considerations for a
cheekbones and add definition to the dancer’s face.
production, there are also the traditional expectations
Powder varieties should be applied with a large
of dance styles to keep in mind. Perhaps more so than
brush for blending. Cream varieties can be blended
any other designer in dance, the costume designer must
with a sponge. For both methods, start at the center
blend together a wide array of skill sets and expertise
of the cheekbone (the “apples”) and work your way
in order to create the finished product viewed on stage.
out, blending evenly.
Whether it is the historian, the fashion designer, the
Color the lips and define the shape. Most dancers
archivist, the craftsperson, or movement consultant,
use either a combination of a lip liner and lipstick,
the costume designer is an integral part of the creative
or simply use a colored lip cream. For ladies, bold
process for producing dance and one whose expertise
red lips are the norm in dance. This may seem
affects many of the other production areas.
excessive from close up, but it is necessary to allow the dancer’s facial expressions to be read from
Review Questions
the audience. When using lip liner, first draw in
1. In what way is a costume linked to movement?
the shape of the lips, following the natural line of
2. What color would be the most likely result of
your lips. Next apply a colorstay variety of lipstick to the interior areas of the lips. The colorstay is important for keeping the lipstick on the lips and off of costumes. When using a color cream, the lip color is applied using a lining brush for details. ●●
costumes, hair and wigs, and make-up is an exhaustive
Finish the make-up application with a barrier spray. After all of your make-up is applied, spray a finishing coat of barrier spray onto the face to set the make-up. This will help prevent the make-up running with perspiration and color rubbing off onto your costume or others.
shining a red light onto a green fabric? 3. What is the key difference between a classical tutu and the powderpuff tutu? 4. What is the flat toe of a pointe shoe called? 5. How do jazz shoes differ from ballet slippers? 6. Which dance style most commonly features dancers in bare feet? 7. What is the difference between a wig and a hairpiece? 8. What are some concerns when working with hats or masks onstage? 9. Why is dance make-up so bold in appearance? 10. What is the purpose of a barrier spray in make-up?
186 PRODUCTION AREAS
This page intentionally left blank
CHAPTER 11 CREATING THE COSTUME DESIGN Costumes are the first impression that you have of the character before they open their mouth—it really does establish who they are. Colleen Atwood
Student dancers from Eastern Michigan University’s 62nd annual Faculty and Guest Artist dance concert. Choreography by Laura Zimmerman. Lighting Design by Jeromy Hopgood. Photo courtesy Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
Since costume designs are so eclectic and involve
up some suggestions for initiating a conversation about
a number of different components, it only stands to
the dance and how the costume design can assist in the
reason that the process of creating the costume design
storytelling process.
would also be a multifaceted one requiring many specialized skills. The costume designer must work
Setting Goals
closely with the choreographer and dancers to create a
As mentioned above, the role of the dance costume
costume that both fits within the conceptual framework
designer is a bit different from its counterpart in
of the dance and assists the dancer in creating the role.
theatre. Though the ultimate goal of creating costumes
This chapter details the process for creating the design
for a performer remains the same, the path to getting
from concept to opening night.
there is a bit more circuitous. Since the choreographer
11.1 Working with the Choreographer
will often not have a definite concept for the costumes in the early stages of discussions, it is useful to start a
Other than the dancers themselves, no other aspect
dialogue that focuses on what should be communicated
does so much to communicate the essence of the
through the dance. Listed below are some questions
characters than costuming. Unlike the process of
that can spark this conversation and drive the
designing costumes for theatre, television, or film,
discussion to revealing pertinent information about the
when working on dance costumes the primary source
dance. Even if the choreographer has not begun the
of character information will most often come directly
process of discovering these things about the dance, it is
from the choreographer. For this reason, the costume
important to put the questions out there. In many cases,
designer and choreographer often have a close
this helps him/her frame their approach to the dance,
relationship. When working in the theatre, the script
especially as it relates to characterization.
dictates much of the story arc. As a result, the costume designer can enter production meetings with a fairly solid concept of where the costume design is heading. Since there is rarely a script for a dance, the process of creating the story happens in rehearsals. This means that designers typically do not have a notion of the story arc, pertinent themes, or concepts until well into the rehearsal process. For the costume designer who comes from a strictly theatrical background, this can be a foreign concept and take some time to adjust. For these reasons, it is important that the costume designer establishes an early dialogue with the choreographer
Talking About Your Dance 1. Is your dance based on or influenced by any particular work of art? (If so, feel free to include images, links/references with this response.) 2. Describe in two to three sentences what you want your dance to communicate. 3. Is it important to distinguish different characters within the dance, or should the dancers all be a bit more uniform? 4. If there are specific characters, do you have a sense
and makes time to attend rehearsals. Be aware that
of who they are and what they should be saying to
some choreographers may not like to bring the designer
the audience?
in until the piece is a bit closer to completion. The
5. Give a few adjectives or short descriptive phrases
bottom line is that the choreographer and designers
to describe how your dance (or individual sections)
have to determine a method that will work best for their
should feel. Try to avoid the temptation to explain
individual project and stick with it. This section offers
your concept—it tends to be more effective to focus,
190 PRODUCTION AREAS
instead, on what the dance or moments should feel
●●
like. 6. Are there specific movement-related needs for the costuming? 7. Will movement create specific demands of the
dancers will be moving? ●●
At what point will the dance be fully choreographed?
●●
What is the tech schedule?
●●
At what point do the dancers need to be working in
costume (i.e. will knee pads be necessary)? 8. Is there any other design element that might affect
costume? ●●
the way in which costumes have to be used (i.e. scenery—the use of stairs, props: dancers all must hold umbrellas, etc.)?
there a requirement for quick changes—either within this dance or to/from the previous/ subsequent dances?
Practical Concerns In a perfect world, the costume designer would be able to provide any type of costume for the dance in any number required. The truth of the matter is more often that what can be offered in a design is factored on a sliding scale. The important factors to consider are the budget, the number of dancers to costume, the number of workers to help build the costumes, the skill level of available workers, timetable for construction, access to a costume stock to pull from, and more. For each production these factors must be considered as part of the design planning. Make sure to ask the right questions early in the collaborative process to identify potential challenges along the way, before getting too far into your creative process and discovering that your choices cannot be accomplished within the given parameters of the production resources. ●●
Is this a new piece or a remount?
●●
If a remount, are there elements of the premiere that are important to reproduce?
●●
What is the rehearsal schedule?
Are there specific props needed for this production? If so, how will the dancers use the props?
●●
Are there specific colors selected for the lighting yet?
●●
Are there any special effects needs that might affect
9. What kind of footwear is needed for the dance? 10. If the dance is done in a repertory setting, is
Is it OK for me to attend rehearsals and see how the
the costuming (flying a dancer, etc.)? ●●
Does the dance company have a costume stock from which I can pull or a reciprocal arrangement with another company’s stock?
Attending Rehearsals As mentioned earlier, attending rehearsals is one of the important aspects of the costume designer’s job. Most designers would agree that the more time spent with the choreographer and seeing rehearsal, the better. There are a number of things one can take from watching a rehearsal, the most important of which is how the dancers will be moving onstage and what types of movement the costume must accommodate. Rehearsal gives the designer an opportunity to consider not only the needs of the choreographer, but also those of the dancer. Liz Prince, a Bessie Award-winning costume designer for such dance companies as Bill T. Jones and Pilobolus, mentions that her rehearsal process is often informed by the dancers’ clothing: “Sometimes I sneak a peek at what the dancer wore to rehearsal—their street clothes. It can give me a clue into who they are and how they like to present themselves. Sometimes their style shows me something about how garments will best fit their body. Even rehearsal clothes can sometimes be inspiring and useful to observe.”
191 CREATING THE COSTUME DESIGN
The rehearsal process is useful in planning the
choreographer can flip through and respond to elements
costumes for the dance and especially their
that he/she likes or dislikes. It is ideal to share them
construction. Watching rehearsals can greatly inform
in person and chat about the choices, but when this is
the choices a costume designer makes. Perhaps more
not a possibility, it is a good idea to assemble an online
important, though, is the ability to let a dancer try out
presentation that walks the choreographer through
the costume in a rehearsal setting. If at all possible,
the research. Online tools such as Google Presentation
it is of great benefit for the dancer to rehearse in the
or Pinterest offer unique possibilities for virtual
actual performance costume. This will let both the
interaction.
choreographer and costume designer see the costume in action and determine if changes are necessary before going into tech. Of course, this is only possible if there is sufficient time in the rehearsal process to view the piece. Many choreographers are hesitant to open up their rehearsal time for others to see the work before it is complete. It is always important to have an honest conversation with the choreographer about the pros and cons of an open rehearsal process and how it can benefit the overall process.
11.2 Communicating the Design The job of communicating the design is multifaceted. Not only must the costume designer generate information for the choreographer and other designers, but there is also the task of working with those who will be building the costumes, shopping, etc. Specificity in the design materials is a necessity. This section breaks down the many steps that go into communicating the costume design to other members of the production team.
Visual Research One of the most useful tools of the costume designer is visual research. Finding suitable images that represent possible choices in the costume design can save a lot of time and energy. Particularly in instances of historical dress, it is beneficial to find pictorial references of period costumes to show to the choreographer as a starting point. In this phase of the design process, it is often a stack of photocopied images that the
192 PRODUCTION AREAS
Research can take many different forms. Primary research, like photographs, paintings, or etchings of period costumes, is useful for realistic dress. When considering costumes that are a bit more stylized, though, it might be beneficial to draw from alternate resources, like works of art or textures found in nature, etc. Another more practical form of visual research might be looking through dancewear or apparel catalogs to see what pre-fabricated costume pieces might be suitable for the dance. Finally, it is not uncommon for the choreographer to provide research images of his/ her vision for the costumes. Every collaboration is a bit different. Try to find the right process to work for the given project instead of attempting to make the project fit a preconceived notion of how it should work.
Costume Sketches The process of determining design choices frequently begins with the costume sketch. The first sketches created by the designer are referred to as costume roughs, sketches that include the basic form of the costume design on a human figure, but typically without color or specific details (Figure 11.1). The purpose of the rough is to present a quick representation of the design idea to the choreographer without spending too much time on the execution. If the idea does not work, then the designer creates another rough, gradually eliminating the undesired details and arriving at the essence of the desired costume. The next step is the creation of the costume rendering.
mostly purchased or rental elements, the designer may
F I G UR E 11. 1
Rough sketch for the mice in The Nutcracker.
decline the use of sketches and renderings in favor of including the actual photos of costumes to be used.
Design by Campbell Baird.
Costume Design Paperwork A big part of the costume designer’s job is assessing the costume needs for all of the dancers in a performance and planning how all of the costume pieces will be provided. In larger dances, or when costuming a dance concert featuring multiple dances, there can be hundreds of different costume pieces to keep track of. The most efficient method of planning for costume needs is costume paperwork. There are a number of different methods used by different designers to plan for and execute a design. This section details a few different lists that come in handy when assessing the costume needs of a dance production.
The Costume Plot The costume plot is a type of form used to track the action of a performance and list the costume elements worn by each character over the progression of the performance (Figure 11.3). This is most useful in dances where there are costume changes during the performance. It is more common in story-based dance forms like ballet, though it certainly is a possibility for
Renderings
any dance style. A costume plot is generally created in a spreadsheet layout with columns and rows customized
After discussions and design roughs, the costume
to fit the needs of the production. In Figure 11.3, dancers
designer will create a costume rendering, a color
are listed in the left column, with the breakdown of
illustration of the costume design that features precise
scenes progressing from left to right in the subsequent
details, patterns, color, and any additional notes that
columns. Each cell lists the necessary information
might be necessary to communicate the design to
regarding the dancer’s costume. The costume plot
those building it (Figure 11.2). In addition, the costume
is useful for tracking the progression of a dancer’s
rendering normally includes fabric swatches, small
costume changes throughout the entire performance,
pieces of fabric attached to the rendering that illustrate
listing the changes that occur and allowing the designer
the type of fabric used for the costume. Sometimes,
to see when quick changes happen. This information
swatches will be included after the actual fabric is
will be invaluable to the wardrobe crew when planning
purchased. In the instance of a costume design that is
for the performance.
193 CREATING THE COSTUME DESIGN
F I G UR E 11. 2
A costume rendering for multiple dancers with fabric swatches included, for Headless Woman, a dance from the University of Michigan 2013 dance concert, Translation. Choreography by Amy Chavasse. Costume design by Suzanne Young.
F I G UR E 11. 3
A mock costume plot for The Nutcracker.
Show: The Nutcracker
Designer: Deborah Sery
Character Mr. Stahlbaum Mrs. Stahlbaum Clara Stahlbaum Fritz Stahlbaum Drosselmeyer
Act 1 2-pc tailsuit, vest, wing shirt, tie, suspenders, gloves, hat, ballet slippers Evening gown, hoop, gloves, pointe shoes Party dress, bloomers, tights, large hairbow, pointe shoes Party suit, shirt, tie, hose, ballet slippers 2-pc frock, vest, shirt, bowtie, gloves, ballet slippers
Nephew
3-pc frock,shirt, tie, ballet slippers
194 PRODUCTION AREAS
Date:1-18-14
F I G UR E 11. 4
A concert breakdown, illustrating which dancers perform in each piece of a dance concert.
Show: Soul Kinetic
Dancer Abby Chloe Courtney Amber Jennifer Javon Deante Mykalah Randy Kira
Dance 1
Designer: Holly Ridges
Dance 2 x x
x x
Dance 3
x x x
x x x x x
x x
x
Dance 5 x
x x
x x x
Dance 4
Date: 1-18-14
Dance 6 x x
Dance 8 x x
x x
x x
x x
x x
Dance 7 x
x x
x
x x x
x
The Concert Breakdown
lists used for tracking specific needs. The costume
Unlike theatrical performances, dance is frequently
list breaks down the costume needs of each individual
presented in the concert format: an evening of dances that often feature dancers in multiple pieces intended to stand alone as independent works. The concert breakdown, a chart that breaks down each dance and the dancers that appear in them (Figure 11.4), is a form used to assess the number of dancers that appear in each dance and how their assignments might correspond. This is similar to the French scene breakdown for plays, a chart that shows each scene of the play and who appears in it. The concert breakdown is a useful tool for both the costume designer and those arranging the order of performances for the concert. By considering which dancers appear in which pieces, one can plan for a show order that does not require multiple quick changes and allows for the dancers to rest between individual pieces, if possible.
Lists Assembling the wardrobe for a production can be a daunting task when you consider the hundreds of articles of clothing that can go into even one dance. One time-tested method for keeping track of all of the costume needs is the list. There are multiple types of
dancer, with separate lists for each particular character they play. By creating a separate costume list for each character in the dance, the costume designer has a quick reference to see all of the wardrobe items required to create the costume. In the first column, the costume designer lists the wardrobe piece, such as camisole, tights, tutu, pointe shoes, etc. In the columns to the right of the wardrobe piece, there is a check sheet that lists the procurement method for each piece (build, pull, buy, rent) and a space for additional notes, as necessary. This simple list is essential in communicating information between the costume designer, costume shop manager, wardrobe crew, and others. In addition, this list can lead to other types of useful lists and forms, such as the shopping list, pull list, rental list, or the to-build form. The format for these simple lists and forms varies from designer to designer. The common theme is that this paperwork is used to communicate information to the costume construction personnel who might be working on the project, as well as to simply help organize the approach to different tasks necessary for the design implementation. The
195 Creating the Costume Design
shopping list, pull list, and rental list are all three
spreadsheet template that can be used for all of your
variations on the same type of list, including costume
costume designs. The first sheet you make should
items, the dancer/character who wears them, the
be the costume list, and then you can add other
appropriate size needed, and additional notes. Once
sheets for shopping lists, pull lists, rental lists, etc.
generated, these lists can be given to shoppers,
Since most spreadsheet programs allow you to link
costume shop personnel, or sent to rental houses to
information from one sheet to another, you can set
indicate the items needed.
up the shopping list to copy all of the costume items
The build list is a specific form used to indicate all of the steps necessary to building a costume piece. Most often, the costume shop manager creates this form in consultation with the designer. It lists all of the different
from your costume list that have been checked as “buy” directly into the shopping list. This eliminates the redundancy of re-writing a list of items already listed on your costume list.
costume pieces for a given dancer and all of the steps necessary to complete said pieces. Common steps include: purchase fabric, pre-wash fabric, dye fabric, iron fabric, cut fabric, attach trim, paint/decorate fabric, fit costume to dancer, etc. The build list becomes a to-do list for costume shop personnel and helps keep track of where each project is in the construction timeline. FYI: Spreadsheets for List Making
The Costume Bible During the process of preparing for a production, most costume shops will create a book referred to as the costume bible, or the show bible—a collection of all of the information necessary to plan for and execute the design. This includes basic information such as calendars, costume plot, measurement sheets, costume renderings, costume lists (build,
When considering the amount of paperwork that
buy, pull, rent), research, budgets and receipts, etc.
a costume designer might need to generate for
In addition, it is common to have a separate section
a given design, you might ask yourself if the time
for each dancer including costume renderings, build
spent making these lists might be better spent
lists, fitting schedules and notes, and additional notes
on actually building the design? While it can be a
pertinent to the build. While it may seem like a lot of
time-consuming endeavor, the more organized the
time and effort go into the creation of the costume
plan for creating the design, the better the chance
bible, the payoff is huge considering it provides
the costume designer has to finish on time without
a centralized location for all of the information
accidentally leaving something out. Perhaps more
related to the costume design. Frequently, costume
important is the fact that, without a detailed list,
shop personnel can get the answers they need by
no one can provide assistance without the costume
referencing the bible instead of waiting for an answer
designer taking time from his/her schedule to
from the costume designer. This alone makes the
explain everything needed for a project. One tool
effort well worth it.
that can speed up the process of creating and maintaining lists is the spreadsheet. Programs like
11.3 Executing the Design
Microsoft Excel or online versions like Google Drive’s
Once the designs have been approved and the build
spreadsheet can make the task of creating lists
process begins, there are a number of steps that go
much more manageable. I recommend creating a
into the design execution. The process of assembling
196 PRODUCTION AREAS
all of the necessary components for a costume design
hands-on endeavor. Since the quality, color, and
requires that the designer multitask and keep track
attributes of fabric can vary immensely, it is essential
of a vast amount of information. This section details
for the costume designer to touch and see the fabric
the process and personnel for executing the costume
in person. For fabric shopping, the fabric shop is the
design.
primary location for purchasing. Depending on your
Taking Measurements
location, you might have to make special trips out of town to visit a suitable fabric store, as the selection of
One of the most important steps to ensuring the
fabric is so important to designing the costume. Arrive
correct fit and movement of a dance costume is
at the store with the appropriate lists of fabric needs,
taking measurements. Who is responsible for
types, and yardage. Remember that when purchasing
taking measurements varies according to the type
fabric you often get a discount when purchasing in bulk,
of production. In a larger professional company or
so it is better to buy everything you need at once, rather
some academic environments, it is often the costume
than making multiple trips. Likewise, keep in mind
shop staff that will take measurements. For smaller
that fabric from different bolts can have an incredibly
professional companies, it would be the responsibility
different appearance, so always try to purchase the
of the costume designer. In a repertory company, it is
amount needed from the same bolt rather than having
common to have the company members’ measurements
to purchase from separate sections.
on file, but it is a good idea to update the measurements on file, and fluctuations in weight can occur over a
Costume Shopping
relatively short period of time. Whoever performs the
Some things are easier and more affordable to purchase
task of taking measurements, the process should be
than to build. This leads to one of the fundamental roles
professional and efficient. The dancer should give
of the costume designer: shopping. Since shopping is
basic information such as shoe size and weight. Most
only one component of the costume design process
other measurements will be taken and transferred
and it takes the designer away from the costume shop,
onto a measurement form that lists all of the dancer’s
shopping trips must be meticulously planned to make
measurements in one easy-to-reference sheet. In
the most of time and resources. When heading out on a
addition to common measurements, there should
shopping trip, try to plan ahead so as to make the most
be space for uncommon measurements that apply
of your time. Is the item you are looking for available
to specialty items. In addition, there should be basic
online? If so, how quickly can it be delivered and for
information about the dancer, such as hair color,
what cost? This will require some cost comparison up
length, eye color, complexion, allergies, and any item of
front, but it is definitely possible to save time and money
importance that might inform the design process. The
through ordering in costume items from the Internet.
measurement form should be kept on file for reference in patterning, shopping, or renting costumes.
Fabric Selection The Internet has drastically changed the way in which costume designers can shop for pre-made items, but the process of buying fabric still remains a mostly
Along those lines, before heading out to shop in a store, it is often useful to visit the store’s website to check their inventory and pricing. Spending a little time researching stores online can save you an unnecessary trip. Keep in mind, though, that most websites do not feature an up-to-date inventory, and even if it says an
197 CREATING THE COSTUME DESIGN
item is in stock, it may not always be available when you
developed a modest stock of costumes from which to
arrive. When you do head out, try to line up shopping
pull. The primary advantage of working from stock is
trips to visit vendors in similar parts of town, so that
that, since the company owns the pieces, designers are
you don’t find yourself wasting time and money making
allowed to alter stock to a much greater extent than
multiple trips.
when working with rentals. In addition, the use of stock
Thrift stores are an excellent resource in shopping for costumes, but definitely more hit-or-miss than a retail store. In addition, this type of shopping requires flexibility on the part of the designer to make use of available pieces that fit within the design intent but are not exact matches. For the lower budget production, the thrift store is definitely a must.
Rentals Rentals are a common part of the costume design process that enables the designer to pick pieces that might be impossible to build or buy. Typically, the costume designer should go to the rental house to peruse their stock, as this allows for changes in design on the fly based on availability. Go to the rental house with measurements and a rental list in hand in order to facilitate the selection process.
items is free of charge, which opens up your budget for other expenses.
Patterns When considering making a costume from scratch, there are a few different methods that can be used for construction. A pattern is a template that can be used to construct apparel according to the specifications of a design and the measurements of the dancer. There are commercial patterns available in a number of different styles. The benefit of using a commercial pattern is the low cost, lack of skilled labor necessary to create the pattern, and relative ease in locating the desired look. When the goal is a period costume, commercial patterns can look a bit modern in their approach. Another option is the creation of a pattern from scratch, drafting the pattern off of the measurements of the dancer. A wellequipped costume shop will also have slopers that can
When renting a costume, there is normally a flat
be used to make patterns quickly. A sloper is a pre-
fee per costume. The rental agreement should
made pattern custom-fitted to match a dress form or
be made with careful attention to allowances for
individual. It is sewn in muslin or a cotton fabric and can
modifications. Typically, modifications are allowed,
be used as a template for creating other patterns (Figure
so long as it is something that can be undone before
11.5). Still another option is draping a costume, in which
returning the costume. Obviously, this means no
muslin is hung on a dress form, pulled and pinned into
cutting or dyeing of the fabric. Always keep in mind the
the appropriate shape to create the desired style. After
arrangements that must be made for delivery time and
this is done, the seams are marked and the muslin taken
shipping costs when dealing with a rental house outside
apart to be used in the creation of a pattern for the actual
of your area. These fees must be included as part of
costume piece. Whatever process is used, patterning and
your overall budget.
working from patterns is a time-consuming process that
Working from Stock
requires a great deal of experience.
One of the benefits of working with an established dance
Fittings
company is the use of a costume stock. Most companies
A fitting is a meeting in which the dancer tries on
that have been producing for some period of time have
different aspects of the costume to see how well they
198 PRODUCTION AREAS
which the dancer comes back in to try on the costume
F I G UR E 11. 5
Some basic sloper shapes.
once final adjustments have been made. It is not
Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
uncommon to have only two fittings, but it should not be an expectation. In all fitting sessions, the costume designer and shop personnel should be prepared to take detailed notes as to what changes must be made to the costume. Fittings are a necessary component
FRONT BODICE
BACK BODICE
I I I
I SLEEVE
I
FRONT BODICE
BACK BODICE
I I I
to the costume design process that should always be factored into the production schedule.
11.4 Preparing for Dress Rehearsals Unlike the other design elements, costume designs are not always present from the beginning of technical rehearsals. First dress is the first technical rehearsal in which costumes are integrated into the process. As the time draws near for dress rehearsals, the pace begins to quicken and it is more important than ever to remain efficient and organized in approach. Though first dress is technically the first time costumes are required to be used, many choreographers and lighting designers will request at least one costume to be present for setting lights during a cueing session or cue-to-cue. Likewise, if the costumes are used in
fit and move. If the costume is being built, the first
unique ways by the dancers, the choreographer may
fitting is often done with a muslin mock-up of the
request to have the costumes in rehearsal before going
costume. This allows the costume designer to check
into tech rehearsals. Always plan ahead to determine if
the pattern and make necessary adjustments according
there will be special needs for the costumes before first
to the fit and movement. Once this fitting has occurred,
dress.
the designer should mark changes as necessary and then use the corrected mock-up as a template for
Organizing Costume Elements
the final product. Once the actual costume has been
The final step of preparing the costume design for going
assembled, the dancer should be rescheduled for a
into dress rehearsals is an organization of the costumes
second fitting, to try on the show costume. This fitting
into logical groupings for moving into the theatre space.
should be a thorough meeting in which the costume
As pieces are completed in the shop, they should be
designer and dancer address the fit of the costume.
labeled for the character or dancer wearing them and
The dancer should be given the opportunity to work
combined together with other wardrobe elements for
through any movements that may be affected by the
the performance. Wardrobe racks, rubber bins, and
costume. If necessary, there may be a final fitting, in
banker’s boxes are some of the storage devices
199 CREATING THE COSTUME DESIGN
commonly utilized for organizing costumes. Small
pressing, and repair of costumes, if necessary. To
items such as jewelry, tights, etc. can be organized into
facilitate this, the wardrobe crew often posts a sheet
bags labeled with contents. It is important to keep the
backstage for dancers to note any repairs that need
finished wardrobe elements separated from those to be
to be undertaken before the next performance. This is
completed in the shop.
particularly important given the wear and tear that most
Working with the Wardrobe Crew
dance costumes endure.
The wardrobe crew is the group of people responsible
11.5 Dress Rehearsals and Beyond
for the running of the show and maintenance of costume
Dress rehearsals are the designer’s first chance to see
elements once the show opens. As you get close to
the costumes integrated into the production beside all of
first dress, it is important to bring wardrobe crew into
the other design elements. It is essential for the costume
the shop and begin the process of preparing for dress
designer to attend these rehearsals in order to see how
rehearsals. The wardrobe supervisor is the head of
the costumes work, specifically under the stage lighting
the wardrobe crew and supervises the crew once dress
and in the context of scenic and property elements.
rehearsals begin. The supervisor is familiar with the
Detailed notes should be made regarding the look of
production and all of the costume elements so that
costumes and any changes that might need to occur,
he/she can fully appreciate the requirements of the
such as toning down the color of a costume or adjusting
wardrobe crew throughout the performance.
the fit of a piece. Dress rehearsals should operate under
The wardrobe supervisor and the designer should coordinate with other design areas to allow for quickchange locations backstage. These areas often require running lights, a mirror, and sometimes masking for privacy’s sake. This means consulting with scenery and lighting in order to provide the appropriate backstage accommodations. During the course of the production, there may be members of the wardrobe crew who function specifically as dressers, wardrobe crew members whose responsibility is specifically working with the dancers during costume changes to ensure a
show conditions whenever possible in order to assess the amount of time needed for quick changes or costume demands. It is important to communicate openly and honestly with the choreographer regarding costumes. If a wardrobe element is incomplete or not present, make sure to mention it. Find out what is working and what he/ she does not like. Always communicate when changes are coming and try to make sure nothing is a surprise. There are typically a limited number of dress rehearsals in which to make adjustments. Make the most of your time and keep calm under pressure.
quick and safe costume change.
Performance Run
Another role of the wardrobe crew is setting up
Once the dance is up and running, the designer will
dressing rooms and organizing costumes into their
typically move on to his/her next project. If the designer
appropriate locations before first dress. Wardrobe crew
is part of a repertory company, this may mean the
will communicate with the costume designer and shop
next show of the season. As a freelancer, he/she may
supervisor before this point, as well, to determine
be heading across the country. Once the show is in
the specific maintenance and costume care needs
performance runs, it is up to stage management to
of the wardrobe elements. Once the show is up and
ensure that the dancers maintain a sense of continuity
running, wardrobe crew will be responsible for cleaning,
as related to the costume design; always wearing the
200 PRODUCTION AREAS
costume in the appropriate manner, reporting any
the costume designer is undeniably a major role on the
damage, and contacting the designer should there
dance production team.
be a need for a replacement costume. As dances become part of a company’s repertory, it is important
Review Questions
that detailed documentation be maintained in order to
1. What is a costume rough?
ensure future productions remain consistent with the
2. What is the difference between a costume sketch
original concept.
Strike The final step of the production process is strike, the
and a rendering? 3. What is the purpose of a costume plot? 4. What information is on the build list?
closing and putting away of the show. In most cases,
5. What is the costume bible?
designers are not required to attend strike, though
6. Explain the draping process.
this may not be the case in academic environments or
7. What is the purpose of a muslin mock-up used in
repertory companies. All rental and borrowed items must be cleaned and promptly returned. In addition, all pulled costume pieces must be returned to stock and new purchases added to the costume stock. Finding clean, safe, and dry storage for costumes can be a task, but it will save time and money in the long run to not shortchange this process.
11.6 Chapter Review
the first fitting? 8. At what rehearsal are costumes first incorporated with the other design elements? 9. What is the role of the wardrobe supervisor? 10. What happens at strike? Chapter 11 Project: Thinking Like a Costume Designer
As this chapter showed, the role of a costume
What a dancer wears communicates a lot about
designer is a wildly eclectic combination of skill
his/her character. The costume designer’s job is to
sets. From the initial planning stages to attending
use the wardrobe to help reinforce character traits
rehearsals, working with the choreographer and
without “spoon-feeding” the audience or coming off
dancers, facilitating the build, and making adjustments
as overly stereotypical. Included below is a list of
along the way, the costumer designer wears a number
character descriptions, short phrases that might be
of different hats to execute the design. Communicating
used by a choreographer to describe the dancer’s
the design occurs through visual research, costume
presence. Pick two descriptions from the list below
sketches, and color renderings. After this, the
and create a research collage that visually illustrates
process becomes a bit more hands-on by taking
the type of clothing choices that communicate the
measurements, selecting fabric, pulling and/or renting
character for each description. For your collage,
costume pieces, shopping, and building new costume
try to arrange the images in an aesthetically
pieces. Throughout it all, the costume designer must
pleasing composition that shows both attention to
maintain an open channel of communication with the
detail and clear choices. Think about how color,
choreographer, construction personnel, wardrobe crew,
fabric, textures, flow, and cut make statements.
and the other members of the production team. It is
If presenting these in a classroom setting, make
certainly not a job for which everyone is well suited, but
sure to take time for discussion and Q&A. Talking
201 CREATING THE COSTUME DESIGN
about design choices is an important aspect of the
New York Public Library for the Performing Arts,
designer’s role in the production process.
Cleveland Center for Contemporary Art, Snug Harbor
●●
Calm and reserved
Cultural Center, and Rockland Center for the Arts. Ms.
●●
Hot-tempered
Prince received the New York Dance and Performance
●●
Magical
●●
Mesmerizing
●●
Looking for attention
●●
A broken soul
●●
Noble
●●
Unremarkable
●●
Gracefully elegant
●●
Self-assured
The Costume Designer’s Perspective: An Interview with Liz Prince
“Bessie” Award for costume design in 1990, as well as a 2008 Charles Flint Kellogg Arts and Letters Award from Bard College for achievement in her field. In addition to her professional work, she also teaches costume design at SUNY Purchase and Manhattanville College. Do you have a dance background/any formalized training in dance? Yes, I was a Dance and Theater Major at Bard College. When I moved to NYC after I graduated, it was to be a performer in dance and theatre. How did you first start working in dance design?
Liz Prince is one of the more prolific dance costume
My work-study job while I was attending Bard was to design
designers in the field today, having designed costumes
the costumes for the four dance concerts each year. It
for some of the most reputable companies for over 25
was very basic stuff that I came up with, but I remember
years. She has worked extensively with Bill T. Jones
well the struggle of trying to find something appropriate
and his company, Boston Ballet, Berlin Opera Ballet,
for each dance and tried very hard to understand what the
and Alvin Ailey American Dance. Other work includes
choreographer wanted—not always an easy endeavor!
designing for Doug Varone (Doug Varone and Dancers,
Aileen Passloff was one of my teachers there and she had
José Limón Dance Company, Dayton Contemporary
worked closely with James Waring and showed me some
Dance), Mark Dendy (Dendy Dance, Pacific Northwest
costumes he had created. They were very beautiful and odd
Ballet, Dortmund Theater Ballet), Trey McIntyre
and had a lot of handwork and detail. The pieces were like
(Washington Ballet, PHILADANCO, Pennsylvania Ballet,
animals, so lively and intense. I remember trying to create
Houston Ballet), Mikhail Baryshnikov’s White Oak
pieces like his work because they so impressed me!
Dance Project, PILOBOLUS Dance Theatre, Bill Irwin, Neil Greenberg, Ralph Lemon, Jane Comfort, Lenora Champagne, Bebe Miller, Sarah East Johnson, Gerard Alessandrini (MOBIL Masterpiece Theater Celebrates
Upon graduating from Bard I moved to NYC and started creating costumes for friends’ work as well as my own. It snowballed into a career.
20 Years on PBS), David Dorfman, Patricia Hoffbauer,
How do you find dance costume design differs for
Jennifer Monson, Lawrence Goldhuber, and Keely
theatrical costume design?
Garfield.
Theatrical design generally starts with a script and that
She designed costumes for Nancy Savoca’s film
script is the design team’s map for their work. It’s all about
Union Square (2011) starring Mira Sorvino and Tammy
realizing the director’s vision for the script. Designers are
Blanchard. Her costumes have been exhibited at the
trying to realize the choreographer’s vision for a dance,
202 PRODUCTION AREAS
but at the end of the day in theatre, the arc of the piece
is too heavy on one idea, it may squelch other ideas that are
pretty much is mapped out in the script from day one in the
being expressed in the dance as it progresses, and then the
creative process. This allows the entire team to play around
whole piece—the costume and the dance—will start to look
with ideas months in advance of rehearsals.
very static.
Dance is very different because, for the most part
Can you describe your ideal process for working with
(unless it’s a classical ballet with a story that everyone knows) the creation of the piece happens mostly in rehearsals and designers have no advance clues as to the arc of the piece. Often, where the piece lands isn’t even fully clear until very close to the technical rehearsals and premiere of the work. This can make the timeline for designing for dance somewhat hair-raising, especially for costume designers because sewing a costume from scratch takes a HUGE amount of time. On top of that, very often there are technical issues, like how a costume moves and what to do if it gets hung up on the body when the dancer flips upside down or how does it take sweat. There’s a lot of that stuff
choreographers? The more time a choreographer can give me the better. I like to come in early in the process and hear their ideas— even if they change. It gives me more time to mull over/ sleep on it and discover without feeling terrified that there’s not enough time. Sometimes choreographers don’t like to bring people in to design their piece until the piece is practically finished and often that leaves a designer with a tiny amount of time to work because the piece is about to be premiered. In many ways, costumes are very personally linked to the individual dancer. Do you consult with dancers
you don’t find out until the costume is fully made and on the
during your design process?
dancer in technical rehearsals.
I always consider the dancer. The two-dimensional piece
Also, many times there aren’t any costume changes in a
of fabric a costume designer works with to create a three-
dance as there are in theatrical productions. In a play a character moves through different times of day or a year etc. and will encounter other characters and the story progresses, so there are all these psychological changes and mood changes onstage that designers try to enhance or express (in my case through costume changes). This is very different from dance costuming, where often there is no costume change. Most often when I design for dance I
dimensional costume (you could even think of that costume as a sculpture) lives in space and works with the dancer’s body like one, so there is always some sort of dialogue going on with the dancer.…I always consult performers during fittings and listen to their comments. This is very important. Sometimes they are a little skeptical about what I am putting on them, and I have to explain my intention. At other times, it’s the other way around and they will come up
am trying to come up with one phenomenal costume that
with a great solution if there’s a fit issue.
will address a number of ideas in the dance and I endeavor
I know you have a lot of experience working with
to get that one costume to express those ideas as fluidly as the dance itself. This is a very important aspect of dance costuming, because these various ideas and concepts in the dance are often perceived on stage concurrently— there is no time for a costume change to express all these ideas at once. They must all be embodied in one costume. It’s a very nuanced way of having to work. If you create a costume that
companies like Pilobolus, where the dancers can be very interactively involved with their costumes. Can you describe the process for working with a company like this? If it’s a complex costume that needs to function in a particular way, you really need to respond to the dancer’s needs and make sure they feel like they can move freely
203 CREATING THE COSTUME DESIGN
and also not somehow hurt themselves if it’s a really
work. It’s a little intense because so much is happening at
complex costume. Getting a rehearsal costume into
once, but you can get great results. It’s important to have a
rehearsal as soon as a complex costume is conceived is
good sense of humor in those situations.
of utmost importance. Rehearsal costume pieces also
Sometimes we would use the actual set of garments we
can help the performer play with the costume so it is truly integrated into the dance.
put together and other times I would have them rebuilt so they fit better or also so they could ultimately withstand the
There are many approaches when beginning to work with
rigors of touring (lots of wear and tear, and washing with
a choreographer. Sometimes they know what they want
dance costumes!).
exactly and other times they just have a sense of a color or quality of fabric that interests them and other times I’m completely on my own as to what will happen with the costumes. Sometimes I build a look with the choreographer and dancers by bringing in a selection of clothes to rehearsal and come up with everyone’s costume together at the same time. Jonathan Wolken loved to work this way. I have done this often with other choreographers but this ended up being Jonathan’s only way of creating costumes when I worked with him. I think choreographers like it because it allows them to express their vision for the work in a similar way to how they build a dance with the dancers, and so it feels well integrated into their work and not a foreign imposed element tagged on at the end of the process. When working with Jonathan in this way we would chat a bit about the piece and then I would go off and hunt and gather a huge amount of garments for a couple of weeks. I would then come in and cover the rehearsal room floor with my finds and the dancers would start to put things on and come up with great combinations. Jonathan would approve the looks or suggest other things to try and I, of course, would be suggesting things like mad throughout the fitting time. Clothes are flying through the air and there’s a lot of joking of course because it’s half dress up time and half
204 PRODUCTION AREAS
What advice would you have for a young artist interested in costume design for dance? I think it is useful to understand dance as a dancer and as a choreographer. If you are in school and have the opportunity, take dance classes and make some dances as well! It’s a great artistic endeavor and will feed you creatively, also give you insight into what works when costuming dance and what doesn’t. It also really helps to understand how a choreographer works and appreciate what it means to be working and creating something with a large group of people in the room. It’s a tremendous feat to have all those personalities present and be directing them and creating at the same time! If you try to design for dance, be prepared to go to a lot of dance rehearsals. Go see dance! All kinds of dance! If you see something you like, figure out what it is you like about it, why you think it works, and if you don’t like it so much, figure out what exactly it is that isn’t working for you. Of course, go and see art. Lots of art! There is so much there that can give you a new perspective and also there are many visual artists that have designed for dance—great to see what they came up with and how they came at dance from their world.
This page intentionally left blank
CHAPTER 12 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO A film is never really good unless the camera is an eye in the head of a poet. Orson Welles
Hubbard Street Dance Chicago in One Thousand Pieces by Resident Choreographer Alejandro Cerrudo. Costumes and Set Design by Thomas Mika. Lighting Design by Michael Korsch. Photo by Todd Rosenberg.
Projection design is the art of integrating still and
nature of the performance, though, any of these tasks
moving imagery into a live performance. The use
could be expanded or reduced to a great degree.
of projected film imagery in live performance dates back at least as far as the 1800s, but the field of projection design as we know it today is still in its infancy. United Scenic Artists’ Local 829, the union that represents designers and scenic artists in the entertainment industry, created a section for projection designers in 2007. The first graduate program in projection design began in 2010 at the Yale School of Drama.
Projection design seems to use a number of different names in different locations across the world. Some refer to the projection designer as a video designer, media designer, or even video director. Whatever the title, the role of the projection designer is to be a blend of artist, technician, computer programmer, filmmaker, director, and performer. In addition to all of these things, a projection designer must be first and foremost a collaborative artist. The projected
The term projection design can be a bit misleading,
image must ultimately land on a surface, be it a
since imagery is not always projected. Productions
set piece, a prop, a performer, or the walls of the
that use LED walls, video monitors, or television
performance space. Since the nature of projected
screens would also be referred to as projection
imagery is to always work in conjunction with some
design. Projection design is not a given in every dance
other element, the projection designer must be adept
production, especially since the equipment required
in communicating and collaborating with all of the
for projection on a large scale remains somewhat
members of the production team in order to create a
expensive. It seems that every year projection
successful design.
technology becomes a bit more affordable, however. As this trend continues, we will see more dance companies incorporating projection design into their production programs. This chapter addresses the use of projections in dance design and some of the unique challenges inherent in integrating this discipline with dance.
12.1 The Projection Designer Like so many of the designers addressed in this text, the work of the projection designer is greatly dependent on the scope of the project and the design needs of the dance. At its core, the job description of the projection designer is the creation of visual content (photographs, animations, and videos), acquisition of any stock footage necessary for the performance, editing all content together, and designing a projection system for the presentation of imagery for the stage. Depending on the
208 PRODUCTION AREAS
As projection design is rooted in the world of film and animation, the designer must have an understanding of a wide range of tools from cameras to video editing software to display solutions, projection systems, and content creation software. Since the moving imagery will be incorporated into a live performance, the designer must also have a good working knowledge of other production areas such as lighting, scenery, and show control systems. Finally, the projection designer must be quick on his/her feet, with the ability to incorporate a wide range of imagery into a presentation and be ready to respond to changes that invariably come along due to the domino effect of collaboration (i.e. the wall that you were projecting on has to be moved ten feet upstage, or the choreography has changed and now we need to focus on the downstage instead of upstage right).
F I G UR E 12. 1
A projection designer at work at the tech table. Photo courtesy of Michael James.
FYI: Is it Projections or Lighting? Many people consider the projection design part of the lighting design. While it is true that projections are composed of light, it is important to recognize that the field is specialized and not simply a subset of lighting design. One important aspect of projection design is the necessity of a truly collaborative arrangement between a number of production team members—primarily, the choreographer, lighting designer, and projection designer. That said, it is important to recognize that the lighting design greatly affects the projection design and vice versa. An effective projection design is only achieved through collaboration. This is especially important in
limited budget situations where the dance company cannot afford powerful high-lumen projectors. If the projector is not bright, or the projection surface is not ideal for projections, then the lighting designer must compensate by trying to keep the lighting design from washing out the projections. Of course, this means that the choreographer must also agree to stage the movement away from the projection surfaces, so that there can be both clear projected images and well-lit dancers. If a dance is to successfully incorporate projection seamlessly with the other design elements, the project must be approached proactively with an open mind from all members of the team.
209 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO
12.2 Assessing Projection Needs
year. This section focuses on a number of these functions
Similar to lighting design, projection design cannot
of projection design. However, if the choreographer and
be accomplished without specialized equipment. Often the producing dance company will have to rent this equipment for the performance. In addition, projection design requires the creation or acquisition of visual content in order to facilitate the design.
projection designer do not approach the project with a clear vision of how the projection design should be used, it runs the risk of coming off as an afterthought or a design element that seems out of place within the context of the performance. So the question must be
For these reasons, it is essential that the designer,
asked, how will we use projection design in this dance?
choreographer, affected design personnel, and
Will the projection be used to produce an immersive
management meet as early as possible to discuss the needs of the project. Projection design is closely related to both scenery and lighting and will affect both areas of design. For this reason, it is important to involve these other designers in discussions related to projections so that they are not surprised. Likewise, even though projections are created with light and also have the ability to serve as scenic reinforcement, the role of projection designer should not simply be piled on as an additional responsibility for either designer without additional compensation. It is a separate discipline and should be treated as a separate production line.
environment that creates a scenic backdrop for the dance performance? Should the projection be more interactive in nature, with media designed to respond to and interact with a performer onstage? Should it be used in a presentational method, projecting video footage of pre-recorded dancers with which the live dancers “partner”? Perhaps the need is a simple projection of words, like a poem or quotation, on to the cyclorama? Each approach carries with it different challenges and affects the amount of design time and equipment necessary for the project.
Projections should never be considered an afterthought
What Content Do You Want to Project?
or a simple solution to creating an environment. In
The answer to this question will no doubt be tied to the
truth, the process of integrating projection design into a dance has the potential to be more time-consuming than any of the other design areas. One of the first duties of the projection designer is to meet with the choreographer and others to determine the actual projection needs of the dance. So many times, a choreographer knows that he/she would like to use projection in the dance, but has no understanding of what that actually entails. The following list of questions offers a starting point for discussion that will inform the
previous question of how projections will be used in the production. Specifically, though, are there certain images, textures, or video footage in mind for the projection? This requires content creation or finding the appropriate stock footage. An important consideration here is permissions. Like music, video and film footage is typically under copyright and cannot simply be used without permission. It is important to identify at this stage if there is a need for using footage that is under copyright. If so, that means the added task of securing
entire team as to the reality of the projection needs.
permission for using the imagery in grand performance.
How Do You Want to Use Projections in the Production?
image you found through a Google images search is
Projection can be used for dance productions in so many
actually someone’s intellectual property. Don’t fall
interesting ways, with new applications surfacing every
210 PRODUCTION AREAS
It can be easy in the Internet age to forget that the
victim to this and find yourself on the receiving end of a cease-and-desist letter or, worse yet, legal action.
In addition to footage, another common type of projection
method of orienting a projector in front of an object
content is live video feed. Will the design feature
and projecting on to its surface. If there is only room
moments within the dance that should be captured on
to project on to a projection surface from the front,
video and incorporated into the projection design? Many
then there is the potential of the light from projectors
projection designs feature a combination of both pre-
also illuminating the dancers. This would create the
generated and live content. If so, this adds a number of
appearance of imagery projected on to the dancers
different pieces of equipment beyond a basic projection
and their bodies casting shadows on to the projected
system.
background. Sometimes this is an interesting visual,
What Type of Performance Space?
whereas other times it is undesirable. Another option is the use of rear projection, the orientation of a projector
Since projection design is the by-product of light, the
behind the desired projection surface. For this method,
performance space is always a concern. One main
the projection surface must be translucent, in order for
consideration should be the projectors’ positions. There
the image to be visible from the audience. Figure 12.2
are two common methods of projector placement: front
shows a projection design utilizing both front and rear
projection and rear projection. Front projection is the
projection.
F I G UR E 12. 2
In this projection design, the upstage wall and ceiling unit use rear projection on to special rear projection material, while the side walls use front projection, due to their solid surfaces. Projection design by David Koltunchik. Photo by Jeromy Hopgood.
211 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO
Another important question is the amount of light in the performance space. For theatre spaces, lighting is a factor controlled by the lighting designer. In exterior spaces, though, it is important to consider time of day, season, and shade in order to determine the brightness needed for a projector to overcome the natural lighting of the space.
What is the Projection Surface(s)? Projections are incredibly versatile as a design medium. Since they are composed of light, virtually any substance, both opaque and translucent, can serve as a projection surface. If the surface is intended to be an extension of
F IG UR E 12. 3
The image on the left is the original image. The one on the right shows the keystone effect of the image being projected on to a surface from a non-perpendicular angle. Photo courtesy of NASA.
the scenery, the scenic designer should have a say in the selection of the material to function as a projection
image is squared up when it lands on the projection
surface. This could be a common flat, scrim, any number
surface. Because of the keystone effect, it is important
of fabrics, or projection screen designed specifically
for designers to observe both the projector placement
for use as a projection surface. In addition, dynamic
and projection surface locations to determine how to
surfaces like fog, haze, or even water can function as
address the problem of keystoned images.
a projection surface. For exterior performance spaces, landscape and plant life itself could be used. In dance, it is common to project on to the performers themselves. The possibilities are virtually limitless.
Another important consideration is the number of faces or planes on the projection surface. When projecting on a flat surface, the image remains consistent. With the addition of raised, recessed, or angular planes
While it is a fairly straightforward process to project
to the projection surface, the resulting image will
imagery on to a flat surface when the projector is
be distorted. Projection designers use a process
aligned at a perpendicular angle to the surface, it is
referred to as projection mapping to address this
a different matter to project on to complex surfaces
phenomenon. Projection mapping is the manipulation
with multiple angles and planes. First, if a projector
of a projected image through the use of specialized
is not aligned directly centered on an object and at
computer software to “map” the projection in a way
a perpendicular angle to the surface, the resulting
that allows three-dimensional multi-plane surfaces to
image will be skewed, a result known as the keystone
function as a suitable display surface for projections
effect (Figure 12.3). This distortion of the image
(Figure 12.4). Projection mapping enables the use of many
makes a square or rectangular projection appear to
non-traditional forms as projection surfaces, such as
be trapezoidal. Whether through the projector itself or
architecture, landscaping, stage props, or even the human
with projection software, the image must be augmented
body. For all of these possibilities, it is important to identify
through a process called keystone correction, or
early in the production planning process the types of
keystoning. This process simply adjusts the image to
surfaces intended for projection, as each type presents its
be trapezoidal before projecting so that the resulting
own unique challenges to the projection designer.
212 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 12. 4
projections in the past and should be more familiar with
Projection Mapping used in DLECTRICITY, Detroit’s nighttime exhibit of art and light at the Detroit Institute of Arts. The projection content was mapped to interact with the facade of the DIA building. Production credits: TLS Productions, Inc. XL Video. Mindfield.
the process and any potential problems that occurred in the past.
What is the Timeline? The timeline for creating projection designs can vary greatly based on the needs of the project. For
Photo courtesy of Carl Kedzierski.
something relatively simple, like the projection of words or a single image, the design can come together in a shorter timeframe. If the design is more complex and requires pre-production work (filming dancers, editing the film, creating animations, etc.), the timeline must be adjusted to facilitate these needs. Likewise, it is important to recognize that the needs of the projection designer may affect the schedule of the choreographer and other designers. If, for instance, the projection design incorporates pre-recorded video of the dancers then the choreographer must complete the choreography for those sections early enough in advance to allow for filming the dancers. Likewise, if the dancers must be in the same costumes, then the costume designer’s timetable will be affected by this decision. The projection designer is the only person qualified to determine how much time is needed for the
Does the Company Have Any Equipment in Stock?
recording, editing, and post-production work necessary to assemble the footage. Make sure to plan ahead and
One important consideration is if the dance company
allow for ample time in the schedule or everyone will
already owns any projection equipment. We will discuss
feel the crunch.
projection systems in depth later in the chapter, but some common needs for projection would include:
Reality Check: Is Projection Right for Your Dance?
projector(s), a mount for hanging the projector, a control
Projections are an amazing design element that can
computer (or multiple, depending on requirements),
contribute a certain magical element to a production.
cabling to run from the computer to the projector,
The bottom line, though, is that projection design
and a dowser to eliminate the light of the projector
is not suited for every production situation. For the
(especially important if there is ever a blackout or low-
young choreographer, it is so important to remember
lighting situation). If a dance company already owns
that flashy design elements are no substitution for
this equipment, then the cost of projections is reduced.
well-conceived, purposeful choreography. Any design
Also, unless the equipment was purchased for the
element can help or hinder the dance, but in my
dance in question, it means that the company has used
experience projection seems to be one of those areas
213 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO
that has the most potential for seeming out of place
their very nature, ephemeral. The imagery projected
in the world of the dance. Don’t just decide to use
onstage has the potential to be constantly changing.
projections for the sake of novelty. Make certain that
This leads to a dynamic sense of movement on the part
projection is a tool to help illuminate your vision for the
of the projection design, something that very naturally
dance and the themes you want communicated to the
works in the context of dance. Some might be tempted
audience.
to refer to this as virtual scenery, but that is only one
Always keep in mind that projections will have a completely different aesthetic quality to them than painted scenery. Like LED lighting, projectors will create a bright and vividly colorful presentation. By its very nature, projection is eye-catchingly theatrical. It is important to remember that, if not carefully executed, projection has the potential to draw focus away from the dancers and
component of the dynamic environment. While projected scenery is certainly one possibility, the interesting thing about projections is how it marries together both scenery and lighting. In addition to virtual scenery, projections could be used to create ambient textures as a background, something popularized in concert touring and club environments for some time now (Figure 12.5).
overpower the visual composition of the stage.
Interacting with Dancer(s)
The unfortunate reality of projection design is that it is
Potential for interactivity is an important element
an expensive and time-consuming endeavor. It has the
of projection design. Typically, there are two basic
potential for looking amateurish if the designer does not
approaches to projections design content: linear and
have access to projectors that are both bright enough
interactive. Linear content is imagery that will always
and can fill a large enough area of the stage. If you are in
be presented in the same fashion for each performance
the position to decide on the inclusion of projections into
without the potential of change. This is common in many
a dance production, ask yourself if it can be executed in
theatrical, cue-based environments where it is desirable
a professional and aesthetically pleasing fashion. A dim
to reproduce similar results for each performance.
image that fills a small window of the stage picture can
Interactive content is created with the intent of featuring
be much more of a distraction than a benefit.
media with which the performer interacts and changes
12.3 Functions of Dance Projection Design (What Projection Design can Accomplish)
in response to the performer’s actions. This type of interactivity has become ubiquitous in projection design with the proliferation of motion capture technology.
Projection design can be used to accomplish many
As computer technology has advanced, giving the
different outcomes in a dance production. It is important
public access to multiple forms of motion capture and
for the projection designer and choreographer to both
movement sensitive devices, projection designers
understand the goals for the projection design and how
have integrated this into their toolkits to expand the
to go about accomplishing them. Listed below are six
possibilities of interactive projection.
functions of dance projection design that explain how projections can serve the dance.
Creating a Dynamic Environment This function refers to the use of projections to create a scenic environment for the dance. Projections are, by
214 PRODUCTION AREAS
One common use of interactivity is the projection of virtual costumes on to dancers. Through the use of motion sensors built into the costumes or by the 3D, depth-sensing capabilities of hardware like Microsoft’s Kinect™ sensor, projection designers are now able to
F IG UR E 12. 6
This interactive projection design utilizes bio-sensors and motion tracking to capture the movements of the dancer and create an interactive pairing between the dancer and projections. Photo courtesy of João Biera.
way, the projection design almost functions as another performer, allowing the dancer to “partner” with the projections and add another level to the choreographed movement of visual elements on the stage.
Presenting/Representing the Dancer(s) One function of projection design that dance frequently utilizes is the presentation of the dancer as a projection F I G UR E 12. 5
An ambient video background, utilizing amorphous starbursts, pulsating lights, and numeric sequences. Dead Man’s Cell Phone, Eastern Michigan University. Scenic design by John Charles. Lighting design by Emily Clarkson. Projection design by Jeromy Hopgood. Photography by Jeromy Hopgood.
element. Whether this is in the form of a pre-recorded video of the dancer, or a real-time video capture, both options serve to capture the movements of the dancer and present them in a magnified format via projections.
interpret the movements and positioning of a dancer’s body and map projections in real time on to the dancer’s body onstage.
Another possibility that has emerged more recently is the representation of the dancer through projection design. There are a number of ways that this can occur. As mentioned earlier in the chapter, motion capture
Another possibility is allowing the dancer to change their
software has made it possible to analyze the movements
environment through interaction: triggering changes
of a figure in real time. By using simulation software,
in the projection design, appearing to move projected
the dancer’s movement can be captured and applied to
elements, or many other possible interactions. In this
the form of an avatar (a graphic representation of the
215 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO
F IG UR E 12. 7
These images illustrate the use of projection to create a graphic representation of the dancer. Photo courtesy of João Biera.
the storytelling of the dance, thematic elements, or support other production elements such as scenery, sound, or costumes. In addition, one of projection’s greatest strengths in reinforcement is the fact it is a kinetic element itself, which makes it a natural choice to reinforce movement within the dance. If projections are moving in conjunction with or in counterpoint to the type of movement that occurs onstage, it can help draw attention to the movement of the dance. Finally, visual imagery has the ability to evoke emotional responses in the viewer in a way that can truly accentuate mood onstage. Projections, when used in conjunction with the visual storytelling of the dancers, can help communicate a tone or emotion in a given moment.
Stage Magic/Special Effects Projection design can function as a tool for the creation of special effects or magical moments for the stage. Projection could be used for creating a visual of explosions, magical appearances, flight, underwater acrobatics, or more. Typically special effects are best accomplished in projections when combined with another production element. For example, the spectacle dancer) projected in real time. This representation of
of flight might be best accomplished by flying a dancer,
the dancer can mimic the movements in a completely
while the projections track the movement of the dancer
different physical form. In addition, projection could be
around the stage.
used as a more abstract representation of the dancer’s movement, mood, or character through the use of
Creating a Commentary
changing colors, textures, or forms.
Projections can be used to comment on certain
Visual Reinforcement
elements presented onstage. This can be done in a number of different ways. Quite often imagery can be
Like some of the other design areas mentioned
used to draw comparisons and point out similarities or
earlier, projection design is useful in reinforcing
differences between actions being seen onstage and
elements seen onstage. Projections can reinforce
a concept with which the audience might already be
216 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 12. 8
A projection design for ballet utilizing rear projected imagery as a kinetic backdrop. Opera (2013), La Scala Ballet, La Scala, Milano. Choreography by Alexei Ramansky. Projection design by Wendall K. Harrington. Costumes by Colleen Atwood. Lighting design by Mark Stanley. Photo courtesy of Wendall K. Harrington.
familiar. An example of this might be a dance piece that features a dancer in obvious emotional/psychological distress onstage juxtaposed with a projected image of her idealized self, well dressed, smiling, and as she would want the world to see her. This form of commentary obviously is used to illustrate two opposite realities. Another common use of projections as commentary is the integration of text into the projection’s design. Words or commonly understood visual symbols (such
F IG UR E 12. 9
Dr. Faustus being pulled into the flames of Hell by a pack of demons. Dr. Faustus, Eastern Michigan University. Scenic design by Jeromy Hopgood. Lighting design by John Charles. Projection design by David Koltunchik. Costumes by Melanie Schuessler. Photo by Jeromy Hopgood.
217 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO
F I G UR E 12. 1 0
This image showcases the use of projection to comment on the action of a scene. Urinetown: The Musical, Eastern Michigan University. Scenic design by John Charles. Lighting and projection design by Jeromy Hopgood. Costumes by Melanie Schuessler. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
as a stop sign or skull and crossbones signifying
12.4 Projection Systems
poison) could be used to literally comment on the
As with our discussions of sound and lighting,
action in the dance. This is a dramatic tool that was pioneered in the theatrical works of Bertolt Brecht, whose style of Epic Theatre purposefully reminded the audience that they were watching a theatrical performance. As a function of projection design, using projections as a commentary runs the risk of coming off as overly simplistic or pedantic in its approach. While it certainly has its place, one should use it sparingly and with consideration of the tone it can create in a performance.
218 PRODUCTION AREAS
projections are created through the use of a projection system. A projection system can be defined as a collection of all the equipment necessary to execute the projection design. As such, each system is variable depending on the needs of the project. A basic system might include a collection of components: a media storage unit (computer); cameras; cabling/network; and output devices (monitors, projectors, televisions, LED/LCD panels). More complex systems might include peripheral devices that interact with the projection,
such as motion capture devices. As you might assume,
network. It is much more common in the video system,
there are a number of different configurations one could
however, to find a number of different computers
choose, based on the needs of the project. This section
networked together, each controlling different aspects
details the purpose of different projection systems and
of the playback.
their components.
Video Workstation Though not specifically part of the projection system used in a performance, the video workstation is the first step necessary to creating and/or editing content for playback. A video workstation is any computer with the necessary peripherals and software used to generate and edit video content. You could easily spend tens of thousands of dollars to create a highend editing station with digital video cameras, editing software, interfaces, graphics software, and more. Likewise, the beginner can do rudimentary video editing through software that comes pre-installed on their home computer.
The most basic form of a playback system is a computer connected to one projector or monitor displaying the media. Each computer comes with a graphics card, a device used to process graphic information on the computer and output to external display devices. Some computers have multiple outputs available on the graphics card, allowing the computer to connect to more than one display device. It is much more common, however, that consumer grade computers have only one video output.
The Video Reinforcement System In addition to playing back pre-recorded video, a projection system will frequently need to accommodate the use of live video as part of the
For video editing considerations, the most important
projection design. The video reinforcement system is
hardware aspects to consider are processor speed
used to capture and input live video into the projection
(CPU), RAM, and graphics card (GPU). Another
system. This type of system is similar to the playback
important consideration is storage. Video files are large
system except that the input video signal comes from a
and take up a lot of space. A video editing workstation
camera, rather than from a video or graphics file. This
should have a dedicated drive for video storage with a
system can include many components, but the basic
minimum of 1 terabyte storage capacity that is separate
setup would consist of a video camera connected to an
from your startup disk. In addition, invest in portable
input device that connects directly into the projection
hard drives for backup and transportation purposes
system.
since the projection designer deals in vast amounts of data transfer.
The Video Playback System
12.5 Projection Equipment Depending on the needs of the project, projection design can require a staggering amount of equipment. While
Video playback systems are a combination of all
this book is not intended to serve as an introduction to
the equipment necessary to play back pre-recorded
hardware, it is important to have a basic understanding
video or still images in a live performance/installation
of the tools used in creating a projection design. While it
environment. Like audio systems, the video playback
is by no means an exhaustive list, this section lists some
system is a combination of one or more computers
of the fundamental tools to the design process.
connected either directly to an output device(s) or into a
219 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO
The Digital Video Camera
Media servers are expensive and require specialized
The digital video camera is a tool that captures moving
training to operate, but have become common
light and then sends the light through one or more sensors to translate this captured light into images. The captured video image is then translated into computer pixels. For live performance, the digital video camera will be connected to a computer interface so the video signal can be sent through the projection system. FYI: Pixels and Resolution A pixel is short for “picture element,” the tiny dots of colored light that make up a digital image. Typically, thousands of pixels combine together to make an image viewed on a digital monitor. The number and size of pixels in an image is related to the image quality. Images with smaller pixels (and greater pixel count) have higher resolution, the measurement of pixels in a given image. Images with lower resolution tend to be a bit fuzzier and, when enlarged, have a blurry, unclear look with individual pixels more visible called pixelation.
components of any high-end projection system.
Interface Connections For any type of audio/video system, physical connections (both hardware devices and cabling) comprise a substantial amount of the necessary components. Each device in your system will require some type of cabling for input and output. Typically, this is one of the commonly overlooked costs of setting up a projection system. Keep in mind that each project can have considerably different needs, based on the number of input devices, computers, output devices, and the distance between each component in the system. Check with all of your equipment to determine what types of connectors are required. It is also a good idea to sketch or draft out a plan that takes into consideration the distances between each component and the required physical connections between each device. Common connector types are VGA (Video Graphics Array), DVI (Digital Video Interface), HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface), and Category
The Computer
5/6 networking cables.
In any projection system, you will likely find one or more
Display Devices
computers serving various functions. For most basic systems, the computer serves as a media storage device and an interface for transmitting live video footage from the video camera. If recording video for later playback, the computer will be used in conjunction with video editing software to edit audio and video components of the digital video file.
A display device is any type of equipment used to receive a graphic signal and translate it into light impulses for visual display. There are many types of display device that can be used in a projection system: digital projectors, flat panel displays, LED walls, monitors, television sets, etc. The ultimate result is the visual display of graphics and video footage for the projection
Some installations make use of a media server, a
system. The list below covers some basic information
specialized computer built specifically for media storage
about the most common types of display devices.
and playback across multiple different displays. Most media servers are equipped with ultra-fast processors
Digital Projectors
and graphic cards, a large amount of RAM, intense solid-
Digital projectors, sometimes called video projectors,
state storage capabilities, and multiple video outputs.
are digital outputs that accept audio and video
220 PRODUCTION AREAS
For most entertainment applications, there
F I G UR E 12. 1 1
A digital projector.
are three suitable categories of lumens: mid range (2000–3000 lumens), high-performance range (3000–4500 lumens), and ultra-bright range (4500–12,000 lumens). For some applications the highperformance range is suitable and not cost-prohibitive. As throw distance and ambient light increases, though, the ultra-bright range is a must. Of course, the price of this range is incredibly high as compared to the lower range models. Operating distance is the second consideration that will influence the type of projector necessary for a given project. All digital projectors have a given throw ratio that describes the ratio of the distance to the screen (throw) to the resulting image width. For instance, if a projector has a throw ratio of 2:1 and the projector is placed ten feet away from the screen, then the resulting image width would be five feet. It is worth signals from a number of different source types, from
noting that, since most projectors have zoom lenses,
computers to DVD/Blu-ray to live input from a video
most ratios will be variable in nature (i.e. 2–2.4:1).
camera (Figure 12.11). Digital projectors work by
All decisions for projector selection should take into
receiving a video signal and transmitting it via a bright
consideration both the need for lumens and throw
light source and through a lens to enlarge the image
distance.
and project it across a distance. Considerations for digital projectors tend to fall into two categories: brightness (lumens) and operating distance (throw ratio). Brightness of a projector affects how visible the projected image will be, especially when in the presence of other light. The amount of light in a given space (outside of that created by the projector) is commonly referred to as ambient light. When ambient light reflects on to a projected image, there is a potential for the projected image to appear “washed out,” or lacking in definition and color. This is why most
Flat Panel Displays A flat panel display is a type of display surface known for being thin and lightweight (e.g. flat screen TVs). Most flat panel displays today are Liquid Crystalline Display (LCD) technology. Another variety of flat panel is the plasma display, known for producing vivid colors and deeper blacks, enabling a high contrast ratio for displayed video. Plasma displays can be manufactured in large panels and are quite thin— typically around 4˝.
dance applications call for the use of a digital projector
Another possibility with video displays is the ability to
with high brightness output, typically referred to as
link multiple displays together to create a video wall.
“high-lumens.”
The term refers to the use of multiple display devices
221 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO
F I G UR E 12. 1 2
A projection design utilizing an LED wall. Merrily We Roll Along by Stephen Sondheim, Encores! New York City Center. Direction by James Lapine. Projection design by Wendall K. Harrington. Photo courtesy of Wendall K. Harrington.
arranged to create one large screen. In this instance,
12.6 Software Solutions
the displays are not treated as individual devices, but as
As important as hardware and equipment is to the
one display.
LED Panels One of the emergent trends in all areas related to lighting and media is the use of LED technology. LED displays are quite popular due to their ability to produce incredibly bright, vivid colors while using a smaller amount of electricity and having a longer life than traditional lighting fixtures or projectors. LED panels
projection system, the software used to control that equipment could be even more important. Software should be selected based on the needs of the project and what the designer wants to accomplish. Listed below are some common programs used for projection, organized according to their functions. Each has its own unique attributes and uses. Some are incredibly basic, while others require specialized training in order to use.
are basically circuit boards with clusters of LEDs
Slide-based Presentation
attached to the facing (Figure 12.12). They can be easily
This area is one of the most basic in form and function
connected together to form large surfaces and can even be constructed as a curved display surface.
222 PRODUCTION AREAS
and features software with which most casual computer users are familiar. Slide-based programs are created to
mirror the old slide projector method, creating a linear
system, individual looks called cues are saved into the
approach to presenting information where the presenter
playback device’s internal memory. Typically, these
can advance from one slide to the next in order.
cues are stacked in a column in ascending order
Microsoft’s PowerPoint is probably the best-known
with the lowest numeric values at the top. When the
program for this type of presentation method, though
performance begins, the operator simply presses the
Apple also makes a similar program called Keynote.
GO button and progresses in a linear fashion down the
Both programs allow users to create slides with still
cue stack from cue to cue. In terms of consistent, linear
images, video, text, and basic animation effects (fade-in,
playback for projection design there is really only one
fade-out, etc.). While this software is not normally
program on the market: QLab by Figure 53.
utilized for projection design, it can be used in basic applications such as simple photo stills or projecting title card information for a dance, etc. The benefit of this is accessibility, as many computer users already have access to a slide presentation program. The down side is the somewhat unreliable nature of the software and a lack of interactivity.
Linear Playback For many years most theatrical and dance control systems followed the method popularized by lighting consoles, a cue-based linear setup. In the cue-based
QLab is a complete show control software package for Mac OS X that can be used for sound, projections, and controlling other devices in your system, like lighting or special effects (Figure 12.13). There are currently two versions of QLab for sale: version 2 and version 3. In version 2, there were basic projection design functions, but the program primarily remained in the domain of sound design. Since the release of version 3, however, the program has included a vast array of projection design tools, such as video effects, keystone correction, surface mapping, animation, and more. In addition to providing a robust range of functions for
F I G U R E 1 2 . 13
An example of a QLab workspace.
223 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO
sound, projections, and show control, QLab also is
operator then manipulates the length, placement, size,
quite affordable and easy to learn. For these reasons,
and visibility of the cues in relation to one another in the
a number of dance companies have embraced QLab as
timeline. The power of Watchout is in its versatility. Each
their method of playback.
Watchout system is made up of a production computer
Timeline-based Playback
networked to display computers. The production computer holds the media and sends signals out across
Timeline-based playback is an alternate method for
the network to the individual display computers. Each
playback control. Dataton’s Watchout is the program
display computer can be connected to up to six display
most commonly associated with this type of playback
devices. The fact that Watchout uses separate display
for projection design in live performance. Watchout is
computers makes it remarkably scalable to almost any
used for multi-display applications, distributing video
size of application.
and stills across numerous different displays like video walls or seamless overlapping projected imagery.
Interactive Visual Programming
Unlike QLab’s linear approach, Watchout features an
From the beginnings of projection design, dance artists
interface with a horizontal orientation of cues stacked
have experimented with ways to interact with the
atop one another, called the timeline (Figure 12.14).
projections. The program most widely used in dance
Each instance of media (video, still images, sound files)
applications for interactivity in projection is called
is imported into the timeline as a separate cue. The
Isadora. Mark Coniglio, a composer and media artist,
F I G UR E 12. 1 4
The Watchout workspace.
224 PRODUCTION AREAS
created Isadora for use in performances by Troika
initially designed for dance production, there are a
Ranch, a media intensive dance company he co-founded.
number of functions that are appealing for the dance
Today, Isadora (frequently referred to as Izzy, for short)
environment. Isadora can control audio and video in
is distributed by TroikaTronix and used in production
real time based from pre-recorded or live feed. It can be
settings for dance, theatre, video artists (VJs), and more.
used to manipulate media based off of the movements
Isadora is a visual programming environment, meaning that the program can be used to manipulate media in real time while watching the effects live. One of the main benefits to this is a simplified workflow. Designers
of dancers and their location in space. Likewise, it can process a live video feed of the stage, enabling the projection design to integrate live dancers with their own processed image in the projection design.
can use the same program for editing and playback. It
With so many different interactive functions, it is no
works by using 250-plus basic building blocks called
surprise that Isadora is a favorite amongst dance
“actors” that are pre-programmed functions such as
companies across the world. In addition, it features a
image warping, opacity, and more (Figure 12.15). By
relatively low price point (currently $350 per license),
combining multiple actors together and applying them
educational and non-profit discounts, online video
to a media file, the designer can manipulate the media
tutorials, and a stable platform for live performance. It
in interesting and interactive ways.
can be a bit of a steep learning curve for the beginner,
The terms used most often when describing Isadora are flexible and interactive. Since the program was
though, so make sure to include ample experimentation time if using it for the first time.
F I G UR E 12. 1 5
An example of the Isadora programming interface.
225 PROJECTIONS AND VIDEO
12.6 A Word About Interactive Dance
and fashion into an interesting new genre that defies any
Interactive dance is a dance field that blurs the line
one label (Figure 12.16).
between dance, music, and projections, merging the performing and interactive arts. In traditional dance performance, the dancer performs to the media with no control over the music or projection. This means that the dancer must synchronize his/her movement to pre-recorded media, leaving little to no room for improvisation. Interactive dance, on the other hand, integrates motion tracking and data processing capabilities of modern rigs to create a new performance style, in which the dancer’s movement actually controls and interacts with the media. While experiments in interactivity have been popular in dance since the 1970s, it has not been until the last decade that advances in motion sensing technology combined with computer animation have broadened the scope of what is possible in integrating media and live performance. Companies like Kansas City’s Quixotic blur the lines between dance, electronic music, projection mapping, aerial acrobatics,
12.7 Chapter Review Projection design is an important field of dance production that enables a greater level of interactivity and versatility in presenting the choreographer’s vision for the performance. The technology used in projection design is changing at a rapid pace, making it possible for a wider range of users to have access. Even so, it is a production area that requires a great deal of planning and financial investment on the part of the producing dance company. As such, it should be discussed early in the production process with an honest assessment of the company’s resources. It is important for the choreographer and production team to consider the way in which projections will be used in the production and how projection design affects all of the other production areas.
Review Questions 1. What is rear projection? 2. How does ambient light affect projections? 3. Describe the keystone effect. 4. What is projection mapping? 5. What is the difference between linear and interactive content? 6. Explain the difference between a video playback system and a video reinforcement system. 7. What is a media server? 8. Describe a video wall and how it functions. 9. Which program is ideal for linear, cue-based playback? 10. Which program is a real-time visual programming environment?
F I G UR E 12. 1 6
Quixotic’s unique brand of interactive dance. Photo courtesy of João Biera.
226 PRODUCTION AREAS
This page intentionally left blank
CHAPTER 13 CREATING THE PROJECTION DESIGN Projected images are ephemeral; they live in another more poetic dimension. Dance is the poetry of music as made manifest by the body. Projection and dance are an inevitable and welcome combination. Wendall K. Harrington Alexei Ratmansky’s Cinderella at the Australian Ballet, 2013. This world premiere ballet set to music by Sergei Prokofiev featured scenery, projections, and costumes inspired by Surrealist art. Photo courtesy Wendall K. Harrington. Choreography by Alexei Ratmansky. Costume and set design by Jérôme Kaplan. Lighting design by Rachel Burke. Projection design by Wendall K. Harrington.
The role of the projection designer, perhaps more so
For instance, perhaps he wants to use the work of
than any other dance designer, is defined by the needs
a well-known painter to create a three-dimensional
of the project. As illustrated in the previous chapter,
environment. In this example, the role of the projection
so many aspects of the design are dependent on the
designer is more centered on composition and visual
requirements of the dance. Like the lighting designer,
storytelling, rather than being rooted in the creation
the projection designer deals with the ephemeral
of original visual content. In another example, the
and must communicate his/her design ideas in great
choreographer may have only a loose concept in mind
detail, often before even having stepped foot into the
of the dancers creating movement onstage that will
performance space. In order to communicate the design
ultimately be represented in the projection design,
idea, the projection designer relies on research, pre-
with the projections serving as a counterpoint to the
visualization, draftings, and paperwork in addition to the
movement of the dancers onstage. In this instance, the
basic written and verbal communication skills. Since
projection designer will likely be involved to a greater
projection design is still a young and rapidly changing
degree in the rehearsal process and might even have
art form, there are a number of different approaches
a hand at collaborating with the choreographer to
to the creative process. This chapter details a few key
determine how the movement might best serve the
concepts for how a designer progresses from the design
projections and vice versa.
idea to execution.
Setting Goals
13.1 Working with the Choreographer
In my experience, projection design tends to be
The collaborative process for projection design can be a
the area with which choreographers are the least
bit more circuitous than some of the other disciplines,
familiar. As a result, there is often a tendency to rely
since projections tend to affect so many other areas
on the projection designer to define the goals and
of design. The successful projection designer must
outcomes of the project. While this can seem helpful
be prepared to be in constant communication with the
at first, it can sometimes lead to negative outcomes
choreographer, scenic designer, and lighting designer
in collaboration. Clear communication from the
about design decisions, since those decisions (and the
earliest stages is important to ensure that all parties
decisions of the other designers) can have such a great
know what the goals are for the projection design
impact on the process and affect a great number of
and how the designer hopes to accomplish them.
factors.
Like the other design areas we have discussed so
One of the most important goals for working with the choreographer is determining the function of projections within the dance. As discussed in the previous chapter, there are a number of ways in which projections can function in the dance setting. Determining the choreographer’s expectations for projections will help define the nature of your collaborative model. Sometimes the choreographer will enter the process with a specific vision in mind for the projected imagery.
230 PRODUCTION AREAS
far, I find it useful to present the choreographer with a series of questions to help focus the conversation. Sometimes the answer will be, “I don’t know. What do you think?” This opens the door to conversation that will help guide the way.
Talking About Your Dance 1.
Describe in two to three sentences what you want your dance to communicate.
2.
3.
If possible, describe the basic “plotline” of your
●●
If so, has permission been secured for its use?
dance, describing important events or changes
●●
What is the rehearsal schedule?
within the dance.
●●
What is the tech schedule?
How do you see projection contributing to the
●●
Will there be additional time built into the tech
storytelling? 4.
Is your dance based on or influenced by any particular work of art? (If so, feel free to include images, links/references with this response.)
5.
Give a few adjectives or short descriptive phrases to describe how your dance (or individual sections) should feel.
6. 7.
process for working with projections? ●●
Will the projections require filming the dancers?
●●
If so, will costumes, hair and make-up, props, etc. be required?
●●
Will projection design require syncing with audio (e.g. actor voiceover, video syncing with music, etc.)?
Do you see the projections as part of the scenery or
13.2 Communicating the Design
more of a stand-alone element?
No matter the design area, one of the primary roles of
Do you see the projections as a presentational
the designer is communicating his/her design ideas to
element or a design element with which the
other members of the production team and those
dancers interact?
working to execute the design. In the area of projection
Practical Concerns
design, this is particularly important since the projected imagery interacts with so many other areas of the
When going into collaboration with a choreographer
production. This section details some of the ways in which
(especially for the first time) I always try to send a
projection designers can communicate ideas.
message with a list of practical concerns that will be important to the overall process. Listed below is
Visual Communication
a checklist of information with which the designers,
The projection designer tends to produce fewer
choreographer, and dancers should be familiar. In
drawings than the scenic or costume designers
addition, some questions were listed in the previous
and deal more in the world of digital imagery. It is
chapter in Section 12.2. Try to address as many of these
much more common to find the projection designer
questions as possible early in the production planning
communicating ideas through visual research,
process, since the answers will dictate the choices that
storyboards, verbal exchanges, or pre-visualization than
must be made regarding equipment, content, budget,
through a traditional rendering medium. The following
and more.
list includes some common methods of visually
●●
Is this a new piece or a remount?
●●
If a remount, are there elements of the premiere that are important to reproduce?
●●
How will projections be integrated with the scenic and lighting design?
●●
communicating design ideas.
Research One of the first methods of communicating projection design ideas is the use of visual research. One of the primary benefits of this method is the ability to show
Is there specific graphic content needed for the
a number of different ideas without having to commit
projection design?
to hours of work in producing visual content. This can
231 CREATING THE PROJECTION DESIGN
be assembled in a collage method, or as a slide show
performance space and scenery. The purpose of this plot
featuring certain types of imagery for different moments
is to include all of the necessary technical information
in the dance, or simply as individual photos to discuss.
of the projection design rig needed to hang, circuit, and
The designer should always walk the choreographer
focus the equipment. It is drafted atop a ground plan
through the research, pointing out what aspects are
of the theatre space and any included scenery. Since
important: color, the actual image, the contrast, etc.
projection and lighting equipment are frequently vying
Pre-visualization Since light is such an ephemeral medium and is heavily affected by the projection surfaces, it is difficult to emulate the finished product of a design without the use of computer technology. As mentioned in our discussions of lighting design, pre-visualization (or pre-viz, for short) has become an expectation of many lighting and projection designers. In projection design, as in lighting, there are a number of software solutions that can be used for pre-viz. For some projects, the use of graphics editing programs such as Photoshop would be sufficient for presenting a design idea. This is not, however, true pre-visualization. Pre-visualization requires a 3D rendering program that allows the designer to input a 3D model of the theatre, scenery, and human figures into a program and include the projectors in their exact placement as well. Through the use of the software’s graphic engine, the geometry is calculated to determine exactly how the visual content will appear when projected on an object.
for the same space, it is important to coordinate with the lighting designer to determine placement possibilities. The section is a drafting of the theatre cut down the centerline and viewed from one side. Again, this is very similar to the lighting designer’s centerline section— used to visualize the theatre architecture, scenery, and masking in the context of hanging positions and equipment.
Design Paperwork and Informational Graphics The projection designer utilizes a vast amount of paperwork to complete the projection design. Unlike lighting design paperwork, there are few software solutions on the market created specifically for use by the projection designer. One interesting thing to consider about the projection design industry is that, since it is such a young field, there are not as many industry standards to design approaches as in the other areas examined. You will find that the workflow, paperwork, and design methodology will vary greatly from designer to designer, since there is not yet an
There are a number of different choices on the
official “right way” to do things. That is not to say that
market, such as Nemetschek’s Vectorworks, or Cast
there are not approved methods and recommended
Technology’s WYSIWYG. Other platforms like D3 are
practices, but in many ways the field is still discovering
intended to function as an extension of their own
how best to define its own industry standards. Listed
projection design hardware. In cases like this, the
below are some different types of paperwork and
software allows the designer to pre-program the show
informational graphics used by projection designers to
before even entering the space.
plan for the design execution.
Draftings: The Projection Plot and Centerline Section
Signal Flow Charts
The projection plot, similar to the light plot, shows the
One common informational graphic created by the
placement of projection equipment in relationship to the
projection designer is the signal flow chart. This chart
232 PRODUCTION AREAS
F I G UR E 13. 1
A simple block-style signal flow chart, showing the path of video signals from a video camera and media stored on a media server, outputting to eight separate digital projectors.
CAMERA INPUT
MEDIA SERVER
---3>-
Drawing by Jeromy Hopgood.
COMP.1
COMP. 2
COMP. 3
COMP.4
COMP.4 COMP.4 COMP.4 COMP.4 COMP.4 COMP.4 COMP.4COMP.4
(or charts) is a graphic representation of how the
dependent on only one person. In a collaborative
equipment is set up and in what direction the media
environment, however, other members of the production
flows from the source to the display device. This chart
team affect the workflow. For instance, if the projection
is helpful in determining the cables required to connect
design uses video footage of the dancers, filming might
devices and can be invaluable to the troubleshooting
have to wait until costumes are complete. Likewise,
process once something inevitably malfunctions. There
there might be multiple members contributing content.
are a number of different approaches to creating a
In this case, it is important to identify exactly who is
signal flow chart, but the most common approach is
doing what task and in what order. This is the purpose of
a series of boxes with lines that connect them to one
the content workflow diagram. This diagram illustrates
another and arrows to indicate the direction of the
not only who will be providing what content but in what
signal flow (Figure 13.1).
order and how one step affects others in the process.
Content Workflow Diagrams When creating the projection design, it is always
This type of chart can be used to increase productivity and help instill a sense of accountability to the process.
important to consider workfl ow. Workflow can
Cue Sheets
be described as the sequence of events and tasks
As the designer nears the process of creating cues for
required to take a design from concept to completion.
the dance, it is important to create a cue sheet, a form
Each designer develops his/her own unique approach
that breaks down the dance according to individual
to workflow. When working alone, the timetable is
cues, their timing, description, and routing (which
233 CREATING THE PROJECTION DESIGN
computer/projector sends the image to what surface).
Apple’s iMovie or Windows’ Movie Maker can be used
The cue sheet can be organized in a number of different
for basic video editing. For more complex applications,
formats, but it is common to use the spreadsheet-
programs like Final Cut Pro, Adobe Premiere, Avid
style approach, utilizing columns and rows to track the
Media Composer, and Sony Vegas Pro are all solid
information. Important considerations are cue number,
choices. Each of these programs has built-in functions
description (what happens onstage that motivates
to trim and splice video, create fade-in/fade-out effects,
calling a cue), and timing (how long it takes for the
add titles, manipulate brightness, contrast, and color
action to occur), though there may well be a number
settings, etc. It is common for a projection designer
of other areas included. The cue sheet is an important
to have access to a number of different video editing
way for the designer to cement his/her thoughts on
programs.
what will happen in the projections design and is used to communicate to the stage manager how the cues should be called for the dance.
13.3 Content The successful projection designer must have a balance of artistic talent and technical proficiency—an ability to generate original graphic content with an understanding of the tools of image and video editing. This is an area in which the artistic ability of the projection designer shines. Content creation allows the designer to create new artistic works for presentation on a wide scale, through photography, digital art, video, or animations. This section details a few of the tools common to the projection designer for content and editing.
Video Content When discussing video content creation, the basic requirements are a video camera and some type of editing software. Cameras can be either digital video or analog, though if a camera is not digital video your
In addition to basic editing, programs like Adobe After Effects allow the projection designer to create motion graphics, 3D and visual effects with video files. There are many interesting effects that these post-production editing programs can accomplish, such as explosions, blurring imagery, or animating moving elements into a video.
Stills In addition to video, photo stills are a common content element for projection design. For creating this type of content, the normal tools are a digital camera and/or some type of graphics software. Graphics programs like Adobe Photoshop and Illustrator have become staples in content creation for image stills. There is also freeware software such as Gimp that can accomplish many of the same outcomes. A common attribute of most graphics editing programs is the ability to stack different layers of imagery atop one another and change the opacity, enabling the designer to create rich and dynamic compositions.
computer must have specialized inputs for converting
The two standard types of graphics software generate
analog video to digital. Digital video cameras have
either raster graphics or vector graphics. Raster
become incredibly affordable and offer up a number of
graphics are images made up of a series of dots called
high-definition options, even in entry-level models.
pixels, where each pixel is assigned a specific color
Once the video has been captured, it is necessary to edit the video takes into a final presentation. Programs like
234 PRODUCTION AREAS
value. These images are created in programs such as Photoshop or Gimp. While raster images are great for print and web media, they are not always ideal for
projection design. Since raster graphics are designed
Stock Footage
at a specific resolution, when the image is enlarged
When creating a projection design, the designer has a
or reduced, the pixels are affected, creating a blurry or pixelated image. Vector graphics, on the other hand, are images created from basic geometric forms such as points, lines, and curves. The vector graphic is expressed in a specific mathematical equation that enables the image to be reduced or enlarged without distortion. Vector graphics are created in programs such as Illustrator, CorelDRAW, or Inkscape.
3D Rendering and Animation In addition to the two-dimensional graphics mentioned above, projection designers are frequently called upon to create three-dimensional images. In contrast to 2D, 3D graphics use a three-dimensional representation of geometric data to create a representation of a three-dimensional object. The final image created by
number of choices for content. In addition to making content from scratch, many designers utilize stock footage as components of the design. Stock footage is a catchall term referring to any type of pre-existing imagery, either stills or video, which can be used as part of the projection design. Stock footage can come from a number of different sources. There are numerous companies that provide stock footage for a fee. Of late, there are also many websites that offer free stock footage. Most projection designers also create a database of stock footage for their own use that can be repurposed for a number of different projection design projects. For these purposes, it is essential that the designer creates a logical system of naming and organizing the files.
this software, featuring color, textures, and lighting,
Legal Concerns
is referred to as a 3D rendering. These images are
There are many different legal concerns when dealing
amazingly realistic and often cannot be distinguished from an actual photograph or video. Projection designers use programs such as Autodesk’s 3DS Max or the open source Blender to create 3D renderings.
Audio Content Finally, no projection designer’s content creation setup would be complete without considering sound editing. Even though the projection designer does not execute the overall sound design for the production, it is a common occurrence that video would feature an audio feed. In these cases, the projection designer must be proficient in editing and/or creating audio content for the design. While many video editing programs have built-in sound editing capabilities, projection designers may also use programs such as Apple’s Logic Pro or Avid’s Pro Tools, both of which offer the ability to integrate video into the editing workspace and sync audio with your video.
with the use of an image created by another person. Technically speaking, the artist who created an image or took a photograph owns the copyright for that work of art from the moment of its creation. This means that, when using someone else’s work, you really need to understand the legality of use without violating someone else’s copyright. You should typically have the copyright holder’s permission when using any artistic work not of your own creation. Listed below are some important considerations for securing permission. Always get permission in writing for using the image. This permission form should indicate how the image will be used, in what performance, the number of performances, the number of seats in the performance space, and how/if the acknowledgement of the copyright holder will be listed to the audience. It is best to confer with a legal representative about the specific wording of such permission forms, so as to protect yourself.
235 CREATING THE PROJECTION DESIGN
When dealing with photographs of people, there is
surest course of action is to use original imagery, and
also a secondary consideration of the model. Ask
when in doubt about the legality of image use, err on
the photographer if there was a model waiver form
the side of caution and look for another option. Another
signed for the work. If the artist did not explicitly have
note of caution should be extended to those in academia.
permission to photograph the model in the work, then
Many academics make the false assumption that, since
he/she may not be able to give you permission to use
their work is created in an academic environment, the
the work.
use of copyrighted materials is covered as fair use. While
Licensing is another important thing to be aware of as a designer. There are a number of different license types for imagery. If an image is part of the public domain, it means that the rights for the image have been released for public use without cost. If the copyright expires on a work of art, it will fall into the public domain. Likewise, certain entities can choose to automatically release the work into the public domain. For instance, any work created by the United States government and its entities (US military, NASA, etc.) is part of the public domain and a valuable resource for stock footage.
it is true that the classroom is typically covered as a fair use environment, the moment that the work is integrated into a performance it leaves the domain of the classroom and becomes a public event. When in doubt, seek out permission for the use of copyrighted works.
13.4 Preparing for Technical Rehearsals Unlike scenery or costumes, much of the work of the projections designer is accomplished once the load-in occurs in the performance space. One of the indications of a designer’s success in technical rehearsals is often the amount of preparation done beforehand. A wellprepared designer will respond to the rigors of technical
Not all stock footage is part of the public domain,
rehearsals much better than one who plans on “winging
however. If using an image from a stock footage service,
it.” Listed below are some things to consider before
it is likely licensed under very specific terms. Two
heading into the tech process.
common types of licensing are royalty-free and rightsmanaged. With royalty-free images, you typically pay
Preparing to Cue
a one-time licensing fee and then own the right to use
Much of the content creation and organization can
the image in whatever way you choose. It is important to
be done offsite, but it is sometimes difficult for the
recognize that royalty-free does not mean free to use.
projection designer to truly cue the show outside of
In most every instance, royalty-free images must still
the theatre space. Since so much of the specific detail
be purchased up front to ensure licensing. With rights-
of the design is related to the physical projection
managed imagery, there is a licensing fee as well, but
surfaces, cueing is a process best accomplished in
your right to use the image is restricted to a greater
the performance space. Before beginning the cueing
degree. There are typically limitations for image use
process, however, there are a number of questions to
related to timeline, geographic location, purpose, etc.
address.
In this case, the license agreement will indicate exactly how the images can be used. The complexities of copyright law are far too great to be completely covered in this text. Keep in mind that the
236 PRODUCTION AREAS
Do You have all of Your Content? In preparing for the cueing process, it is important to collect and organize all of the content to be used in the projection design. At this point, the cue sheet
and paperwork are indispensible for knowing what
sequences of events. Like both lighting and sound, the
content is secured and what needs to be completed. Plan
cueing process will be affected by the type of projection
on bringing in all of the content and backup copies with
equipment and control software. Each program has
a few different methods for accessing the materials. It is
its own unique process for the creation of cues. The
unfortunate to be in the space with only one copy of the
projection designer should be intimately familiar with
content when a hard drive malfunctions or is damaged.
the use of the software and understand how it will
Is all of Your Equipment Installed and Working?
affect his/her cueing process. No matter what setup is used, though, there are some common considerations
While this might seem like an obvious question, it
for the cueing process. Listed below are some of these
is essential that all of the equipment be set up and
thoughts.
tested before going into the cueing process. Time is money and the projection designer will only be
1.
previously, it is common for the projection designer
given so much time in the space. You don’t want
to have a tech table set up in the auditorium. The
to waste the valuable cueing time troubleshooting
tech table allows the designer to see his/her work
nonfunctioning equipment. In addition to basic
from the vantage point of the audience, rather
questions of equipment function, this is the time to
than from the control booth, which is typically far
consider any specific needs that might be required
away from the stage and in an awkward position.
for cueing. For instance, is the projection computer(s)
Sometimes it is impossible for the projection
positioned in a location where the stage is visible? If
control equipment to be positioned at the tech
not, is it possible to set up a remote network to control
table, however. In these cases, it is important
the computer? Perhaps a video feed of the stage would
that the projection designer has headsets for
be another option to aid in cueing. Taking the time to
communicating with the operator and, ideally, a
answer these questions before the cueing session will
method for remotely accessing and controlling the
save a lot of time later on.
Do you have Dark Time Scheduled in the Space?
projection control system. 2.
on hand at the tech table. It is always wise to think
during the time leading up to technical rehearsals. This
ahead so that you don’t find yourself having to leave
is why it is so important for the projection designer to
to get something from home. A well-equipped tech
schedule a period of time in which all of the theatre’s
table should include: pencils and scrap paper,
auditorium and work lights will be turned off so the
cue sheet(s), design paperwork, a flashlight, a
projections can be seen under show conditions.
stopwatch, a laptop for the designer with a network connection, a backup computer for the control
Cueing the Show
system, a portable hard drive and thumb drives
The cueing process for projections is similar to the
for backup and file transport, and surge-protected
approaches to both lighting and sound. Like lighting space to see the work come to life. Similar to sound, so many of the cueing choices will be linked to timing and
What to bring? When moving into the theatre, it is important to consider what things you will want
Everyone has a lot to accomplish in a short period of time
design, it is important to be in a darkened performance
The tech table. Like the other areas discussed
power strips. 3.
Working with the music. If your dance incorporates music, it can be useful to listen to the music while
237 CREATING THE PROJECTION DESIGN
cueing. Especially in instances where projection
of a production to ensure everyone has a sufficient
must sync with music, there is no better way to get
amount of time and resources to complete their work in
it right than working with the music. In addition, if
time for opening night.
the sound design must sync with the projections,
4.
it is essential to meet with the sound designer and
13.6 Chapter Review
discuss the necessary equipment used and how the
The job of creating the projection design is a complex
two systems must integrate. For these purposes,
process with a number of different requirements.
a device called a word clock is used to synchronize
The projection designer must balance artistry and
the multiple devices in the system.
technical expertise to create a dynamic and visually
Working with a rehearsal video. As mentioned in
interesting design that contributes to the dance
previous chapters, a rehearsal video is invaluable
without drawing focus away from the performance. In
to the cueing process. By referencing the video,
creating the design, the projection designer must use
you can determine the location of certain moments
draftings, drawings/renderings, paperwork, and verbal
on the stage and ensure the timing is correct.
communication to communicate his/her ideas. Planning
Likewise, if using a rehearsal video that includes
and workflow are central concerns of the projection
music, this allows you to include both music and
designer, used to ensure continuity from his/her initial
movement into one package.
concept through the final performance. Through a
13.5 Technical Rehearsals The nature of technical rehearsals varies from project to project. At its essence, the technical rehearsals are those sessions dedicated to working through the dances
study of the projection designer’s process, we gain an increased appreciation for the job of the designer and his/her role within the production.
Review Questions
with all technical elements included. It might be a long
1. What is a signal flow chart?
process over the course of multiple weeks or only a day,
2. Which document is used to communicate who is
depending on the specific production arrangements. If the dance company owns its own space, it is common to see longer periods of tech. If the company is renting the space, the tech process might be limited to one day or even a few hours before going into the performance. The duration of the tech process is definitely a deciding factor for projection use and how they are integrated into the production. With a production that requires a
providing content and in what order work is done? 3. What document is used to break down the dance according to individual cues, their timing, description, and routing? 4. Name a software program that can be used for basic video editing. 5. What is a raster based graphic?
high level of interaction between the performers and the
6. What is a vector based graphic?
projections, it is wise to schedule more time in technical
7. What is a 3D rendering and how is it created?
rehearsals. Likewise, if the technical rehearsal is a
8. What is stock footage and how is it used?
shortened time period, it will require that the designer
9. Explain the difference between royalty-free and
plan ahead and have the projection design fully cued and ready to go from the beginning of tech. These are the factors that must be brought up early in the discussion
238 PRODUCTION AREAS
rights-managed stock footage. 10. What is a word clock used for?
The Projection Designer’s Perspective: An Interview with João Beira
back in the beginning of 2000. I wrote my master’s thesis
João Beira describes himself as a new media artist
art forms such as live cinema. Their live experience with
and visual performer. His work in projection design is related to research in spatial augmented reality, interactive design, and responsive and immersive digital environments in real time. João is the founder and artistic director of Datagrama, a visual performance art project focused on interactive live visuals, stage design, and 3D video mapping. For the last decade, he has performed internationally at art and music festivals, participating in artistic residencies and
about the computer jockey and his relevance in upcoming media and in particular with digital media is the core of my expression as a visual artist. In 2010 I moved to the United States to do a Ph.D. and I met Professor Yacov Shariv, who became my mentor and also my supervisor. He worked for decades in the intersection of dance with technology and introduced me to interactive media design for dance. Since then, I have devoted my research and work to combining motion tracking with 3D video mapping, collaborating with many different artists such as musicians, choreographers,
collaborating with many artists and performers. He is
architects, designers, dancers, art directors, FX artists, etc.
also a collaborator with Kansas City’s Quixotic Fusion,
My experience as a projection designer extended from
a performance group that merges together dance,
the VJ and electronic music scene; since then I started
acrobatics, projection mapping, music, and fashion into
to use motion and 3D video mapping as my main forms
a multidisciplinary spectacle. Since 2010 he has been
of expression. I believe that the role of the VJ has gained
working on a dual degree Ph.D. in Digital Media at the
new meaning over the last decade, adding a stronger layer
University of Texas at Austin and in the FEUP at the
of creativity and DIY solutions for projection design and
University of Porto. João holds an M.A. in Multimedia Art
interactive art.
from the University of Porto and a bachelor’s degree in Fine Arts from ESAP. Two of his recent projects, 2&4 and 3D [Embodied], were nominated for best video design in 2012 and 2013 by the Austin Critics’ Table Awards.
One of the companies for which you have done some interesting work is called Quixotic Fusion. Can you describe Quixotic and the process of working with them?
The projection design world is such a new field in
Quixotic Fusion is an ensemble of artists from various
dance. Could you tell me a bit about how you got started
disciplines including aerial acrobatics, dance, design,
as a projection designer?
music, and visuals. It is a collective of creative designers
My exploration of video and design started with electronic
and performers.
live music events in my youth. This style of work is usually
My collaboration and role with Quixotic Fusion was an
referred to as VJ-ing and has been attracting young visual
extension of the work that I was developing as a practice-
artists over the last decade to projection design. Through
based Ph.D. student working with interactive dance, more
music and using real time strategies, VJs use light and
precisely my work with depth sensors and motion tracking
video projections to invoke an expression and design
with dancers. Quixotic Fusion has provided me with an
process.
amazing framework to explore the potential of motion
My background was in fine arts and design. My focus has
capture technologies for dance artists. In particular, to
always been related to real time visuals, even when that
explore the depth camera visualization tools with body
was not fully accepted as an art form in the academic world
mapping in real time. For this we use generative design
239 CREATING THE PROJECTION DESIGN
strategies. First, through the use of motion sensing input
significant number of artistic projects in interactive
devices we capture 3D data of the dance performer, the
dance. As Peter Kin wrote in 2011 in his blog www.
cloud point. This data is then translated into shaders and
createdigitalmotion.com: “the combination of sensing with
to specific design pallets. The visual outcome is projected
projection is to live digital visuals what a technique like
back onto her body and a transparent screen right in front
perspective was to painting centuries ago. It’s a calculated
of the performer—a scrim. This process changes and grows
illusion, but it could be the basis for an entire body of work,
as we perform every show. It is an evolving process just like
both a marvel in itself and a springboard to new art.”
a music band’s creative process. Using a depth sensor camera means that instead of working with light values that we have from video cameras we now use data values of depth and motion. The mapping process of this data to creative design strategies is the core of my work with Quixotic Fusion.
I know you work on a wide range of projects. How does working in a dance-based art form differ from what you do in some other genres? My work as a projection designer is based in interactive strategies for real time and also the exploitation of 3D space with video. This means I do a wide range of shows,
I know one of your areas of expertise is interactive
varying from architectural lighting with 3D animation, live
dance. Many of our readers may not be particularly
visuals, theatre, and dance performances.
familiar with that field. Can you tell us about interactive
Dance-based art relies on a collaborative process and the
dance as an art form?
articulation of different arts and it’s based in motion. This
Interactive dance is a field that emerged from performing
changes profoundly the creative process for media design.
and interactive arts. Choreography in the digital age had
When you work with musicians you usually focus on sound
a difficult start due to the complexity of human movement
and time, while in theatre we usually focus on storytelling
to be digitized. Technological development in computer
and narrative. In dance we focus on the body, space, and
hardware and software has made it possible to record digital
time. With the use of sensing technologies this process
3D representations of moving bodies. During the 1990s most
might be described as augmented reality, as we use live
of the work was based on pre-recorded content and based
direct physical real-world environment to augment in the
in pre- and post-production usage of the data gathered
virtual space. This process is referred to as mixed reality
from dancers. I believe this was not really augmenting the
and this output can be also described as spatial augmented
dancers’ movement but actually restricting it.
reality, merging real and virtual worlds in one display and
In general, performers had to do the same routine,
reality for the audience. In conclusion, the nature of the art
leaving almost no space for improvisation, creating a
form that you collaborate with dictates the creative process.
disembodiment for the dancers, for movement freedom
Do you have a dance background/any formalized
and expression. During the last decade this has changed significantly. With the introduction of motion tracking and data processing began a new philosophy and media design strategies for movement in the digital age. Dance and
training in dance? I do not have any formal training in dance; my background was in fine arts and multimedia.
technology attained a new and higher level of integration.
Have you done any “traditional” dance design? If so,
The scientific breakthroughs in sensing technology
how does this process differ from the work you do in
combined with computer animation have created a
240 PRODUCTION AREAS
interactive dance?
No, I have never done traditional dance design. But this
traditional approach of video design for live events. When
question brings us to the nature of “dead” media—pre-
I moved to the United States in 2010 as a Ph.D. student
rendered or pre-recorded media— and “live” media—real
I found there were opportunities to use live video design
time generative media.
for events. At this time it seemed to me that there were
Real time feedback and the use of sensing natural
clearly opportunities in the entertainment industry and that
interfaces are two benefits of choreographing in the digital age. The dance performer practices with the system like an instrument and the process is quite similar to the computer gaming experience. As a media designer and visual artist, I engage in regular sessions with them, and the outcome of each project is based on this collaborative process. With analog media, or “dead” media, it was too complex and demanding to map such large amounts of data. This process and technological development changed profoundly
not many people were creating work with a wider range of skills than traditional projection designers. In general, there are more resources and opportunities to develop bigscale projects in the United States. This is also visible in the academic world, especially in large universities, where you can have access not just to equipment, but also to multidisciplinary collaborations with different departments within the same university. I also found in the United States opportunities to conduct my Ph.D. work as practice-based
the creative process of media design for live dancers.
research, which is a great framework to work as a designer
I know you have worked internationally as a designer
for experimentation and pioneering development in Europe,
and educator. What are some of the key differences you notice in American vs. international work?
and educator. Overall, I believe that there is a lot of space but it is usually in the United States that these ideas gain a different scale and exposure. I also found that the American
My experience as a teaching professional and designer in
public is extremely receptive to new ways to experience
Portugal and Europe was quite relevant since it allowed
video and calculated illusions with light. My work in
me to gain experience and interest in the DIY culture and
collaboration with Quixotic Fusion is a great example of
architectural light design. France-based projects like
that, as we perform mostly in the United States, but also in
1024 and antivj highly influenced me to start to expand the
Asia and Europe.
241 CREATING THE PROJECTION DESIGN
CHAPTER 14 STAGE MANAGEMENT Perhaps, therefore, ideal stage managers not only need to be calm and meticulous professionals who know their craft, but masochists who feel pride in rising above impossible odds. Peter Hall
A photo from the studio collection “Simply Magic” by Richard Calmes. Photography of dancers in motion from the Gwinnett Ballet Theatre in suburban Atlanta, Georgia. Photography by Richard Calmes.
The stage manager is undoubtedly the linchpin of
the theatre artist, this chapter should be a useful primer
live performance. This is true for dance as well as
in considering the differences between theatrical and
theatre. From the initial discussions with designers,
dance stage management.
to the rehearsal period, to running the show and interacting with the company, the stage manager is the
14.1 The Stage Manager
single person whose job affects the greatest number
In both professional and academic circles, the role of
of individuals in the production process. As a dance
stage management is often linked to the individual
stage manager, one must be fluent in many different
dance company or academic department and their
languages—dance, theatre, and management being
specific needs. Since the role is often so specific to
three of the most important. The stage manager is the
the individual workplace, there will never be a cookie
source through which all information is disseminated
cutter, “one-size-fits-all” job description for a dance
and the individual responsible for keeping all production
stage manager. The term stage management refers to
members on schedule. In addition to organizing
the collective group of personnel responsible for the job
rehearsals and production meetings, the stage manager
of managing the production. In most dance companies,
also runs the technical rehearsals and during the
the main management roles fall under the categories
performance is the single individual coordinating cues
of production management and/or stage management.
and calling them out over the headset (referred to as
While, technically speaking, a production manager’s
“calling the show”). Finally, once the production is
duties do not fit neatly into the job description of stage
up and running, it is the duty of the stage manager
manager, many companies combine different aspects of
to continually watch performances and ensure
each of these roles into one job. Listed below is a brief
consistency to the original vision of the choreographer
description of some common roles for both areas.
and designers, so that the artistic integrity of all of the artists is maintained. It is a huge responsibility. Many
Production Management
dance stage managers come from the dance world
As mentioned in Chapter 1, the production manager (or
and have never worked as a theatrical stage manager
PM, for short) is the person who keeps the production
(the same is true in reverse for many theatrical stage
on schedule and on budget. In addition, most dance
managers). Though many of the duties are similar, the
companies utilize the PM as a liaison between the
dance stage manager tends to take on many specialized
performance venue and the company. Since many dance
roles within the dance company that would not typically
companies do not own their own performance space,
fall under the domain of a theatrical stage manager.
it is an important aspect of the job. Typical duties of a
This chapter details many of the aspects of serving as a
production manager include forwarding technical specs
dance stage manager. It is, by no means, meant to be an
to the design staff, examining the performance space
exhaustive study of the role of the stage manager. There
for any special considerations, setting up production
are many excellent textbooks on the market dedicated
meetings that bring together administrators and
to that pursuit. Instead, this chapter should introduce
production staff, creating the production schedule,
the aspiring dancer, choreographer, or designer to
tracking the production budget, and hiring technicians
the world of stage management for dance and foster a
to run the performance. In many dance companies,
sense of appreciation for all of the ways in which stage
it has become the norm to employ the production
managers assist in the creative process. Likewise, for
manager to participate in rehearsals and call the show
244 PRODUCTION AREAS
as well. In this case, the role is often known as the
●●
Communication: One of the primary roles of any
production stage manager. This term can lead to a bit
stage manager is communication. All information
of confusion, since many theatrical productions use the
should be shared through the stage manager to
term production stage manager to refer to the lead stage
ensure that it is properly documented in writing
manager in a group of several different stage managers.
and that all parties have access to the information (since one area’s choices might inadvertently affect
Stage Management
another). As a result, the stage manager documents
Depending on the size of a production, there might
all meetings, rehearsals, and correspondence to and
be more than one stage manager involved in running
from production team members.
the show. For smaller productions, there will likely be
●●
During the rehearsal period, the stage manager
one stage manager for the entire process. For larger
disseminates information to all production members
productions, there might be a stage manager and one or
through daily emails of notes and reminders. These
more assistant stage managers working to fulfill stage
are referred to as rehearsal reports. In addition, the
management duties. Sometimes the supervising stage
stage manager typically compiles notes for dancers
manager is referred to as the production stage manager
to be posted on the callboard of the rehearsal space
(PSM), head stage manager, or first stage manager. The
or through email. A callboard is a location in the
assistant stage manager (ASM) is commonly situated
rehearsal and/or performance space dedicated to
backstage during the production run and organizes
posting information for performers. It will include call
backstage traffic, calling dancers for places, and working
times for the following day’s rehearsal, notes, and
with properties and/or wardrobe crews to facilitate props tracking and quick changes. During the pre-production
pertinent information for the company (Figure 14.1) ●●
process, it is common to only have the stage manager
correspondence continues in the form of
working with the choreographer and production staff and
performance reports, a record of the performance
to bring in ASMs during the technical rehearsals.
including running times, accidents, technical problems that arose (and how they were addressed),
Common Responsibilities
technical problems that must be addressed before
No matter the nature of the organization, there are
the next performance, and information about
some duties that will commonly fall into the domain
upcoming performances and events (such as photo
of stage management. Listed below are a collection
calls, etc.). In addition, the performance report
of these responsibilities and a brief description of
frequently includes front-of-house information such
expectations. ●●
Once the show is up and running, daily
as attendance, when the house opened, when the
Scheduling: Stage managers frequently create
performance began, intermission times, and patron
rehearsal schedules, production meeting schedules,
issues. In this way, the performance report is a way
technical rehearsal schedules, and schedules for
a wide range of people can stay informed about the
tech times in the space for production members. In
performance.
addition to creating the schedule, the stage manager is ultimately responsible for disseminating the information (see next).
●●
Running rehearsals: If the dance company expects a stage manager to be involved in the rehearsal period, it is common for him/her to perform a
245 STAGE MANAGEMENT
F I G UR E 14. 1
A callboard used for theatre and dance performances.
number of tasks to ensure an efficient use of time
●●
Recording information: One of the more important
and resources. The stage manager will work with
tasks of the stage manager is to act as a sort of
the choreographer to determine the number of
human recording mechanism. In meetings, stage
dancers that should be called and at what times,
management will take minutes of what is said. In
thereby ensuring the dancers are only in rehearsal
rehearsals, stage management will take movement
when needed. Likewise, the stage manager will keep
notes and start to assemble a performance script
an eye on the clock during rehearsal and remind
of what actions occur in what order. Included with
the choreographer of the schedule, including break
this is important information such as tracking props
times. If the dance company is a union structure,
use during the show (what is the prop, where does
there are very specific rules that must be followed
it enter, where does it exit, etc.). This information is
for scheduling and running rehearsals.
useful in determining the placement of props tables
246 PRODUCTION AREAS
that any amount of additional time in one slot will
and presets. Likewise, the stage manager should
take time away from the next dance slot.
keep track of costume changes and the amount of time available for quick changes. This information
●●
●●
Calling the show: No matter what other duties are
will be necessary for the costume designer, since
assigned to the stage manager, the calling of cues in
there is normally a rigid and fixed amount of time for
the performance remains the primary responsibility.
quick changes in a dance.
This job requires patience, organization, and a calm
Compiling the prompt book: Another stage
demeanor. During the run of a performance, the
management task is assembling the prompt
stage manager might call hundreds of different
book. A prompt book is a special annotated
cues, many happening simultaneously. The job is
script used by stage managers to call cues
complicated by the fact that one must keep one eye
for the dance production. Section 14.4 details
on the prompt book and another on the stage, while
the specifics of assembling the prompt book and
communicating with the board operators on headset.
its use.
This role can be compared to that of an air traffic
Running technical rehearsals: Once the production
controller, controlling the operation and timing of
process enters technical rehearsals, the stage
numerous simultaneous tasks on a daily basis.
manager’s job becomes much more involved. The
●●
Maintaining the artistic integrity of the work: Once
stage manager’s role during tech is ensuring all
the production opens, most often the choreographer
personnel are present and ready to run the technical
and other members of the production team will
rehearsal. To those ends the stage manager will
have left to go on to other productions. This leaves
regularly check in with all production staff to ensure
the stage manager responsible for the day-to-day
all parties are familiar with the schedule and are
operations of the dance and the only remaining
ready to go. Once the tech process begins, the stage
member of the production team who has the insight
manager will call instructions out from the house
of having worked on the entire creative process.
for dancers and production teams alike. During this
For this reason, the stage manager is charged
period, it is important that the stage manager be
with maintaining the intent of the choreographer
intimately familiar with the dance and its structure.
and designers. During the course of a longer run
This is one situation in which it is beneficial for
it is sometimes necessary for the stage manager
the stage manager to have a command of dance
to give some notes related to the continuity of the
terminology. Since the technical rehearsal tends to
performance.
be stop and go, it is important to understand exactly
●
●●
what the choreographer means when he says “take it
Stage Management and Union Structures
from the pas de deux.”
There are a number of different unions who represent
Another of the important roles of the stage manager
artists and performers in the arts. The United Scenic
in technical rehearsals is that of timekeeper. The
Artists-Local 829 (USA-829) represents designers
stage manager must keep a watchful eye on the
working in all areas of the entertainment industry,
clock and be aware of the time remaining in the
including dance. The American Guild of Musical Artists
allocated timeslot. This is especially important in a
(AGMA) is the union that represents opera singers,
concert setting with multiple dances, understanding
dancers, opera directors, and backstage production
247 STAGE MANAGEMENT
personnel at opera and dance companies. Any artist
If you find yourself in this situation, there are some
working at a principal opera or dance company operates
things that can be done to help make the task more
under an AGMA contract. Unlike stage managers
manageable. For one, the choreographer should make
working in a theatrical production, dance stage
every attempt to take on some of the normal stage
managers are represented by AGMA and not the sister
management responsibilities, such as scheduling, notes,
union of Actors Equity Association (AEA). The union
etc. If at all possible, the choreographer should try to
structure is an important consideration for those stage
help get the stage manager up to speed on the dance—
managing in dance. If the production is operating under
shoot video of the dance, write a synopsis of the piece
a union contract, then union rules must be followed
with key moments, etc. The stage manager should try to
meticulously. Common rules relate to length of working
get in touch with the choreographer and the design team
days, duration and frequency of breaks, mandatory days
to establish communication. Attempt to determine what
off, amenities in the performance space, and many more
the needs might be before heading into tech rehearsals.
details. The stage manager is ultimately responsible for
Even a cursory understanding will go a long way towards
maintaining the rules and reporting infractions to the
making the process more manageable. Everyone can’t
union, a role that must be taken seriously.
be employed in an elite professional company, but it should not stop you from performing to the highest
FYI: Realistic expectations The material presented above is tailored for a professional dance company structure with a relatively large amount of personnel. Unfortunately, small companies with limited budgets and academic dance programs often cannot mirror this professional model. While it would be ideal to always have a stage manager involved in the creative process, the fact remains that many companies simply cannot afford to enlist a stage manager for anything other than calling the show. In an academic environment, the stage manager is often a student with little to no experience. It is a common situation for the stage manager to come into the job late in the creative process, not be involved with rehearsals, work with designers on a short timeline, and have a lack of assistants or backstage crew. It is not uncommon, in fact, for the stage manager to be the only backstage personnel and to be brought into the process for tech rehearsals only (sometimes as late as the day of the performance).
professional standards of your position.
14.2 Pre-production One of the many ways that a stage manager assists the dance production is in pre-production planning and organization. One of the important considerations is the stage manager’s contract. If operating under a union contract, the stage manager may not be available until rehearsals begin. In other instances, the stage manager might be considered more of a staff position, executing some of the day-to-day operations of pre-production. The following section lists some ways in which the stage manager might assist during pre-production.
Auditions The audition is an important event that allows choreographers the opportunity to see a wide range of dancers and cast available roles for their dance performance. The stage manager can play a pivotal role in the organizational process of auditions, especially if the auditions are for multiple dance pieces. When arranging the audition, it is common to have the stage manager(s) compile audition information that might be
248 PRODUCTION AREAS
included in the audition listing such as audition location,
for contact information. This is the contact sheet. The
time, number of roles being auditioned, performances
stage manager assembles the contact sheets for the
dates, etc. In addition, stage managers might be
production. It is common to have two separate contact
involved in the process of scheduling and booking an
sheets for cast and production staff. This information is
audition space. In this case, the stage manager should
collected from audition sheets and contact information
be intimately familiar with the rules of the space,
from designers and technicians. The stage manager
procedure for opening and locking up, and any special
must keep this information up to date and disseminate it
requirements such as piano or sound system.
to all the members of the production team.
When the time for auditions comes around, the stage
Assisting the Choreographer
management team will normally set up an audition table with registration forms. It is common for dancers to arrive with résumés and headshots. The stage management team will collect these and have the dancer fill out an audition form that includes contact information, physical information (height, weight, hair color), education and specialized training, scheduling information, and any important information about the production that the company would like the dancers to know. An important question to ask of the choreographer before auditions begin is how he/she wants to handle cuts. Some choreographers prefer to wait until the entire audition is complete to let dancers know they will not be cast. Others will make dancer cuts during the audition process in order to better study the dancers in whom they are most interested. Either method is acceptable, but the stage manager should know the preferred method before auditions begin. Some choreographers also prefer to have an audition with callbacks. Callbacks are the second round of auditions that bring in the short list of dancers to be seen a second time. This approach might offer the choreographer an opportunity to focus a bit more on basic skills in the first rounds of auditions and work a bit closely on the dancers’ interpretation of choreography in the callback.
Contact Sheets Since there are so many individuals involved in producing a dance, it is important to have one centralized location
Much of the stage manager’s role in the pre-production period is determined by the needs of the choreographer. Since every dance is different, even when working with the same choreographer, it is always important to determine his/her needs. Perhaps it is coordinating the arrangement of rehearsal props for the rehearsal space. Whenever possible, the stage manager or another member of the stage management team will assist the choreographer in tasks required to prepare for the rehearsal period. Sometimes the stage manager might be assigned to work with a number of different choreographers as well. In this case, the stage manager should be aware of all of the ways in which the dances interact, such as rehearsal times, use of similar dancers, etc. In some ways this setup is preferable, since the stage manager can enter into production meetings with a wider understanding of the needs of the production.
The Production Calendar Depending on the structure of your academic department or dance company, the stage manager might be handed a completed calendar, given a loose set of guidelines and asked to create the calendar, or any number of variations between. When assembling the calendar, it is important to consider for whom it is intended. For designers and other members of the production team, it is sufficient to create a standard calendar with the days of the week and month. For performers, it is likely that this type of graphic-based
249 STAGE MANAGEMENT
calendar will not be sufficient for containing all of the
and, as such, has a number of responsibilities linked to
necessary information. Often, rehearsals will include
the rehearsal process. Many dance companies do not
dozens of indications for individual performers, such as
utilize a stage manager during the rehearsal period,
their call time and when they are excused. For this type
or at least not for the entirety of it. This is often due to
of rehearsal calendar, it is often better to simply go with
the fact that budgets do not contain enough funds to
a text-based approach.
include the stage manager until closer to the technical
Meeting with the Production Team
rehearsals. For this reason, it is important for the stage manager to determine the expectations of his/her role
The stage manager is often responsible for organizing
before entering into the process. This section covers a
production meetings and recording minutes of the
number of concerns for the stage manager during the
production meeting. In some instances, a formalized
rehearsal period.
production meeting with all members of the production staff is not a possibility (due to scheduling conflicts,
Preparing the Rehearsal Space
non-local participants, or the dance company choosing
One of the duties of any stage manager is the preparation
to not have regularly scheduled meetings). By all
of the rehearsal space before rehearsals begin. There
accounts, the best-case scenario is having regularly
are multiple considerations to this process, many of
scheduled production meetings with all production
which will vary for different types of dance. Listed below
team members participating, whether in person or via
are some important questions to consider before the
teleconferencing. If this is not a possibility, though, the
dancers enter the rehearsal space.
wise stage manager will reach out to the production team members to communicate information about the project and determine their needs and expectations. It is not, strictly speaking, the stage manager’s job to accommodate the needs of each member of the production team. It is important to recognize, however, that the stage manager can serve an important function of gathering information from all parties and including them in regular correspondence with the entire team. In this way, each member of the production team has the opportunity to see what is going on in the other areas. This is especially important considering the collaborative nature of dance production and how one area’s choices can affect others.
14.3 Rehearsals Once the dance enters the rehearsal period, the stage manager’s role expands to include assisting the dancers in addition to the rest of the production team. The stage manager is the daily contact point for all of the company
250 PRODUCTION AREAS
●●
Is the rehearsal space the correct size?
●
This is an important question to address before rehearsals begin. If the dancers get accustomed to a certain amount of space, it is difficult to leave this muscle memory behind once they get into a different size performance space. This is particularly important for the choreographer as well. Sometimes there simply is not enough room to fit the entire cast of performers onstage at the same time. If this is the case, it must be understood from the beginning of rehearsals. The best practice is to determine the size of the performance space and tape out the constrictions of the performance space on the floor of the rehearsal space. In addition to the basic size and shape, if the dance will incorporate scenic elements that affect where the dancers can be positioned, it is important to spike out the placement of the set before rehearsals begin. This process requires a scale ground plan from the scenic designer and a
good understanding of how to interpret a drafting.
●
●●
Is there a sound system?
The stage manager uses a scale ruler to measure the
Since music is so important to the rehearsal
ground plan and multiple tape measures to precisely
process, it is always a good idea to know the details
measure out the placement of the scenery on the
of the sound system for the performance space.
stage and spike it in the rehearsal space.
Most dedicated dance rehearsal spaces will have a
There are a few options for marking the floor. Spike
system in place for playing back CDs or inputting
tape is a special variety of thin cotton tape made
from a portable music player. Quite often, this
in a wide variety of colors. Spike tape typically
equipment might be locked up and require a key or
comes in ½˝ wide rolls and is used for “spiking”
combination to access, though. Also, if the space
important marks on the stage floor, such as set
does not include a sound system, then arrangements
placement or key locations for dancer placement to
must be made for bringing in a portable system
be appropriately placed in areas of lighting. Spike
for rehearsals. Likewise, it is important to discuss
tape can sometimes leave a residue or discolor
the sound needs with the choreographer and
Marley flooring, so it is important to know if the
sound designer. Some dances might require an
rehearsal space has rules about what can be used
accompanist for rehearsals. Does the space have a
as spike on the flooring. Sometimes it is preferable
piano? Has the accompanist been contracted for the
to use Marley tape, a vinyl tape intended for use on
rehearsal period? Even though these factors may
Marley dance floors. It typically comes in wider rolls
not be the responsibility of the stage manager to
(2–4˝) and can be cut down to the smaller strips used
arrange, it is always an important part of the stage
for spike marks.
manager’s role to ask the right questions. Are special rehearsal elements required?
●●
What are the rules of use for the space?
●
Another important consideration is the rules of use
Always ask the choreographer if there are special
for the rehearsal space, including basic policies
rehearsal elements required for the dance, such as
of unlocking and locking the space, acceptable
props, rehearsal costumes, video, etc. Since these
footwear, time limits, checking out equipment, and
elements are not a common requirement for the
more. Each space has its own unique rules and
rehearsal process, the only person who can speak to
limitations for use and it is important to know these
their need is the choreographer. If there are special
beforehand so this information can be communicated
needs, the stage manager can then contact the
to the choreographer. If, for instance, there are
necessary parties to inform them of the needs and
rules for the rehearsal space that keep music
timeline.
●●
from being played during certain times of day, this information would affect the rehearsal schedule.
FYI: The Stage Manager’s Kit
Some spaces may not allow for the use of tape on
All professional stage managers have a collection
the dance flooring. This can be a complication if
of essential supplies on hand for rehearsals and
there are scenic elements that must be represented
productions. This kit is normally held in some
for rehearsal purposes. A good stage manager will
sort of tackle box, duffle bag, or rolling suitcase—
always try to foresee any complications that may
depending on the stage manager’s preference. The
arise before going into rehearsal.
contents of the stage manager’s kit are typically
251 STAGE MANAGEMENT
an amalgam of first aid and office supplies.
During the Rehearsal
Sometimes the dance company will provide some
Once the rehearsal actually begins, the stage manager’s
of these items, though it is often a good idea for the professional stage manager to have their own supplies just in case. The following list is by no means exhaustive, but it would be a good starting point for the dance stage manager.
job is to assist the choreographer in the rehearsal process, supervise the dancers, and serve as the primary method of communication between the choreographer and other members of the cast and production team. The stage manager will create a cast list before rehearsals begin that includes a sign in for each rehearsal. When the
Keep in mind that the distribution of medicine is sometimes acceptable and at other times it can create a legal dilemma. Over-the-counter antiinflammatory medicines are beneficial in the event of an
dancers arrive, they will initial the sheet indicating that they are present. The stage management team will immediately contact any late arrivals, unless prior arrangements have been made. This process guards against a room full of
injury, but one should always ask about allergies before
people waiting on one person to show up.
distributing the medicine. Likewise, if the dancer is a
Once everyone has arrived and the rehearsal begins,
minor, the decision might best be left up to the parents. ●●
First aid supplies: Ace bandages, triangular bandages, Band-Aids of all sizes, gauze, blister plasters, instant heat/cold packs, nail clippers/nail file, antibiotic ointment, sterile medical gloves, throat lozenges, scissors for cutting bandages, tweezers, splinter removal kit, and Q-Tips.
●●
Basic medicines: Aspirin or other pain relievers, ibuprofen or other anti-inflammatories, cough drops, saline solution, antacid, and vitamin c supplements.
●●
Office supplies: Brads, stapler, paper clips, binder clips, hole punch, pens/pencils/markers/highlighters, pencil sharpener, scotch tape, Post-it notes, ruler, scale rule, scissors, whiteout pen, three-ring binder, blank paper, and reinforcement rings.
●●
Backstage supplies: Tape (Gaffer’s tape/spike tape/ glow tape/clear packing tape), measuring tape, batteries, flashlight, clip light, multi-tool, sewing kit, stopwatch, extension cord, and electrical plugging strip
●●
the stage manager’s role is to assist the choreographer in a number of different ways. The stage manager and choreographer should communicate beforehand to determine what services will be most useful. The stage manager can take specific movement and blocking notes or simply be there to observe and take general notes on the choreographer’s behalf. Whatever tasks the stage manager performs, this period is remarkably useful in that he/she will see the evolution of the dance and have a deeper understanding of the subtleties in the dance. This will be invaluable when it comes to calling the show, as the stage manager will understand all of the various parts of the dance completely.
Communication Communication is one of the most important aspects of the stage manager’s job. During the rehearsal period, this is performed in many different ways. The list below includes some of the ways in which the stage manager serves as the communication hub for the production.
Dancer supplies: Hand sanitizer, breath mints,
Rehearsal Announcements
hairpins, tissue, tampons, baby wipes, dental floss,
Since everyone is together for the rehearsal period,
and high-protein individual snacks.
this is often a good time to make announcements.
252 PRODUCTION AREAS
This might be a general announcement from the
same type of notes, so it is important to discuss with all
company regarding the upcoming performance or
of the production team what their needs might be.
specifics from the choreographer. Typically, rehearsal announcements are best placed at the end of rehearsal
14.4 Technical Rehearsals
when the dancers aren’t preparing for the rehearsal
Once the dance heads into technical rehearsals, the
and are free to take notes, as necessary. Sometimes,
stage manager’s role focuses on integrating all of the
the announcement might be as simple as reminding the
design, technical, and performance aspects into one
dancers to check the callboard for notes.
seamless package. The effective stage manager makes
The Callboard
this task look easy, even though it is without a doubt one of the most challenging roles in any type of production.
Many rehearsal and performance spaces use a bulletin
Planning and experience are essential to the success of
board to post information for the company. This is
the stage manager. Listed below are some thoughts for
referred to as the callboard. The callboard is a useful
how the stage manager can make the difficult task of
location for including notices such as rehearsal notes,
managing technical rehearsals a bit more manageable.
weekly schedules, fitting schedules, photo calls, and more. It is important to make sure everyone is aware of
Assembling the Prompt Book
the placement of the callboard and reminded to check
As mentioned earlier in the chapter, the prompt book is
it on a daily basis. It is also important to remember
a tool specifically used by the stage manager for calling
that the callboard is not the appropriate method for
cues in the show. As the stage manager approaches
disseminating sensitive or private information. The
the technical rehearsals, it is important to assemble a
stage manager must always be aware of the necessary
clean and legible prompt book that will be used for the
balance between communication and privacy.
production. For theatrical productions, this is typically a
Rehearsal Notes
three-ring binder with the script on one side (often the left side) and the notes on the opposite side (the right).
During the rehearsal process there are many different
Cues will be marked on one side with a line drawn to
types of notes that the stage manager takes for different
indicate the location in the script for calling the cue.
purposes. Since some of the design team may not be able to attend rehearsals, the stage manager is expected to provide answers to them regarding timing, tracking, and details. The stage manager is responsible for sending out a daily rehearsal report to all members of the production team to inform them of any information or questions that may have arisen during rehearsal. In addition to notes for the rehearsal report, stage management often tracks important information such as movement of props or set pieces (where items enter and exit), costume changes, and timing of certain
For dance productions, however, it is less common to have a true script. In lieu of a script, stage managers will often work with the choreographer to write out a shorthand script for calling the show, with descriptions of movements or music, the point in the running time when it would be called, and the cue name/description. For something of this nature, it is common for the stage manager to meet with the respective designers and assemble the cue script by combining information from the various designers’ cue sheets.
sequences that might relate to precise cueing of lights,
Another consideration is the type of prompt book
sound, or effects. No two dances will require the exact
used for longer story-driven dances, like ballet. When
253 STAGE MANAGEMENT
working with ballet or longer pieces, it is common for
manager. In this case, the production stage manager
the stage manager to create a prompt book from the
would often be responsible for hiring the necessary crew
musical score of the ballet. Since the orchestra will
members and communicating duties and schedules
be playing for the duration of the performance, the
before technical rehearsals begin. Even if this is not
score is a natural method for marking and calling cues.
the case, the stage manager should make an effort to
This means that the ability to read music is a must
reach out to all crew members, communicate duties,
for those interested in stage managing these types of
and answer any questions that might arise. All crews
productions. In truth, all dancers and those working in
should have a designated crew head that supervises the
dance production should have a passing familiarity with
crew and reports to the stage manager. Each crew head
musical notation and music terminology.
should have a detailed schedule and checklist of duties
The Paper Tech
for each performance, as well as receiving any training necessary to performing his/her role in the performance
As mentioned in previous chapters, some dance
space. In an academic environment, it is not uncommon
companies have a special meeting called the paper
to find crews comprised of dancers who have little to no
tech, in which all designers, the choreographer, and
technical experience. In this case, it is doubly important
the stage manager meet to talk through the cues and
to ensure the crew is properly trained in expectations
cue placement in the production. This is much more
and safe operation of any stage equipment. While this
common in academic environments and resident
responsibility may fall to the technical director or house
companies with in-house production support. When the
technician, the stage manager should make an effort to
production team is made up of freelance artists, it is
reach out to all crew members and identify these needs.
sometimes difficult to carve out a time for everyone to meet. In this case, it is essential that the stage manager
Assemble a Tech Packet for Dancers
receives cue sheets from the designers in advance so
Another useful tool that the stage manager often
that he/she can incorporate the separate cues into the
generates is an informational packet to give to the
prompt book.
dance company before heading into tech. This packet
Communicating with Cast and Crew
might contain useful information such as schedules, house rules for the performance space, maps (should
One of the main roles of the stage manager is to ensure
the dancers need directions to the performance space),
communication flows between all parties and that the
and any other information that might be of use to the
information remains both timely and consistent. This
company. This is particularly useful when taking a dance
is the reason that all information should be vetted
on tour, as each individual performance might offer up
through the stage manager. As the company nears
its own unique challenges.
tech rehearsals, the stage manager should reach out to both cast and crew to ensure all parties have all the
Daily Schedules
necessary information.
Since the stage manager will be sending out daily
Check in with Crew Members
reports to both cast and production staff, it is important to include with these messages a detailed schedule for
As mentioned before, many companies utilize the stage
the following day. These schedules, sometimes called
manager as a production manager or production stage
dailies, must be sent out as soon as possible to ensure
254 PRODUCTION AREAS
the performers are sufficiently prepared for call times.
Early Arrival
The schedule should include call times (the time at
The stage manager is often one of the first people in
which individuals are required to report to the theatre), release times (when people are free to go), and the evening schedule for things like sweeping and mopping the floor, lighting/sound/projections check, company warm-ups, curtain time, and anything else of specific importance.
the building. In some spaces, he/she would arrive early and unlock doors, turn on lights, and prepare for crew arrival. In other spaces, there might be a house tech crew that takes care of these responsibilities. Either way, it is always a good idea for the stage manager to be in the space from the moment it is available
FYI: A Word for the Dancers Throughout the rehearsal and performance process, the choreographer and stage manager will be your
so he/she can begin the process of prepping for the performance.
Check-in
constant points of contact. Keep in mind that, once
Before going into technical rehearsals, the stage
tech begins, you will be interacting with a wide
management team should create a check-in sheet
range of designers and technicians whose jobs are
that lists each cast and crew member. Beside each
multifaceted and demanding. Remember the rule of
name there should be a box for checking in. When the
thumb for communication protocol is to always go
performer or crew member arrives, he/she should
to your choreographer first. The designers always
initial the box. The stage management team will then
welcome the input of the dancers, but it can be
check the list to ensure all participants are present
difficult during the process of tech to address the
and on time. Should there be a late arrival, the stage
concerns of every dancer who brings up an idea. If
manager or assistant stage manager will call this
you have a question or comment about a production
person to determine their location and estimated arrival
element, bring it up with the choreographer, who will
time. While this may seem a bit tedious or excessive,
in turn talk to the stage manager and designers or
this system ensures that stage management will have
address the concern with the appropriate designer
sufficient time to locate and put in an understudy or
and/or crew member. This type of professionalism
replacement dancer, should this be necessary.
will make you look like a seasoned pro and get you hired back again. Everyone likes working with a team player.
Technical Checks Typically the crew will arrive a bit earlier than the performers so that there is time for running through
14.5 During the Run
various crew checks. Common checks during this time period are dimmer checks (making sure all of the lights
Once the show is up and running, the stage manager
are functioning properly), sound check, projections
transitions to a dual role of calling the show and
check, and headset check (to ensure all of the headsets
ensuring that the production remains true to the vision
are properly functioning). During this time period, it is
of the choreographer and designers. Listed below
important that the stage manager checks in with each
are some common responsibilities that occur during
crew head to determine if their pre-show checks have
the run.
been done and if there was anything amiss. If so, this
255 STAGE MANAGEMENT
would need to be addressed before opening or marked
14.6 Chapter Review
in the production notes to be fixed before the following
The stage manager has one of the most difficult jobs
performance.
Giving Calls Once dancers arrive in the performance space, the stage manager is responsible for keeping everyone aware of the time remaining until the curtain goes up. There are a number of different events that must occur at specific times, such as sweeping and mopping the stage, technical checks, dancers getting into costumes, stretching/warm-ups, etc. Typically, the stage manager will make an announcement on the theatre’s intercom system at the top of the call, letting everyone backstage know what time it is and how long remains until the house is open (when the audience enters the auditorium). Most theatre spaces open the house 30 minutes before the curtain goes up. At this point, the stage manager will announce to the backstage that the house is open and give a 30-minute warning. After this, there will be a 15-minute warning for dancers to be in places, followed by a 5-minute warning, and
of all the roles in performing arts. He/she must be a master communicator with the ability to juggle with one hand while taking notes with the other, all the while watching the stage and talking to multiple people over a headset. The stage manager, above all else, is dedicated to working behind the scenes to facilitate collaboration and help others out. From the initial discussions with designers, to the rehearsal period, to running the show and interacting with the company, the stage manager works with the greatest number of individuals in the production process. The role of the stage manager is fluid, with duties and expectations changing during the production process from pre-production planning to auditions, rehearsals, technical rehearsals, and running the show. The stage manager who can successfully balance the needs of the creative staff, dancers, crew, and performance space staff will be an invaluable member of the production team whose work is always in demand.
finally a call for places. The specific times may change
Review Questions
according to different companies, but the process
1. What is a production stage manager?
remains similar.
2. What is the role of the assistant stage manager?
Working with House Management
3. Explain the purpose of a callboard.
In addition to communicating with the cast and crew
4. What type of information is included in a rehearsal
backstage, the stage manager is also in communication with the house management for the performance space. The house manager is the individual who interacts with the box office and patrons and determines if the show will start on time or if there is to be a delay in order to get all of the patrons seated (called “holding the curtain”). The house manager will communicate to the stage manager once the house has been closed and, only then, the stage manager communicates with the cast and crew that the show can begin.
256 PRODUCTION AREAS
report? 5. What are some of the duties of stage management at auditions? 6. What are some of the stage manager’s responsibilities related to the rehearsal space? 7. What is spike tape and how is it used? 8. Explain the use of a stage manager’s prompt book. 9. What is a paper tech? 10. Describe the activities a stage manager undertakes during the performance run.
The Stage Manager’s Perspective: An Interview with Julie Ballard
on, Power Goes, I was brought in quite early just to
Julie Ballard is a Chicago-based lighting designer,
as the lighting designer). We were lucky enough to
photographer, production/stage manager, and sound/ media designer. She worked as the lighting director at the Dance Center of Columbia College for nearly eight years, and is owner/operator of Overlap Lighting Productions. As an independent, freelance artist, Ms. Ballard is an artistic associate with Signal Ensemble
start getting ideas (more often than not I am doubling recently complete a technical residency at the Museum of Contemporary Art here in Chicago, and right up until I put the company in a stand-by, I am still the lighting designer. During our main run of the piece, I saw maybe five cues that I could take any type of lighting notes for. I’m usually having to record the show, watch the lighting there, and
Theatre and Unnatural Spaces, as well as technical
make adjustments from that.
director for The Seldoms, Same Planet/Different World,
Other times, I’m brought in two or three weeks before.
and Deeply Rooted Dance Theatre. Ms. Ballard has been
Again, 99 percent of the time (and I really can’t think of
a part of numerous festivals as well as American Dance
a time where I just called a show) I’m doing double duty.
Festival, and has toured nationally and internationally
Based on budgets during a tech week, I’ve seen the piece
with David Dorfman Dance and The Seldoms. Ms.
(recorded it from rehearsal) and I’m laying the Marley,
Ballard holds a B.A. in Theater, and earned her M.F.A. in
spiking the floor, getting the space ready for folks to
Lighting Design from the University of Florida.
arrive, and then switching gears back to design the lights
Do you have any background in dance beyond the design/tech aspects?
(sometimes set up QLab for sound), and then calling/ running lights and sound for the performance.
I have never even taken a dance class.
Are there any tricks/tools of the trade that you find you
How did you get into stage management for dance?
production?
While working on my M.F.A. at the University of Florida, I was introduced to some folks that were quite awesome. Kelly Drummond Cawthon (Shapiro and Smith Dance Company) took me under her wing and began to teach me what her SMs [stage managers] did for the company. I was aware that there were differences between theatre and dance, but I didn’t know how much. I went out on a summer five-city tour and got handed a priceless gift of what being an SM for dance was all about. You really need to be a Jill/Jack of all trades in the mid-size
just can’t live without when stage managing a dance Spreadsheets, schedules, and communication. I know what you are thinking—really? Recently, I filled in for an LD [lighting designer] that had a family emergency and in the beginning email correspondence it took three emails to even get the basic info of their name! Other than that: clear vinyl tape—don’t pull the backing off of glow tape to stick it to the floor. Just cut and cover it with the clear tape, you will save yourself hours pulling up goo off the floor!
dance company world here in Chicago.
Have you done stage management for theatrical
What is the typical process for you as a stage manager?
description differ for the two worlds?
It differs from project to project. I work with The Seldoms, under the direction of Carrie Hanson (Dance Magazine’s 25 to Watch 2012). For the new project we are working
productions? If so, in what ways do you see the job I have not stage managed for theatre since undergrad. When I started doing lighting, I couldn’t give up enough
257 STAGE MANAGEMENT
time to devote just to one show, those SMs are special,
differences you noticed in American vs. international
special people!
work?
Calling a dance piece is very different than a theatre piece—
Sometimes in Eastern Europe the [facilities and
there is no “script” that you can follow along with. You learn
equipment promised in] correspondence [are] not what
the piece or you miss cues. Setting up a cue sheet so that
is there when you get there. I was promised a great
it makes sense to you (and in a pinch to someone else) is
lighting rig on one show and we showed up and had a less
crucial. Again, it sounds silly, but my chicken scratch of cue
than desirable plot. What I say in that situation, you need
notes needs to make sense to someone outside.
to know your show! I also once had to give hand cues to my
I often give a cue sheet to the choreographer at the end of a
video op. because there was no other communication and
run, so that they have a record of what was done, and if they
no way to get light board and video computer in the same
need to remount it for a festival situation.
room or area.
I know that you also do lighting design as well. Do you
What advice would you give to a young artist interested
find that your work as a stage manager is affected by
in stage management for dance?
your lighting design experience? And vice versa?
Be a sponge! Learn everything, and take at least one
I’m a better LD because of the SM world. I have a great
class in each of the disciplines. Educate yourself, be
sense of timing with cues. In dance, for me, I really don’t do one without the other. I actually find it hard to turn over a dance design to a different SM. In theatre, no problem, here
involved, and don’t be afraid to ask questions. You really don’t know how and where your experiences will lead you. I’ve been from New York to San Francisco, Siberia
take my design and enjoy the run!
to South Africa—the better “armed” you are, the more
I know you have worked internationally on some dance
that interest you!
productions. Tell us a bit about that and if there were
258 PRODUCTION AREAS
employable you become, and you might find new things
PART III QUICK REFERENCE
CHAPTER 15 DANCE TERMINOLOGY One forgets words as one forgets names. One’s vocabulary needs constant fertilizing or it will die. Evelyn Waugh
Hubbard Street Dancers Jessica Tong, left, and Jesse Bechard in One Thousand Pieces by Resident Choreographer Alejandro Cerrudo. Costumes by Thomas Mika. Lighting Design by Michael Korsch. Photo by Todd Rosenberg.
Every successful collaborative project relies on good
of describing this method of choreography, with the
communication. One of the challenges in a multi-
repetitive use of movements or gestures that gradually
disciplinary endeavor such as dance production is
build up, or “accumulate.”
making sure everyone is communicating in the same language. Some years back, when I first began polling colleagues about what would be most useful in a dance production text, the most frequent request was a glossary of commonly used terms. These final chapters present just that—a quick reference guide of common
Alternate In dance, an alternate is a role performed by more than one dancer. Unlike an understudy, who only performs if someone gets hurt or can’t go on, an alternate is guaranteed some number of performances.
terms used in both the dance and theatre world. Neither
And
chapter is meant to represent the entire canon of dance
The “and” refers to the half-beat that is
or theatrical terminology, as that would be two separate
counted between the consistent down beat of
books worth of material. Instead, I have tried to distill
music—i.e. counting rhythms out for a dance as
the information down to the terms that will be of the
“one-and-two-and-three-and-four-and…”
most use to the uninitiated from either dance or theatre. This should be a good starting point to give you a working vocabulary of some of the most essential terms and concepts.
Arabesque A ballet term referring to a dancer standing on one leg with the other leg extended behind the body with a straight knee. There are a number of different arabesque
As a final thought, when in doubt please ask a question!
positions, defined by the placement of the arms in
It is so much better to know that you truly understand
relation to the body (Figure 15.1).
what is being said rather than to smile and pretend. This will lead to problems down the road. I hope that you find this as useful and interesting as I did when compiling it.
A
Attitude A ballet position similar to arabesque, but with the extended leg bent at the knee (Figure 15.2). The position can either be attitude devant (with the leg extended in front of the dancer) or attitude derrière (with the leg extended behind the dancer).
Abstract dance
En avant
An abstract dance refers to a type of choreography that
The French term, meaning “forward,” or to execute a
does not follow a narrative construction. Another way
move towards the audience.
to look at this is “movement for the sake of movement,” that is, not related to story, symbolism, ideas, or associations. Accumulation The notable choreographer Trisha Brown created a dance called Accumulation in 1971, comprised of dancers meticulously working through the graduated gestures of the piece. The title became used widely as a way
262 QUICK REFERENCE
B Ballet Ballet is the theatrical work which a choreographer creates to express his/her ideas through solo and group dancing to musical accompaniment, including scenery, costumes, and lighting.
F I G UR E 15. 1
A dancer in arabesque. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
Ballet (Classical) A formal and structured style of dance that originated in the French courts in the sixteenth century. Classical ballet is typically performed to classical music and combines together highly technical dance work with elaborate scenery, lighting, and costumes in order to tell a story. It is often characterized by the use of light, graceful, and fluid choreographed movement. The term classical ballet is often used loosely to refer to the type of ballet that adheres to the performance framework established in the nineteenth century. Ballet (Romantic) Romantic ballet refers to the type of ballet created in the early nineteenth century. Based on the artistic concepts of Romanticism, the ballets often featured themes revolving around a return to nature or the supernatural. The Romantic ballets showed a decline in the use of male ballet dancers, and instead focused on the ballerina. Ballet blanc Ballet blanc, literally translated as “white ballet,” refers to the Romantic style of ballet popularized in the nineteenth century in such works as La Sylphide, Giselle, or Swan Lake. The term originates from the tradition of dressing the ballerinas and corps de ballet in all white Romantic tutus. Bar (measure) In musical terms, a bar refers to a section of the musical composition that contains a certain number of beats. In some instances, the measure may begin with an accented beat, as in the case of a waltz. For instance, waltzes are written with measures containing three beats. The first beat is a strong down beat, with the last two beats having a lesser emphasis (i.e. 1-2-3, 1-2-3…). F IG UR E 15. 2
Dancers in attitude devant. Photo courtesy of Randy Mascharka, Eastern Michigan University.
263 DANCE TERMINOLOGY
F IG UR E 15. 3
Barre work. Photo courtesy of Jim Lamberson.
of eight beats and starting over again at one (i.e. 5-6-7-8-1-2-3-4…).
C Canon See also unison. In choreographic terms, the repetition of choreographed movement by a number of dancers starting at different points of time. Character artist See also corps de ballet, coryphée, principal, and soloist. A senior position within a ballet company, the character artist often performs roles within the ballet that require a great deal of acting, as well as dancing. Seasoned Barre French for “bar,” this horizontal railing is either
professionals within the company or guest artists hired on for the ballet often fill these positions.
attached to a studio wall or free standing on support
Choreographer
legs (Figure 15.3). The railing is used primarily at the
The choreographer is the artist who envisions the
beginning of a class period for stretching, warming up,
movement of the dance. Though there are a number of
or performing specific exercises—commonly referred to
different choreographic methods, most choreographers
as barre work.
work specifically with the production staff and
Battement
performers to ensure their vision is realized onstage.
An extension of the leg to the front, side, or back,
Coda
creating a beating action of the extended or bent leg.
In ballet, the final suite of dances (called the grand
Beat See also down beat and up beat.
pas) is used as a high-energy showcase for the dancers. The coda, literally translated as “tail,” refers to the concluding portion of the grand pas, in which
A beat is the primary unit of time used to measure both
the principal performers execute the finale—either
music and dance. It is the regular repeating pulse that
separately or with their partners. If a large number of
is felt when listening to the music. In dance terms, the
performers participate, this might be referred to as the
beat is often a series of pulses counted aloud while
coda générale or grand coda générale.
learning choreography—often occurring in a sequence
264 QUICK REFERENCE
Contemporary dance
sometimes perform solos, while maintaining their
Contemporary dance is a form of dance that emerged in
position in the corps de ballet.
the mid-twentieth century, best illustrated by the works of Merce Cunningham. In terms of style, contemporary dance draws on both classical ballet and modern dance,
D
creating a movement language drawing from a number
Dance captain
of different sources. Contemporary dance is typically an
A role most often seen in musical theatre, the dance
unpredictable, non-narrative form of dance that focuses
captain is a dancer who is in charge of overseeing
on creative freedom. Often, contemporary dance features
dancers in a production, maintaining the choreography,
the use of scenery, lighting, projection, and sound
and running “put-in” dance rehearsals for an understudy
elements functioning independently from the dance
coming into a role.
elements.
Dance theatre
Contraction
See also Tanztheater.
See also release.
Dance theatre is a term used to describe a genre
A common term used in Graham technique, Horton
of performance that blends together performance
technique, and jazz. In Graham’s technique, all
elements from both dance and theatre. Dance theatre
movement was based around the opposite movement
is similar to musical theatre, with less of a focus on the
concepts of “contraction and release.” The process of
dramatic storytelling through the use of song. Though
contracting the abdominal muscles to make the lower
dance theatre may incorporate dialogue and some song,
back curve out and the abdomen appear hollowed out.
the focus will remain on storytelling through dance.
In contraction, the shoulders should remain positioned above the hips. Corps de ballet See also character artist, coryphée, principal, and soloist. In ballet, there are typically three tiers of performers in the company: principals, soloists, and the corps de ballet, or corps for short. Literally translated as the “body of the ballet,” the corps is a group of dancers who do not have lead roles but perform in group numbers, similar to a chorus role in the theatre. Most often, the corps is composed of a greater number of females than males.
En diagonale The French term meaning “on the diagonal.” Down beat See also beat, up beat. The down beat refers to the first beat of a measure of music, i.e. number one. In many musical styles it is also the accented, or emphasized, beat of the bar.
E Evening length dance
Coryphée
A dance piece, at least one act in length, which could be
See also character artist, corps de ballet, principal, and
used as a stand-alone performance.
soloist. A coryphée is a member of the corps de ballet who has been elevated to a higher rank within the corps. They
265 DANCE TERMINOLOGY
Extension This term is used in a number of different dance styles to refer to extending an arm or leg away from the body and holding it in place for a period of time. Often, the extension is an exaggerated pose or posture, done to accentuate a particular bodyline and to create an interesting picture at the end of a phrase.
F En face A French term referring to the dancer facing the audience. Fall A term used to describe a dancer quickly dropping his/ her body to the floor with the weight centered over the ball of the supporting foot. Freeze
J Jeté A ballet term that means “throwing.” Though the term is often combined with other words, when used by itself it means to lightly spring off of the floor on one foot and land on the other.
L Legato In dance, as in music, legato refers to a sense of movement that does not stop, creating a smooth sense of connected movement without breaks between the motions. Lift A lift is a dance movement in which one partner lifts the other so that both feet are off of the floor. There are many different variations on lift types.
When the dancer instantly stops movement and holds a fixed body position. Full out See also mark. To run the dance as choreographed, executing each move in the proper time and place with the music. Show conditions.
G Grand pas See also coda. In ballet, the grand pas is a suite of dances of the ballet, used as a showcase for the dancers. This suite of dances comes towards the end of an act or at the finale of the ballet itself. Though there are different variations on the grand pas, it typically consists of the entreé (the introduction), the grand adage (also referred to as the adagio, in Italian), which features dance partnering, and the coda.
266 QUICK REFERENCE
M Mark (mark it) When a choreographer uses the term “mark it,” he/ she refers to running the dance with the music, keeping your general place on the stage, but without executing the more complex moves like lifts or falls. This is often done in a technical rehearsal setting for the benefit of the designers to see the placement of dancers onstage without making the dancers physically exhausted by running the dance “full out” each time. Merde Like all of the performing arts, it is considered bad luck to say “good luck” before a dance performance. In music and theatre, performers often say “break a leg” instead of good luck. For opera, the phrase “toi, toi, toi” is used, often accompanied with knocking on wood and
spitting (whether literally or feigning the act) to ward off bad luck or a hex. Dancers prefer to use the word merde, the French curse word literally meaning “shit.” Like all superstitions in the performing arts, there are a number of wildly different theories on why this became the norm. One posits that in the olden days a successful ballet would be visited by a number of the wealthy elite who arrived in horse-drawn carriages. The more successful the show, the larger the pile of horse droppings. Another theory is that in the olden days, animals were often onstage for performances, leaving droppings. The term merde would be used before the performance to wish the dancer good luck and a reminder to avoid stepping in the manure. Whatever the true origin of the term, it has remained a part of dance vocabulary in theatres across the world.
N Notation The process of documenting the choreography for a dance. There are two main methods for notation: Labanotation and Benesh notation.
P Pas de deux In ballet, the pas de deux refers to a dance for two. The French word pas, meaning “step,” is combined with a number of other words to describe numerous ballet terms. Since most of these other terms are never shortened, the pas de deux is sometimes simply referred to by dancers as the pas, for short. All classical ballets have at least one pas de deux, so it might be necessary
Modern dance
to indicate which specific pas de deux is being referenced
In many circles, the terms modern dance and
(i.e. the Giselle Act 1 pas de deux).
contemporary dance are used interchangeably. When referring to specific dance movements, however, modern dance typically refers to the type of dance that emerged in the late nineteenth century and continued on until the late 1950s. Modern dance
Phrase A phrase is a series of dance movements that create a sense of choreographic pattern, typically with the distinct feeling of having a beginning and end.
was a direct response to classical ballet, leaving
Pirouette
behind the strict forms, tight corsets, and pointe
French for “spinning,” this term describes a dancer
shoes and embracing a freer sense of movement and
spinning on one leg with the other off the ground.
expression. Martha Graham, Mary Wigman, and Lester Horton are three pioneers of modern dance. As the movement progressed, artists such as Paul Taylor, Twyla Tharp, and Alvin Ailey continued in the modern tradition.
Plié This is a key position in ballet that allows the dancer to execute a number of different moves. Derived from the French word meaning “to bend,” a plié is the bending of the legs outward at the knees with the heels positioned
Motif
on the floor. The grand plié is a deeper version of this
A theme or idea that makes up a pattern in a work
bend, in which the heels lift slightly off the floor when
of art. In dance, a motif is most often a movement or
the dancer reaches the lowest part of the bend.
gesture that becomes the framework for repetition and variation, creating a pattern that appears within the work.
En pointe See also pointe shoes.
267 DANCE TERMINOLOGY
To support the weight of the body on the tips of the toes,
Post-modernism
while wearing pointe shoes.
In dance, post-modernism refers to the twentieh-
Pointe shoes See also en pointe. Pointe shoes are special ballet shoes devised for dancers (typically female) to perform en pointe. These shoes are typically covered in satin with no heel and a reinforced toe called the box that helps support the weight of the dancer. Pointe shoes are secured onto the ankle through the use of ribbon and/or elastic straps (Figure 15.4).
century dance movement whose work reacted to the compositional and presentational forms of modern dance. Post-modern dance championed the notion that all movement is dance and supported novel new methods of dance composition. Though short-lived (mostly in the 1960s and 1970s), post-modernism formed the bridge between modern and contemporary dance. Famous post-modern choreographers include Trisha Brown, Yvonne Rainer, and Judson Church. Principal See also character artist, corps de ballet, coryphée, and soloist. The term principal dancer, or simply principal for short, describes the highest rank of dancer within a professional dance company, particularly in ballet. In short, the principal dancers are the marquee performers who have earned a position of prominence in the company and play the lead roles. Principal dancers are typically hired by the company or promoted from within the company ranks to take on both solo and pas de deux pieces. Principals may also occasionally take on a guest performer position at a separate dance company.
Q Qualities of movement The qualities of movement, sometimes referred to as dynamics, are a group of six terms used to describe the nature of physical movement. These terms are particularly useful when describing choreography and should be a working part of every dance artist’s vocabulary. 1.
Swing: A type of movement that appears the most natural in performance. It begins with a slight
F I G UR E 15. 4
impulse and allows the movement of the dancer to
Pointe shoes. Photo courtesy of Jim Lamberson.
268 QUICK REFERENCE
2.
3.
follow the natural flow of gravity along the natural
Release
path of an arc. A free sense of movement.
See also contraction.
Sustained (see also legato): Sustained movement
A common term used in a number of different
is smooth and even, without the perception
dance techniques (including Graham, Cunningham,
of accent or abrupt starts/stops. This type of
Horton, Laban, etc.). Release refers to a relaxing or
movement uses a continual release of energy and
arching movement of the body. In Graham’s technique, for
requires a heightened amount of physical control.
instance, all movement was based around the opposite
Compared to musical terms, sustained movement
movement concepts of “contraction and release.” In
is comparable to the term legato (some artists
addition to a movement, release can refer to “release
might use the terms interchangeably).
technique,” a movement practice that focuses on
Percussive: A type of movement that is short,
breathing, relaxation, and the use of gravity and
choppy, and has a broken, disconnected sense to it.
momentum to create efficient movement.
In musical terms, this type of movement might be referred to as staccato. This is in direct opposition to sustained movement. 4.
Suspending: The moment when all opposing forces reach equilibrium—the moment, for instance,
performed by an individual or a dance company. Repertory concert A concert featuring several shorter dances.
dancer is suspended at the peak of a jump. This is
Retrograde
moment before the body succumbs to gravity and falls to the floor. Vibratory: Quick, repetitive, and percussive movements that produce the visual effect of vibration. In vibratory movement, energy is exerted in brief, intermittent spurts. 6.
The collection of choreographic works commonly
when after exerting a great amount of energy, the the moment when kinetic energy has run out, the
5.
Repertoire
Collapse: Collapse is a movement in which gravity takes over and the movement takes the dancer towards the floor. It can occur in a gradual or sudden fashion. Often collapse is followed by a recovery movement upwards.
R Re-staging
This term is often used by choreographers in reference to the performance of choreography in reverse—from end to beginning. Run To execute the performance of a dance from beginning to end without stopping.
S Site specific The term site specific refers to any dance piece created for performance in a specific location, most often not a traditional performance space. Site specific works include locations such as art galleries, elevators, shopping malls, or even rock quarries.
A new interpretation of a pre-existing work of
Soloist
choreography.
See also character artist, corps de ballet, coryphée, and principal.
269 DANCE TERMINOLOGY
In ballet, there are typically three tiers of performers in
The German term, meaning “dance theatre.” This
the company: principals, soloists, and the corps de ballet.
style of German Expressionist dance emerged during
The soloist is a performer who has earned the rank
Weimar Germany. Rudolf Laban was the most famous
above the corps, but not yet attained principal status.
artist working in this style. He believed that Tanztheater
In many dance companies, the soloists perform dance
represented a new interdisciplinary total art form.
solos and understudy the principal roles, occasionally
Tanztheater combines dance, speaking, chanting, and
performing them.
song with traditional theatrical devices to create a
Spotting A technique used during pirouettes and other turning
performance with no narrative plot, focusing instead on a train of thought or central theme.
movements to keep the dancer from getting dizzy. The
Tempo
dancer focuses on one spot (often a light in the back of
In dance, as in music, tempo refers to the speed at which
the auditorium called a “spotting light”) as the turn is
something is performed, measured in number of beats
made, keeping his/her eyes on that spot until the head
per minute (bpm).
has no choice but to whip around.
Turnout
Sprung
Turnout refers to a dancer turning his/her feet or legs at
A term referring to the process of creating a floor surface
a 90-degree angle away from the hips. Also referred to
with the ability to flex and move under the dancer. A sprung
as rotation.
floor is typically made using a special wooden framework or foam blocks beneath the performance surface, allowing for flexibility of the floor. This type of floor absorbs shock and is easier on the dancers’ knees and joints.
Tutu The traditional costume for a ballerina, composed of multiple layers of net. The tutu comes in a number of different styles, often associated with specific ballet
Supporting leg
styles (i.e. the Romantic tutu for Romantic ballet). The
See also working leg.
tutu is often worn accompanied with a bodice.
The supporting leg refers to the leg that holds up the weight of the body during a dance move, in contrast to the working leg, which does the movement.
U Unison
T
See also canon.
Tableau
number of dancers performing identical choreography at
Tableau is a French term meaning “picture.” In dance
the same time.
terms, this refers to the dancers freezing in one position to create a stage picture. Tanztheater See also dance theatre.
As the name implies, unison is a term referring to a
Up beat See also beat and down beat. The up beat refers to the last beat in a bar of music. When looking at a sequence of musical bars, the up beat is the beat that anticipates the first beat (or down beat) of a bar.
270 QUICK REFERENCE
V
W
Variation
Working leg
In ballet terms, a variation is a solo dance performed in
See also supporting leg.
a classical ballet.
The working leg refers to the leg performing the movement, in contrast to the supporting leg, which holds up the weight of the body.
271 DANCE TERMINOLOGY
CHAPTER 16 THEATRE/STAGECRAFT TERMINOLOGY The limits of my language mean the limits of my world. Ludwig Wittgenstein
A photo from the studio collection “Lighting Drama” by Richard Calmes. Photography by Richard Calmes.
A Amplifier An amplifier, or amp for short, is an electrical device used to take low-power audio signals and amplify them to a level powerful enough to activate a loudspeaker. Apron See also proscenium line. The area of the stage, downstage of the proscenium line, that extends out towards the audience. Arena stage Arena staging, or theatre in the round, is a type of stage featuring audience on all four sides of the stage. Typically, the seating is raked so that the audience is looking down on the stage.
B
F IG UR E 16. 1
A batten, in the foreground. Photo by Jeromy Hopgood.
Back light See also front light, side light, top light, up-light. An angle of light in which the lighting instrument is
Batten
positioned to project light from the upstage to the
See also fly.
downstage, illuminating the back of the figure. This type
A long metal pipe suspended above the stage from which
of lighting accentuates the head and shoulders of a figure and visually separates the form from the background. Barn door
lighting and scenic elements are hung (Figure 16.1). In a theatre with a fly system, the batten can be lowered to stage level or raised out of sight high above the stage
See also Fresnel.
deck.
A lighting accessory attached to the color slot of a
Black box
lighting instrument (often a Fresnel) with four hinged
A small, simple performance space—frequently with four
panels used to shape the beam of light.
walls and black masking curtains along the sides (ergo
Bastard amber A color of lighting medium frequently used for dance lighting. The resulting colored lighting is a slightly
black box). Black box spaces often feature adjustable seating so the audience orientation can be reconfigured for different styles of performance.
warmer “white light” with a pinkish hue. Bastard amber
Blackout
is a popular color for dance lighting as it naturally
To turn out all of the stage lighting and leave a
enhances a wide variety of skin tones.
completely darkened stage.
274 QUICK REFERENCE
Blacks
Circuit
Black velour curtains used for masking purposes on the
See also dimmer, stage-pin connector.
stage—legs, borders, and full-stage blackout curtains.
The plug into which a lighting instrument is connected
Boom
to provide electricity. In most theatres, the circuit is
A vertical lighting position, typically in the wings of the
connected directly to a dimmer that provides variable
theatre, used as a side lighting position. Booms feature
electrical flow. Most theatrical circuits utilize the stage-
a steel boom base on the floor into which a tall vertical
pin connector.
pipe is threaded. Since booms are frequently top heavy,
Color drop
it is also common to use sand or shot bags placed on the boom base to keep them from tipping over.
Color drop, or dropping color, is a term that refers to dropping of gels into the lighting instruments. For dance
Border
concerts, it is common to have stagehands drop color
A border is a masking curtain that hangs horizontally
in the side lights between the different dance pieces,
from a batten above the stage. Its primary purpose is for
enabling the lighting designer to achieve a wider variety
masking lighting instruments and scenery that might
of looks.
be flown overhead. Some people might refer to a border
Crescent wrench
as a teaser, but technically speaking the teaser is the furthest downstage border used to frame out the top of
A type of wrench commonly used for hanging and
the proscenium opening.
focusing lighting instruments and other types of
Boundary mic
an adjustable spanner whose opening is opened or
A specific type of microphone designed for being placed on the perimeter of the stage, typically placed on the stage floor. This microphone is commonly used in dance performances to reinforce the sounds made by a dancer. Common models are the PCC (Phase Coherent Cardiod), which picks up sound from one direction, and PZM (Pressure Zone Microphone) that picks up sound in all directions.
equipment (Figure 16.2). The crescent wrench features closed by turning a threaded spindle. The proper name for a crescent wrench is the adjustable wrench (US) or adjustable spanner (UK). In the US and Canada, the most popular manufacturer of the wrench was the Crescent Tool Company, leading to the common term “crescent wrench.” Some people refer to the crescent wrench as a “c-wrench” for short. Cross
C
To move from one part of the stage to another (i.e. to
Catwalk
Cross-fade
A series of elevated walkways above the stage floor, often where lighting positions are located.
cross down, to cross right, etc…).
Cross-fade is a term that refers to shifting from one cue into another over a period of time. As the first cue
Centerline
is fading out, the second cue begins to fade up, creating
The imaginary reference point running down the center
a seamless transition between the two cues. This term
of the stage from the upstage to the downstage, dividing the stage at the center.
can be used to refer to transitions in lighting, sound, or projections.
275 THEATRE/STAGECRAFT TERMINOLOGY
particular event, such as a dancer entering or a scenic change. Cyclorama The cyclorama, or cyc for short, is a large grey or light blue stretched drop positioned upstage as a backdrop. The cyc is commonly used for lighting effects to create a colorful background for dance.
D Dark 1.
Dark is a term used to refer to a day on which there is no show at the theatre, i.e. The theatre is dark on Mondays.
2.
Going dark is a phrase used to describe turning off lights, either on the stage or in the auditorium. Before turning off stage lights during a rehearsal, it is common etiquette to announce “going dark” so that no one is caught by surprise.
Dead hung A term that refers to rigging an object overhead without FI GU RE 16.2
A crescent wrench.
Crossover See also cyclorama.
the intention of it ever flying. Deck The stage floor—particularly in instances where a stage floor is laid atop of the main stage floor.
A crossover is the space used to cross from one
Diffusion
side of the stage to the other without being visible to
Diffusion is a specific type of gel made of a thicker,
the audience. For dance, it is important for dancers
partially opaque material. The purpose of a diffusion gel
to have access to a crossover for quick movements
is to soften the resulting light and eliminate “hot spots”
from one side to the other. This is often upstage of the
or harsh shadows in the lighting.
cyclorama, or a hallway located behind the back wall of the stage.
Dimmer See also circuit.
Cue light
An electrical device that regulates the flow of voltage to
A cue light is a type of light positioned at key locations
a circuit, thereby dimming or brightening the lighting
backstage and operated by the stage manager to cue a
instrument plugged into it.
276 QUICK REFERENCE
Dimmer check
first ERS unit, introduced in 1933, was named the Leko,
The process of going through the list of all dimmers
after the last names of its creators. The name stuck and
and turning them on to see if the lighting instruments
remains a common nickname for all varieties of ERS
plugged into that dimmer work. This is typically done
lighting instruments to this day.
during the call period before a performance. Down light See also back light, front light, side light, up-light. Down lighting is a direction of stage lighting, in which the light is focused on a figure from above, shining down at a steep angle. This type of lighting creates strong slightly unnatural shadows on the figure. Down light is sometimes referred to as top light, as well. Downstage See stage directions.
F Flat A vertical panel of scenery, typically framed in wood with either wooden or muslin fabric covering. Flats framed with wooden facing are often referred to as Hollywood flats, whereas those covered in muslin are called soft flats. Fly To raise or lower an item overhead by means of a rigging
Dress parade
system in the theatre.
A specific event in which all of the dancers come onstage
Fly house
in costume, giving the choreographer and designers a chance to see the dancers all in costume under stage lighting.
See also fly, fly system. A theatre with a dedicated fly system. Fly loft
E
See also fly, grid.
Electric
grid, blocks, and battens necessary to fly elements out
See also batten.
The area over the stage in a fly house that contains the of the audience’s overhead line of sight. The fly loft is
An electric is a type of batten with electrical
typically two and one-half times taller than the height of
circuits dedicated to powering lighting instruments
the proscenium arch.
(Figure 16.3).
Fly system
Electrician
A theatrical rigging system that utilizes battens,
An electrician is the name given to a stagehand working
cables, pulleys, and counterweights in order to
in lighting.
fly components such as lighting, scenery, soft
ERS
goods, etc. overhead.
The Ellipsoidal Reflector Spotlight, or ERS for short,
Follow spot
is a type of stage lighting instrument that creates a
A moveable spotlight lighting instrument that can pan
defined pool of light. ERS instruments have the ability to
(move in a horizontal plane) and tilt (move in a vertical
shape the beam of light, color slots for using gels, and
plane) allowing a follow spot operator to “follow” a
accessory slots for items like gobos and/or irises. The
performer across the stage with a pool of light.
277 THEATRE/STAGECRAFT TERMINOLOGY
F I G UR E 16. 3
An electric.
Footlights
shape their beams of light without using barn doors.
See also up-light.
The Fresnel is a popular choice of lighting instrument
A row of lights positioned along the front edge of the
for back and top lighting because of its ability to wash
apron, pointing upstage to illuminate the performers in
wide areas of the stage with an even distribution of
low-angle up-light.
lighting. Another interesting characteristic of the
Fresnel
changed from flood (a wider beam of lighting) to spot (a
See also barn door. A Fresnel is a type of wash-lighting instrument, named for its use of the Fresnel lens, a lens that utilizes a series of stepped glass rings on the outside, giving it the characteristic appearance of concentric circles on the lens. Fresnel instruments do not have the ability to
278 QUICK REFERENCE
Fresnel is the focus knob that allows the light to be narrower beam). Front light An angle of lighting in which the figure is illuminated from a light source shining from downstage to upstage, particularly used to light the faces of the performers.
F IG UR E 16. 4
Three separate gels cut to size and a gel frame, resting on a paper cutter.
The light enables someone to walk onstage in the dark and avoid accidents like colliding with scenery or falling into the orchestra pit. The superstition holds that all theatres have at least one ghost. Keeping a ghost light running allows the ghost an opportunity to perform onstage, thereby appeasing the ghost and preventing them from cursing the theatre or sabotaging a production. Gobo A template inserted into a lighting instrument that creates a pattern of light. Gobos are made of metal or glass for conventional instruments, and sometimes plastic for LED lighting fixtures.
G
Grand drape
Gaffer’s tape
the proscenium arch. The grand drape is typically made
A type of paintable fabric tape used for taping down
from a heavyweight velour fabric with fullness sewn into
electrical cables and in a wide variety of stagecraft
the curtain. The grand drape is sometimes referred to as
applications.
the main rag, as well.
Gel
Grid
A gel is another name for a thin sheet of plastic color
The grid is the framework of steel beams at the top of
medium, used to shift the color output of a lighting
the fly loft. The grid supports the blocks and cabling
instrument. The gel is placed into a metal gel frame and
necessary for operating the fly system.
inserted into the color slot of the lighting instrument. Gel is purchased in large sheets and then cut to fit individual instruments, often with a large paper-cutter (Figure 16.4). Ghost light
The theatre’s main curtain, flown directly upstage of
Ground row In lighting terms, a ground row is a row of strip lights positioned at the bottom of the cyclorama pointing upward. In scenic terms, a ground row is a low-profile scenic element, typically positioned in the upstage area
A ghost light is a portable light left onstage during times
near the cyclorama. For dance productions, it is common
when the other lighting instruments would be turned off.
to have a lighting ground row with a scenic ground
It is typically rolled onto the center stage position and
row positioned to mask the appearance of the lighting
left turned on for reasons of both safety and superstition.
instruments.
279 THEATRE/STAGECRAFT TERMINOLOGY
H
L
Head high
Leg
A side lighting position from side booms with the lighting
A vertical masking curtain used to mask off the
instrument positioned approximately head high from
audience’s view of the theatre’s wing space.
stage level. Hollywood flat
Leko See ERS.
See flat. House A term indicating the auditorium of the theatre (i.e. sitting in the house). House lights The lighting system used for illuminating the auditorium.
I In-between The area of the stage located between the masking legs, where the side booms are positioned. These positions are named according to stage directions, moving from downstage to upstage (i.e. stage right in-1, stage right in-2, etc…).
M Main rag See grand drape. Mid high A side lighting position from booms with the lighting instrument positioned approximately waist high from stage level.
O Offstage See stage directions. Onstage See stage directions.
J Jack A triangular-shaped brace affixed to the back of a flat to hold it vertically in place.
Orchestra pit A sunken area located downstage of the apron, intended to house the orchestra performers. In many theatres, the orchestra pit is built with an elevator that allows for it to be raised or lowered.
Jumper A short electrical cable (typically 5–10´ in length) with stage-pin connectors used to span the distance to connect a lighting instrument and a circuit.
P PARcan A PARcan is a simple and cost-effective
K
flood-type lighting instrument. The name is
Kill
Aluminized Reflector) housed in a simple metal
To turn off a light or sound immediately.
housing (the can).
280 QUICK REFERENCE
derived from its use of a PAR lamp (Parabolic
Proscenium
Sightlines
The portal that separates the audience from the stage
The area of the stage and backstage visible to the
and frames the action of the performance.
audience.
Proscenium line
Soft flat
Also referred to as the plaster line, the proscenium line
See flat.
is an imaginary reference point running across the stage from the upstage edges of the legs of the proscenium arch. Combined with the centerline, these two reference points divide the stage into quadrants.
R Raked stage
Soft goods The stage draperies, masking, scrims, etc. used in a theatre for performance purposes. This includes, but is not limited to, legs, borders, cycloramas, blackout curtains, scrims, etc. Soft goods typically have a jute webbing attached to the top, with grommets for reinforcement, and tie line used to tie it off to a batten.
A stage floor built so that the surface inclines as it
Special
moves upstage.
A light hung for a specific purpose, i.e. the downstage center special used for the final lift in the Act II pas de
S Scrim A type of stage fabric with an open weave, similar to gauze. When lit from the front, the fabric appears opaque. When lit from behind, it will appear translucent. Due to this “scrim effect” the fabric is often used for magical theatrical reveals. Scroller A mechanical device that scrolls a loop of gels in front of a lighting instrument, allowing the designer to transmit multiple colors from one lighting instrument.
deux. Spike A spike is a mark on the stage floor to signify the placement of an object, set piece, or location of significance. Spike marks are typically made with spike tape or, in some theatres, paint pens. Stage directions The directions used by performers on a stage. Stage directions, in contrast to house directions, use the dancer as the frame of reference—the right of the performer (when facing the audience) is stage right, and the left is stage left. To move away from the audience is
Shin busters
upstage, whereas to move towards them is downstage.
The lowest side lighting position from booms with the
Moving towards the centerline is referred to as onstage,
lighting instrument positioned approximately shin-high
and to move away from the centerline is called offstage.
from stage level.
Stage-pin connector
Side light
The standard connector type used in entertainment
A lighting position, typically in the wings, that
lighting in North America and many countries around
creates a sculptural look, accentuating the dancer’s
the world. The stage-pin connector has two separate
form.
types of connector ends: male and female. The male
281 THEATRE/STAGECRAFT TERMINOLOGY
connector has three cylindrical pins, whereas the female
Lighting a figure from a lighting instrument placed
has three circular openings (see Figure 4.10).
low (typically on or beneath the stage floor) pointing
Strike
upwards. One example of this is the use of footlights.
To remove all of the production elements of the show
Upstage
from a space.
See stage directions.
T
V
Teaser
Visual
See border.
A visual is a cue that is called based off of physical action
Thrust
on the stage.
A performance space with the audience positioned on
Vomitorium
three sides of the stage. Also called a ¾ round space.
A vomitorium, or vom for short, is a passageway
Top light The lighting position with the lighting instrument positioned above and pointing down at the stage. Tormentor
positioned beneath the seating in a theatre space with raised seating, such as a thrust.
W
A tormentor is a vertical curtain or framed structure
Wagon
acting as a leg, typically placed in line with the teaser.
A wagon is a mobile platform that can be used to
The placement of the tormentor is directly upstage of the
transport three-dimensional scenery on a stage. In most
proscenium.
instances, the scenery is built onto the wagon and can be
Two-fer
moved as a single unit.
A theatrical lighting plug used to connect two lighting
Wings
instruments to one circuit.
The area of the stage deck located offstage right and left, typically masked by the legs.
U Up-light See also footlights.
282 QUICK REFERENCE
Index Note: Page numbers in bold are for terms that appear in the quick reference section. Page numbers in italics are for illustrations. ⁄2” scale models 150 ⁄4” scale models 150 1 ⁄8” scale models 148 3 ⁄4 round theatre 47 3D models 82, 145, 146, 148, 149, 150–1, 151, 232 3D printing 150 3D rendering 235 3DS Max 151, 235 1 1
A abstract dance 262 academic dance work 33 accompaniment, music/sound as 98 accompanists 10 accumulation (of movements/ gestures) 262 Accumulation (Trisha Brown) 262 Actors Equity Association (AEA) 248 additive color mixing 74 administrative personnel 8–9 Adobe After Effects 234 Adobe Illustrator 145, 234, 235 Adobe Photoshop 145, 232, 234 Adobe Premiere 234 AGMA see American Guild of Musical Artists alternates 262 Alvin Alley Dance Theater 13 ambient light 221 American Federation of Musicians (AMF) 116
American Guild of Musical Artists (AGMA) 247–8 American Society of Composers, Authors, and Publishers (ASCAP) 106 amplifiers 103, 274 analogous colors 75 and (half-beat) 262 Andrew, Jason 21 angles of lighting 59, 59–60 animation 235 Apollo gels 75 apron stages 38, 274 arabesque 262, 263 arbors, counterweight systems 44 arena theatres/stages 49, 274 arrangement of concert 26–7 artistic directors (AD) 8, 10, 13 assembling a team 14 assistant stage managers (ASM) 12, 245 Atlas, Charles 17 atmospherics see mood/atmosphere attitude 62; derrière 262; devant 262, 263 Audacity program 113, 114 audibility 98 audience(s) 24; expectations 24; seating 45–7; sightlines 39–40, 40, 152, 281 audio equipment 100–4; amplifiers 103; equalizers (EQ) 102–3; input source 100–1; loudspeakers 103–4;
microphones 101, 275; mixers 102, 102 auditions 28 auditorium, divisions of 46, 46–7 AutoCAD 82, 151 en avant 262
B back lighting 58, 59, 66–7, 67, 71, 274 backdrops: scenic 135, 136; see also curtains and backdrops Baird, Campbell 160–3 balance (costume design) 173 Balanchine, George 90, 179 balcony seats 46 Ballard, Julie 257–8 ballet 262; classical 130, 263; romantic 263 ballet blanc 263 ballet pointe shoes 180, 181, 267–8, 268 ballet slippers 180, 181 bar (measure) 263 barn doors (lighting) 72, 274 barre 263, 264 basket weave sprung floors 133, 133 bastard amber 75, 274 battement 264 battens 44, 45, 274, 274 beam spread of lighting 70 beat 264; down beat 265; up beat 270
283 INDEX
Beira, João 239–41 biketards 175, 175 Bill T. Jones/Arnie Zane Dance Company 13 black box theatres 49, 274 blackout 274 blacks/blackout curtains 41–2, 275 Blender program 235 block diagrams see sound diagrams BMI (Broadcast Music, Inc.) 106 Boards of Directors 8 bodices 179, 179 boom lighting 40, 63, 63–4, 275 borders (curtains) 41, 275 bottoms (costumes) 175–7 boundary microphones 101, 275; pickup patterns 101, 101 box office managers 9 box seats 46 Brecht, Bertolt 218 brightness 57 The Brodmann Areas (Norte Maar) 21 Brown, Trisha 262 budget 27, 31–2; props 140 build lists (costumes) 196 business managers 8
C cables: intelligent lighting instruments 73; jumper 280; projection systems 220, 233 CAD (Computer Aided Drafting) 82, 150–1 Cage, John 17 call times 255 callbacks 249 callboards 245, 246, 253 calling the show (calling cues) 11, 29, 88, 244, 247, 253, 254 canon 264 Capezio (dance shoe manufacturer) 182 Caplan, Elliot 17 capri pants 176 Category 5/6 networking cables 220
284 INDEX
catwalks 275 c-clamps 69–70, 70 ceiling slots 65, 65 center stage 37 centerline sections 153, 153–4 centerlines (CL) 38, 38, 152, 275 chance, as choreographic device 17 channel hookup sheets 85–6, 86 character, and costume 167 character artists 264 character relations, and costume 168 character shoes 182 check-in sheets 255 choreographers 12–13, 27, 264 choreographers: and costumer designer collaboration 190–2; and cueing process 90; freelance 16; and lighting designer collaboration 80–1; perspective: Julia Gleich 19–21; and projection designer collaboration 230–1; resident 10; and scenic designer collaboration 144–5; and sound designer collaboration 110–11, 116; and stage managers 249 choreography 10 choreologists 10 circuit 275 coda 264, 266 collaboration 2, 7–21; choreographer—costume designer 190–2; choreographer—lighting designer 80–1; choreographer— projection designer 230–1; choreographer—scenic designer 144–5; choreographer—sound designer 110–11 collaborative models: collective method 16–17; company model 15–16; freelance model 16; independent model 17 collage concerts 25, 126 collapse movement 269 collective method of collaboration 16–17 color drop 275
color filters (gels) 57–8, 75–6; color cut lists 86–7; swatch books 75; transmission 75 color filters (glass) 75 color mixing 74–5 color saturation 73–4, 75–6 color scrollers 70, 281 color values 74 color(s): analogous 75; complementary 75; costume 90, 171, 172; in lighting 73–6; primary 74; secondary 74 Come, and Back Again (David Dorfman Dance) 93, 120 communication, stage manager’s role in 245, 252–3, 254–5, 256 communication protocol 255 company managers 8–9 company model of collaboration 15–16 compensation 32 complementary colors 74 composers 10, 96 composition in dance 55–6 computer aided drafting (CAD) 82, 150–1 computer software: 3D renderings 146, 235; audio/video editing 113–14, 234, 235; lighting design 85; pre-visualization 82, 232; projection systems 222–5; raster graphics 234; scenic models 150–1; sketches 145; slide-based presentation 223; sound playback 114, 117, 223, 223–4; vector graphics 235 computers, and projection design 220 concert breakdown charts 195, 195 concessions 26 conductors 10–11 Coniglio, Mark 224–5 connectors: projection equipment 220; stage-pin 281–2 contact sheets 249 contemporary dance 265 content workflow diagrams (projection design) 233
contraction 265 contracts: letters of agreement (LOA) 14–15, 32; technical rider 12 copyright 96, 105–6, 210, 235, 236 CorelDRAW 235 corner blocks, soft flats 136 corps de ballet 265 coryphée 265 costume bibles 196 costume design 190–204; communicating the (paperwork 193–6; renderings 193, 194; sketches 192, 193; visual research 192); and dress rehearsals 199–200; execution 196–9 (costume rentals 198; costume shopping 197–8; fabric selection 197; fittings 198–9; patterns 198, 198; taking measurements 197; working from stock 198); and performance run 200–1 costume designers 11, 21, 166; and choreographer collaboration 190–2; perspective: Liz Prince 202–4; and rehearsals 191–2 costume lists 195–6 costume plots 193, 194 costume roughs 192 costume shopping 197–8 costumes 148, 162–3, 166–83; changes of 247; components 173–83 (base layer 173–5, 174; bodices 179, 179; bottoms 175, 175–7, 176, 177; dresses 180; footwear 180–3, 181, 182, 267–8, 268; organization of 199–200; skirts/tutus 177–9, 179; tops 180); functions of (character 167; character relations 168; costume as a prop 167–8; movement 166–7; style 169–70; theme/mood 169; time/place 168–9); projection of virtual costumes 214–15; properties of (color 90; fabric 170; line 170–1; scale 173; shape/form 171; texture 172–3); see also fabrics (costumes)
counterweight systems 43–5 coves 65, 66 Crawford, Sam 119–22 crescent wrenches 90, 275, 276 cross 276 cross-fade 275 crossover 275 cue lights 11, 276 cue sheets 258; lighting 88, 89; projections 233–4, 236–7; sound/ music 113 cue-to-cue rehearsals 30 cueing process 28; and choreographers 90; lighting 28, 88–91; and paper tech 91; projections 233–4, 236–8; referencing rehearsal videos during 90; representing the figure during 90; sound/music 28, 90, 112, 114, 116–17; tech tables 89–90, 116–17 cues: calling 11, 29, 88, 244, 247, 253, 254; fade time 89; linear playback 223; placement of 29 Cunningham, Merce 2, 17, 80, 265 curtains and backdrops 40–2; blacks/ blackout 41–2, 275; borders 41, 275; cyclorama (sky drop) 40, 42, 67–8; grand drapes (main rag) 40–1, 279; guillotine 40; legs 41, 280; lighting 67–9; scrim 42, 42, 68–9, 281; traveller 40–1 cyc lights 67–8, 72 cyclorama (cyc) 40, 276; lighting 42, 67–8, 72 Cymbeline 132
D D3 program 232 daily schedules (dailies) 254–5 dance artists 9–10 dance captains 265 dance education 13 dance terminology 261–71 dance theatre 265
dancers 10; and communication protocol 255; principal 10, 268; soloists 269–70; tech packets 254; and tech week 30 dark 276 dark time 88, 237 David Dorfman Dance, Come, and Back Again 93, 120 dead hung 276 Dead Man’s Cell Phone (Eastern Michigan University) 215 decibels (dB) 99 deck 276 design staff 11, 28 designer runs 28 development directors 9 en diagonale 265 diffusion gel 276 Digital Audio Workstations (DAW) 113 digital projectors 220–1, 221; brightness (lumens) 221; operating distance (throw ratio) 221 digital video cameras 220, 234 dimmer checks 255, 882, 277 dimmers 61, 62, 276 direction (lighting) 58–9; see also lighting positions and angles direction (sound) 100 dissonance 99 documenting the dance 31 Dorfman, David 93, 120; see also David Dorfman Dance down beat 265 down lighting 67, 277 downstage 37, 277 Dr Faustus (Eastern Michigan University) 129, 217 draftings (lighting design) 82–5 draftings (projection design) 232 draftings (scenic design) 151–5; centerline section 153, 153–4; ground plan 152, 152–3; painter’s elevations 155, 155; USITT recommended practices for 151–2 drapes see curtains and backdrops draping a costume 198
285 INDEX
dress parade 277 dress rehearsals 15, 31, 199–200 dressers 12, 200 dresses 180 dressing rooms 27 Dropbox 111 drops: scenic 135, 136; see also curtains and backdrops DVI (Digital Video Interface) connectors 220
E Eastern Michigan University: Dead Man’s Cell Phone 215; Dr Faustus 129, 217; Red as Blood, White as Snow 131; Ritual Series One 175; The Shape of Things 213; Urinetown: The Musical 218 educational dance 13 electricians 277; see also master electricians (ME) electrics (batten for lighting instruments) 65–6, 67, 277, 278 Ellipsoidal Reflector Spotlights (ERS) 69–70, 277; barrel 70; c-clamp and yoke 69–70, 70; color filters 76; gobo slot 70; shutters 70, 70 emotion, as inspiration 14 entrée 266 equalizers (EQ) 102–3 ERS see Ellipsoidal Reflector Spotlights (ERS) ESP Vision 82 evening length dance 265 executive directors 8 extension 266 extreme sightlines 39–40, 40 EyeSpace (Merce Cunningham Dance Company) 174
F fabrics (costumes): dyeing 170; fibers and quality of 170; and lighting 171, 172; pattern 172–3; selection 197;
286 INDEX
swatches 193; textural properties 172–3 en face 266 fall 266 far-throw cyc fixtures 72 fibers 170 Final Cut pro 234 final dance 26–7 first aid supplies 252 first dress rehearsal 199 flat panel displays 221–2 flats 135–7, 277 flooring 132–5; dance surface 134–5; sprung 132–4, 133, 270 fly 277 fly house 277 fly lofts 44, 277 fly systems 43–5, 152, 277 flymen 12, 45 focus, in lighting 60, 87–8 focus charts 87–8 fog 26, 73; as projection surface 212 fog juice 73 foldback systems 105 follow spots 70–1, 277 followspot operators 12 foot blocks 44 footlights 65, 65, 278 footwear 180–3; ballet pointe shoes 180, 181, 267–8, 268; ballet slippers 180, 181; jazz shoes 181, 182; modern dance 182–3; musical theatre 182; nude shoes 182–3; tap dance 181–2, 182 form (costumes) 171 formal concerts 24 Fosse, Bob 170 freelance model of collaboration 16 freeze 266 frequency (sound) 99 Fresnel, Augustin-Jean 71 Fresnel lighting instrument 71–2, 278 front elevation 156, 156 front-of-house arrangements 27 front lighting 58, 59, 64–6, 278
front lighting: balcony front 65, 65; ceiling slots 65, 65; coves 65, 66; footlights 65, 65; front low-angle side lighting 66; high-angle 65–6; low-angle 65 front projection 211 full out 266 funding 27, 31–2
G Gaffer’s tape 134, 135, 279 GAM gels 75 Garage Band program 114 gel frame holders 70 gels 279; see also color filters (gels) general managers 8 ghost lights 279 Gimp software 234 Gleich, Julia 19–21 gobo slots 70 gobos 60, 60, 72, 279; glass 76 going dark 276 Gonzales, Tamara 21 Google Drive 111 Google Presentation 192 Graham, Martha 20, 80, 267, 269; Lamentations 167 grand adage 266 grand drapes 40–1, 279 grand pas 264, 266 grand rights performances 106 grandMA 3D 82 graphics cards 219 green rooms 27 grids, proscenium theatres 44, 279 ground plans 152, 152–3 ground row 68, 279; masking of 42–3 guillotine curtain 140
H hair 183 hairpieces 183 hanging schedule 33 hard flats see Hollywood flats
Harlequin Liberty sprung floors 133, 133 harmony 99 hats 83 haze 26, 73; as projection surface 212 HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) connectors 220 head high lighting 64, 64, 280 headpieces 183 headset checks 255 holding the curtain 256 Hollywood flats 135, 136–7, 137, 277 Homasote sheets 139 Horton, Lester 267 house 280 house lights 280 house managers 9, 256 house technicians 9, 27 Hubbard Street Dance Chicago 87 hue 73
I iMovie program 234 in-betweens 43, 43, 280 independent model of collaboration 17 input source (sound) 100–1 inspiration 14 intelligent lighting instruments 62, 72–3; cabling 73 intensity of light 57 interactive dance 226, 240 interactivity: and projection design 214–15, 215, 224–5; with scenic elements 128–9 intermissions 26 Internet, and costume shopping 197 Isadora program 224–5
J jacks 280 jazz dance 130 jazz pants 176 jazz shoes 180–1, 181, 182
jeté 266 Johns, Jasper 17 Johnson, Bernard 21 jumpers (electrical cables) 280
K Karinska, Barbara 179 Keynote software 223 keystone correction (keystoning) 212 keystone effect 212, 212 keystones, soft flats 136 kill 280b Kin, Peter 240 KinectTM sensor 214–15 Kook, Edward 69
L La Scala Ballet, Opera 217 Laban, Rudolf 270 Lamentations (Martha Graham) 167 LCD (Liquid Crystaline Display) technology 221 lecture-demonstrations 24 LED (Light Emitting Diode) lighting 58, 72, 75, 76 LED (Light Emitting Diode) panels 222, 222 Lee gels 75 legal concerns: music 96, 105–6; projection design 210, 235–6 legato 266 leggings 177 legs (curtains) 41, 280 Lekos 69, 69–70; see also Ellipsoidal Reflector Spotlights (ERS) length of dance presentation 25 Léotard, Jules 173 leotards 173–4, 174 letters of agreement (LOA) 14–15, 32 Levy, Joseph 69 licensing 106, 236 lift (dance movement) 266 light board operators 12 Light Emitting Diode see LED
light plots 11, 82, 83, 84, 152; USITT notation 84 lighting: arena stage 49; background elements (cyclorama (cyc) 42, 67–8, 72; painted backdrops 68); beam spread 70; color in 73–6; and costume colors 171, 172; direction of see lighting positions and angles; functions of (composition 55–6; mood/atmosphere 56; reinforcement/punctuation 56; rhythm 56; sculpting/modeling 55, 55; visibility 54–5); gobos 60, 60, 72, 76, 279; house lights 280; masking 42–3; and mood/atmosphere 56, 73; properties of (angle 59, 59–60; brightness/intensity 57; color 57–8; direction 58–9; movement 60; visual quality 60); specials 67, 281; tech tables 89–90; thrust space 8 lighting booms 40, 63, 63–4, 275 lighting consoles 62, 62, 89; channel hookup sheets 85–6, 86 lighting design 80–93; communicating the 81–7 (draftings 82–5; paperwork 84–7; pre-visualization 82, 232); cueing process 28, 88–91; and projection design 209; and technical rehearsals 88–91 lighting designers (LD) 11, 28, 54, 80; and choreographer collaboration 80–1; perspective: Seth Reiser 92–3 lighting ground row see ground row lighting instruments 62, 69–73; conventional 62, 69–72; cyc lights 67–8, 72; electrics 65–6, 67, 277, 278; focus 87–8; footlights 65, 65, 278; hanging 87–8; instrument key 82, 83; intelligent 62, 72–3; LED 58, 72, 75, 76; PAR-type 71, 72, 280; schedule 86; spotlights 69–71, 277; wash lighting 71–2 lighting positions and angles: down 67, 277; front 58, 59, 64–6, 278; see also back lighting; side lighting
287 INDEX
lighting sections 84, 85 lighting systems 60–2; control 62; lighting instruments see lighting instruments; power 61 lighting towers 63 LightWright software 85 line (costumes) 170 linear playback (projection design) 223 linesets 44 list-making (costumes) 195–6; spreadsheets 196 load-in 28 load-out/strike 31, 201, 282 loading gallery 45, 45 lock rails, counterweight systems 45, 45 loft blocks 44 loge seats 46 Logic Pro 114, 235 loudspeaker plots 112 loudspeakers 103–4 Luhrmann, Baz 163
M McKernon, John 85 magic effects, using projections 216 magic sheets (cheat sheats) 87, 87 main rag see grand drapes make-up 184–6 make-up crew 12 Marine, Stacey-Jo 32–3 mark (mark it) 266 marketing directors 9 marking 30 Marley flooring 134–5, 139 Marley tape 134, 135, 251 Martha Graham Dance Company 13 masking 40–3 masks 183 Masonite 139 master electricians (ME) 12, 87 Media Composer 234 media servers 220 Merce Cunningham Dance Company, EyeSpace 174
288 INDEX
merde 266–7 Merrily We Roll Along (Stephen Sondheim) 222 mezzanine seats 46 microphones 101; see also boundary microphones mid-high lighting 64, 64, 280 MIDI (Musical Instrument Digital Interface) 113 mix (sound) 100 model boxes 148 modeling with light 55 models see scenic models modern dance 267 mood/atmosphere: and costumes 169; and lighting 56, 73; and scenery 129; and sound 98 motif 267 motion capture technology 214–16, 226 movement: and costumes 166–7; and lighting 60; qualities of 268–9; and sound/music 100 Movie Maker program 234 multidisciplinary collaborations 17 music 17, 28, 96; as accompaniment 98; arrangements of 106; composers 10, 96; and cueing process 28, 90, 112, 114, 116–17; as inspiration 14; legal concerns 96, 105–6; live performance 106, 115; and movement 100; pre-recorded 96, 106, 116; and projection design 237–8; and prompt book compilation 254; rehearsal 113; and rhythm 98; samples 111 music creation/editing programs 114 music rehearsals 115–16 Musical Instrument Digital Interface (MIDI) 113 musical staff 10–11 musical styles 14 musicians 96–7, 115 muslin 135
N Nashville Ballet 161 New York City Ballet 80 Nikolai, Alwin 167 non-proscenium theatres 47–9 notation 267 nude shoes 182–3 number of dance pieces 25 The Nutcracker 126, 130, 167, 184, 194
O offstage 38 onstage 37 opening nights 31 Opera (La Scala Ballet) 217 orchestra pits 39, 280 orchestra seats 46
P paint shops 156–7 painted backdrops (drops), lighting 68 painter’s elevations 155, 155 panning 100 pants 175–6, 176 paper tech 29, 88–9, 91, 254 PAR-type lighting fixture 71, 72, 280 pas de deux 267 patrons 31 pattern (costume fabrics) 172–3 patterns (costumes) 198, 199 PCC boundary microphones 101 percussive movement 269 performance 15; sound as element in 98 performance reports 245 performance spaces 28, 35–50; arena theatres 49; black box/studio theatres 49; general concerns 27; non-traditional spaces 49; and projection design 211–12; proscenium theatres 36–46, 127, 281; seating 45–7, 46, 48, 49, 127;
and staging techniques 126–7; thrust theatres 47–8, 127, 282 Performing Rights Organizations (PROs) 106, 127 permissions 210, 235–6 Peter Pan 161, 184 philosophical concepts, as inspiration 14 photo calls 31 phrase 267 Pinterest 192 pipe pockets 135 pirouette 267 pitch (sound) 99 pixelation 220 pixels 220, 234 place, sense of: and costumes 168–9; and scenery 129 plan views 82 plasma display panels 221 plaster lines 38 platforms 137, 138, 139 playback systems 101, 104, 105, 114, 117 plié 267 en pointe 267 pointe shoes 180, 181, 267–8, 268 post-modernism 268 postmortems 15, 31 Powell, Michael, Red Shoes 163 PowerPoint 223 premiere piece 13 premium seats 47 pre-production planning 23–33; budget considerations 31–2; performance space concerns 27; personnel considerations 32; production calendar 27–31; program concerns 24–7; stage managers and 248–50 presentation models 150 presenters 9 Pressburger, Emeric, Red Shoes 163 pre-visualization: lighting design 82, 232; projection design 232 primary colors 74
Prince, Liz 191, 202–4 principal dancers 10, 268 Pro Tools 114, 235 production calendar 27–8, 30–1, 249–50 production managers 9, 245–6; perspective: Stacey-Jo Marine 32–3 production meetings 16, 28, 33, 250 production process 13–15 production stage managers (PSM) 245, 254 program concerns 24–7 projection design 229–41; communicating the (draftings 232; paperwork and informational graphics 232–4; pre-visualization 232; visual communication 231–2); content creation 234–6 (3D rendering and animation 235; audio content 235; legal concerns 235–6; stills 234–5; stock footage 235, 236; video 234); and technical rehearsals 236–8 projection designers 11, 208, 230; and choreographer collaboration 230–1; perspective: João Beira 239–41 projection equipment 213, 219–22, 237; cables 220, 233; computers 220; connectors 220; digital video cameras 220; display devices (digital projectors (video projectors) 220–1; flat panel displays 221–2; LED panels 222, 222); projection plot 232 projection mapping 212, 213 projection plots 232 projection surfaces 212 projection systems 218–19; video playback systems 219; video reinforcement systems 219; video workstations 219 projections 208–26; appropriateness of 213–14; content of 210–11, 214; cueing process 233–4, 236–8;
functions of 230 (as a commentary 216–18; creation of dynamic environment 214; interactivity 214–15, 215; magic/special effects 216; presenting/representing the dancer(s) 215–16, 216; visual reinforcement 216); interactive content 214–15, 215, 224–5; keystone effect 212, 212; legal concerns 210; and lighting design 209; linear content 214; methods (front projection 211; rear projection 211); and motion capture technology 214–16, 226;and music 237–8; and performance space 211–12; software (interactive visual programming 224–5; linear playback 223–4; slide-based presentation 222–3; timelinebased playback 224); tech tables 237; timeline for designs 213; video walls 221–2; of virtual costumes on to dancers 215–15 projections check 255 prompt books 247, 253–4 props 126, 130, 139–40, 144; costumes acting as 167–8; rehearsals with 140, 157–8; tracking 246 props designers 11 props tables 159, 246–7 proscenium arch 36, 36 proscenium lines 38, 38, 152, 281 proscenium theatres 36–47, 127, 281; audience seating 45–7; masking 40–3; scenery fly systems 43–5; sightlines 39–40; stage 37–40 public domain 105–6, 236 publicity 28 pull lists (costumes) 196 punctuation of dance, lighting and 56 purchase lines, counterweight systems 44, 45 purpose of production 24 PZM boundary microphones 101
289 INDEX
Q QLab 114, 117, 223, 223–4 qualities of movement 268–9 quiet time 115 Quixotic Fusion 239–40
R rails: soft flats 136; stock platforms 137 raked seating 48, 48, 49 rakes/raked platforms 139, 281 raster graphics 234–5 Rauschenberg, Robert 17 re-staging 269 realism 169 rear elevation 156, 156 rear projection 211 recording systems 104 Red as Blood, White as Snow (Eastern Michigan University) 131 The Red Shoes (film) 163 rehearsal announcements 252–3 rehearsal directors 10 rehearsal music 113 rehearsal notes 253 rehearsal pianists 10 rehearsal reports 245 rehearsal space 28; rules for use of 251; size of 250–1; sound systems 251 rehearsal videos 15, 28, 90, 238 rehearsals 15, 28; costume designers and 191–2; cue-to-cue/spacing 30; designer runs 28; dress 15, 31, 199–200; music 115–16; with scenery and props 140, 157–8; special needs 251; stage managers and 245–6, 250–3; see also technical rehearsals reinforcement function: of lighting 56; of projection design 216; of sound 99 reinforcement systems 104 Reiser, Seth 92–3
290 INDEX
release 269 release times 255 renderings: costume design 193, 194; projection design 235; scenic design 146, 148 rentals (costumes) 198; rental lists 196 repertoire 269 repertory companies 13 repertory concerts 269 resident choreographers 10 resources, availability of 97, 127 rhythm: and lighting 56; and sound/ music 98 rights-managed licensing 236 Ritual Series One (Eastern Michigan University) 175 Rosco gels 75 roundels 76 royalty-free licensing 236 run 269 running crew 12
S scale (costumes) 173 scene shops 156 scenery 125–39; assessing needs for 126–7; changes of 26, 126; fly systems for handling 43–5, 152; functions of 127–130, 132 (defining space 128; interactivity 128–9; mood 129; problem solving 130, 132; style 130; time/place 129); preconceived expectations about 127; and re-mounted productions 127; re-using 127; and seating arrangements 127; and touring productions 127 scenic charge artists 156 scenic construction and painting 155–7 scenic design 126–7, 143–63; communicating the (design specifications 151–5; renderings 145–6, 148; scenic models see
scenic models; sketches 145–6, 147; visual research 145) scenic designers 11; and choreographer collaboration 144–5; perspective: Campbell Baird 160–3 scenic elements: dimensions of 152; drops 135, 136; flats 135–7; flooring 132–5; platforms 137–8; stairs 139; trap doors 39, 139 scenic ground row 68 scenic models 82, 145, 146, 148, 149, 150–1, 151; 1⁄2” scale 150; 1 ⁄4” scale 150; 1⁄8” scale 148; computer-generated 150–1; presentation models 150; white 150 schedules/scheduling: 14; stage manager’s role in 245 scrim 42, 42, 68–9, 281; black 69 scrollers 70, 281 sculpting with light 55, 55 seating 45–7, 46, 48, 49, 127 secondary colors 74 self-examination 15 self-powered speakers 103–4 SESAC (Society of European Stage Authors and Composers) 106 SFX program 114, 117 shape (costumes) 171 The Shape of Things (Eastern Michigan University) 213 shin busters 64, 64, 281 shopping lists (costumes) 196 shorts (costumes) 177, 177 show bibles 196 shutters (lighting) 70, 70 side lighting 58, 59, 62–4, 63, 281 side lighting: head-highs 64, 64, 280; highs 64, 64; mid-highs 64, 64, 280; shin busters 64, 64, 281 sightlines 39–40, 152, 281; extreme 39–40, 40 signal flow charts 232–3, 233 silence 96 site specific 269
sketches: costume design 192, 193; scenic design 145–6, 147 SketchUp 145, 151 skirts 177–9 sky drop curtain see cyclorama sleds 71 slide-based projection 223 slopers 198, 199 Society of European Stage Authors and Composers (SESAC) 106 soft flats 135, 136, 137, 277 soft goods 281 software see computer software soloists 269–70 Sondheim, Stephen, Merrily We Roll Along 222 sound board operators 12 sound checks 116, 255 sound design 97, 97–107, 109–22; communicating the (music/ sound samples 111; paperwork 112–13); cueing process 28, 112, 114, 116–17; functions of (accompaniment 98; audibility 98; mood/atmosphere 98; performance 98; reinforcement 99; rhythm 98); and projection design 235; properties of (mix 100; direction 100; movement 100; pitch 99; sound quality 99–100; volume 99); sound editing and composition tools 113–14; and technical rehearsals 114–18; see also audio equipment sound designers 11, 28, 97; and choreographer collaboration 110–11, 116; perspective: Sam Crawford 119–22 sound diagrams 112, 113 Sound Forge program 113–14 sound mixers (sound boards) 102, 102 sound mixing cue sheets 113 sound plots 112, 112 sound quality 99–100 sound reinforcement 99
sound samples 111 sound systems 104–5; playback systems 101, 104, 105, 114, 117; recording systems 104, 104; rehearsal space 251; reinforcement systems 104 sound tech tables 116–17 sound technicians 97 SoundCloud 111 soundscape 98 spacing rehearsals 30 speakers see loudspeakers special effects, using projections 216 specials (lighting) 67, 281 spike marks 281 spike tape 251 sponsors 31 spotlight operators 12 spotlights 69–71; follow spots 70–1, 277 spotting 270 spreadsheets: for costume list making 196; for organizing cue sheets 88, 234 sprung floors 132–4, 270; basket weave 133, 133; Harlequin 133, 133 stage coordinate system 38 stage directions 37, 37–8, 281 stage left 37 stage managers 11–12, 29, 152, 243–58; common responsibilities (calling cues in the show 11, 29, 88, 244, 247, 253, 254; communication 245, 252–3, 254–5, 256; during the run 255–6; giving calls until curtain up 256; maintaining the artistic integrity of the work 247; prompt book compilation 247, 253–4; recording information 146–7; rehearsals, preparation for and running 245–6, 250–3; scheduling 245; technical rehearsals 247, 253–6; timekeeping 247); kit 251–2; perspective: Julie Ballard 257–8; and pre-production planning (assisting the choreographer 249;
auditions 248–9; contact sheet assembly 249; production calendar assembly 249–50; production meetings 250); as production managers 244–5, 254; and union structures 247–8 stage monitor systems 105 stage pin connectors 61, 281–2 stage right 37 stage weights 44, 45 stagehands 12 stairs 139; rise and run 139 stiles: soft flats 136; stock platforms 137 stock footage 235, 236 stock platforms 137, 138, 139 Strictly Ballroom (film) 163 strike 31, 201, 282 strip lights 67, 72, 76 strobe effects 72 studio theatres 49 studio time 15 style(s): choice of 14; and costume 169–70; musical 14; and scenic choices 130; theatrical 14 stylized approaches 169 subwoofers (sub) 103 supporting leg 270, 271 suspending movement 269 sustained movement 269 swing 268–9
T tableau 270 Tagliabue, Benedetta 17 Tanzheater 270 tap dance 130 tap shoes 181–2, 182 tech packets for dancers 254 tech schedule 28, 33 tech tables: lighting 89–90; projections 237; sound 116–17 tech week 28, 30–1, 91; role of dancer in 30 technical checks 255–6
291 INDEX
technical directors (TD) 12, 156 technical drawings 156 technical rehearsals 15, 30; first dress 199; and lighting design 88–91; and projection design 236–8; and sound design 114–18; and stage managers 247, 253–6 technical rider contract 12 technical staff 11–12, 27 tempo 60, 270 tension blocks 44 texture, in lighting 60 theatre in the round 47, 49 theatre staff 9 theatrical styles 14 theme 14, 169; and variation 169 thrift stores 198 thrust theatres 47, 47–8, 127, 282 ticket sales 28 tie lines 135 tights 176–7 timbre 99 time, sense of: and costumes 168–9; and scenery 129 timekeeping 247 timeline-based playback (projection design) 224 timelines, projection designs 213 toggles: soft flats 136; stock platforms 137 tour managers 9 touring productions 127 trap doors 39, 139 trap rooms 39 traveller curtains 40–1 Travieso, Yara 158 Troika Ranch 225 Troike Tronix 225 Tudor, David 17
292 INDEX
turnout (rotation) 270 tutus 177–9, 270 tutus: Balanchine/Karinska (powderpuff ) 179, 179; bell 178, 179; classical 178, 179; pancake style 178, 179; platter 178–9, 179; romantic 178, 179
U unions 27, 33, 116, 246, 247–8 unitards 174, 174–5 United Scenic Artists-Local 829 (USA–829) 208, 247 up beat 270 upstage 37 Urinetown: The Musical (Eastern Michigan University) 218 USITT (United States Institute for Theatre Technology) 84, 151–2
V variation 271 Vasterling, Paul 161 vector graphics 235 Vectorworks 82, 151, 232 Vegas Pro 234 VGA (Video Graphics Array) connectors 220 vibratory movements 269 video editing 219, 234 video monitor systems 115–16 video playback systems 219 video projectors see digital projectors video recorded rehearsals 15, 28, 90, 238 video reinforcement systems 219 video walls 221–2
video workstations 219 visibility 54–5 visual elements, as inspiration 14 visual quality of light 60 visual research 145; costume design 192; projection design 231–2; scenic design 145 visuals (cues) 282 volume (sound) 99 vomitories 48, 48, 282
W wagon platform 282 wardrobe crew 12, 200 wardrobe supervisors 200 Warhol, Andy 17 Watchout program 224 water: effects 26; as projection surface 212 white light 74, 75 white models 150 Wigman, Mary 267 wigs 12, 183 wigs/make-up 12 wings 40, 282 wireless microphones 101 word clocks 238 workflow, projection design 233 working leg 271 works in progress 24 WYSIWYG 82, 232
Y yokes 69, 70 Your Heart & Your Belly & Your Whole Insides Felt Empty & Wanting & Hollow (Yara Travieso) 158, 158